﻿<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><Bill RHead_reign="62 Eliz. II" RHead_ParlYear="2013" DocumentTitle="BILL C-4" Bill_No="C-4" Document_No="90703" xml:lang="EN" Bill_Type="Non-amending" Stage_Name="Third-Reading-House" Reprint="No" xml:space="preserve" ChapterNo_E="C. " ChapterNo_F="ch. " Bill-Origin="commons"><Bill_Part Part_Type="Cover" CountLines="No"><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="CovBillNo">C-4</Para></Block><Block><Para TopMargin="24" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" TextAlign="Center">Second Session, Forty-first Parliament,</Para></Block><Block><Para Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" TextAlign="Center">62 Elizabeth II, 2013</Para></Block><Block><Para TopMargin="48" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes" TextAlign="Center">HOUSE OF COMMONS OF CANADA</Para></Block><Block><Para TopMargin="42" Size="18" Leading="20" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes" TextAlign="Center">BILL C-4</Para></Block><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="CovLongTitle">A second act to implement certain provisions of the budget tabled in Parliament on March 21, 2013 and other measures</Para></Block><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="COV_StageLine"></Para></Block><Block><Para BottomMargin="14" Size="11" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes" TextAlign="Center">AS PASSED</Para></Block><Block><Para Size="8" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" TextAlign="Center">BY THE HOUSE OF COMMONS<br />DECEMBER 9, 2013</Para></Block><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="COV_StageLine"></Para></Block><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="Cover_DocNo">90703</Para></Block></Bill_Part><Bill_Part CountLines="No" Part_Type="InsideCover"><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="BPT_InsideCoverE">Available on the Parliament of Canada Web Site at the following address:<br /><B>http://www.parl.gc.ca</B></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="108" BottomMargin="4" Size="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">RECOMMENDATION</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">His Excellency the Governor General recommends to the House of Commons the appropriation of public revenue under the circumstances, in the manner and for the purposes set out in a measure entitled “<I>A second act to implement certain provisions of the budget tabled in Parliament on March 21, 2013 and other measures</I>”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="60" BottomMargin="4" Size="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SUMMARY</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Part 1 implements certain income tax measures proposed in the March 21, 2013 budget. Most notably, it</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) increases the lifetime capital gains exemption to $800,000 and indexes the new limit to inflation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) streamlines the process for pension plan administrators to refund a contribution made to a Registered Pension Plan as a result of a reasonable error;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>c</I>) extends the reassessment period for reportable tax avoidance transactions and tax shelters when information returns are not filed properly and on time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>d</I>) phases out the federal Labour-Sponsored Venture Capital Corporations tax credit;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>e</I>) ensures that derivative transactions cannot be used to convert fully taxable ordinary income into capital gains taxed at a lower rate;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>f</I>) ensures that the tax consequences of disposing of a property cannot be avoided by entering into transactions that are economically equivalent to a disposition of the property;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>g</I>) ensures that the tax attributes of trusts cannot be inappropriately transferred among arm’s length persons;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>h</I>) responds to the <I>Sommerer</I> decision to restore the intended tax treatment with respect to non-resident trusts;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>i</I>) expands eligibility for the accelerated capital cost allowance for clean energy generation equipment to include a broader range of biogas production equipment and equipment used to treat gases from waste;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>j</I>) imposes a penalty in instances where information on tax preparers and billing arrangements is missing, incomplete or inaccurate on Scientific Research and Experimental Development tax incentive program claim forms;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>k</I>) phases out the accelerated capital cost allowance for capital assets used in new mines and certain mine expansions, and reduces the deduction rate for pre-production mine development expenses;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>l</I>) adjusts the five-year phase-out of the additional deduction for credit unions;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>m</I>) eliminates unintended tax benefits in respect of two types of leveraged life insurance arrangements;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>n</I>) clarifies the restricted farm loss rules and increases the restricted farm loss deduction limit;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>o</I>) enhances corporate anti-loss trading rules to address planning that avoids those rules;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>p</I>) extends, in certain circumstances, the reassessment period for taxpayers who have failed to correctly report income from a specified foreign property on their annual income tax return;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>q</I>) extends the application of Canada’s thin capitalization rules to Canadian resident trusts and non-resident entities; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>r</I>) introduces new administrative monetary penalties and criminal offences to deter the use, possession, sale and development of electronic suppression of sales software that is designed to falsify records for the purpose of tax evasion.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Part 1 also implements other selected income tax measures. Most notably, it</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) implements measures announced on July 25, 2012, including measures that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(i) relate to the taxation of specified investment flow-through entities, real estate investment trusts and publicly-traded corporations, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(ii) respond to the <I>Lewin</I> decision;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) implements measures announced on December 21, 2012, including measures that relate to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(i) the computation of adjusted taxable income for the purposes of the alternative minimum tax,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(ii) the prohibited investment and advantage rules for registered plans, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(iii) the corporate reorganization rules; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>c</I>) clarifies that information may be provided to the Department of Employment and Social Development for a program for temporary foreign workers.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Part 2 implements certain goods and services tax and harmonized sales tax (GST/HST) measures proposed in the March 21, 2013 budget by</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) introducing new administrative monetary penalties and criminal offences to deter the use, possession, sale and development of electronic suppression of sales software that is designed to falsify records for the purpose of tax evasion; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) clarifying that the GST/HST provision, exempting supplies by a public sector body (PSB) of a property or a service if all or substantially all of the supplies of the property or service by the PSB are made for free, does not apply to supplies of paid parking.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Part 3 enacts and amends several Acts in order to implement various measures.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 1 of Part 3 amends the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I> to extend and expand a temporary measure to refund a portion of employer premiums for small businesses. It also amends that Act to modify the Employment Insurance premium rate-setting mechanism, including setting the 2015 and 2016 rates and requiring that the rate be set on a seven-year break-even basis by the Canada Employment Insurance Commission beginning with the 2017 rate. The Division repeals the <I>Canada Employment Insurance Financing Board Act</I> and related provisions of other Acts. Lastly, it makes technical amendments to the <I>Employment Insurance (Fishing) Regulations</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 2 of Part 3 amends the <I>Trust and Loan Companies Act</I>, the <I>Bank Act</I> and the <I>Insurance Companies Act</I> to remove the prohibition against federal and provincial Crown agents and federal and provincial government employees being directors of a federally regulated financial institution. It also amends the <I>Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</I> and the <I>Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</I> to remove the obligation of certain persons to give the Minister of Finance notice of their intent to borrow money from a federally regulated financial institution or from a corporation that has deposit insurance under the <I>Canada Deposit Insurance Corporation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 3 of Part 3 amends the <I>Trust and Loan Companies Act</I>, the <I>Bank Act</I>, the <I>Insurance Companies Act</I> and the <I>Cooperative Credit Associations Act</I> to clarify the rules for certain indirect acquisitions of foreign financial institutions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 4 of Part 3 amends the <I>Criminal Code</I> to update the definition “passport” in subsection 57(5) and also amends the <I>Department of Foreign Affairs, Trade and Development Act</I> to update the reference to the Minister in paragraph 11(1)(<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 5 of Part 3 amends the <I>Canada Labour Code</I> to amend the definition of “danger” in subsection 122(1), to modify the refusal to work process, to remove all references to health and safety officers and to confer on the Minister of Labour their powers, duties and functions. It also makes consequential amendments to the <I>National Energy Board Act</I>, the <I>Hazardous Materials Information Review Act</I> and the <I>Non-smokers’ Health Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 6 of Part 3 amends the <I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I> to change the name of the Department to the Department of Employment and Social Development and to reflect that name change in the title of that Act and of its responsible Minister. In addition, the Division amends Part 6 of that Act to extend that Minister’s powers with respect to certain Acts, programs and activities and to allow the Minister of Labour to administer or enforce electronically the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>. The Division also adds the title of a Minister to the <I>Salaries Act</I>. Finally, it makes consequential amendments to several other Acts to reflect the name change.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 7 of Part 3 authorizes Her Majesty in right of Canada to hold, dispose of or otherwise deal with the Dominion Coal Blocks in any manner.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 8 of Part 3 authorizes the amalgamation of four Crown corporations that own or operate international bridges and gives the resulting amalgamated corporation certain powers. It also makes consequential amendments and repeals certain Acts.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 9 of Part 3 amends the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> to provide that agent corporations designated by the Minister of Finance may, subject to any terms and conditions of the designation, pledge any securities or cash that they hold, or give deposits, as security for the payment or performance of obligations arising out of derivatives that they enter into or guarantee for the management of financial risks.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 10 of Part 3 amends the <I>National Research Council Act</I> to reduce the number of members of the National Research Council of Canada and to create the position of Chairperson of the Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 11 of Part 3 amends the <I>Veterans Review and Appeal Board Act</I> to reduce the permanent number of members of the Veterans Review and Appeal Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 12 of Part 3 amends the <I>Canada Pension Plan Investment Board Act</I> to allow for the appointment of up to three directors who are not residents of Canada.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 13 of Part 3 amends the <I>Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act</I> to extend to the whole Act the protection for communications that are subject to solicitor-client privilege and to provide that information disclosed by the Financial Transactions and Reports Analysis Centre of Canada under subsection 65(1) of that Act may be used by a law enforcement agency referred to in that subsection only as evidence of a contravention of Part 1 of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 14 of Part 3 enacts the <I>Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act</I>, which establishes the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund. The Division also repeals the <I>Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 15 of Part 3 amends the <I>Conflict of Interest Act</I> to allow the Governor in Council to designate a person or class of persons as public office holders and to designate a person who is a public office holder or a class of persons who are public office holders as reporting public office holders, for the purposes of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 16 of Part 3 amends the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</I> to establish a new regime that provides that a foreign national who wishes to apply for permanent residence as a member of a certain economic class may do so only if they have submitted an expression of interest to the Minister and have subsequently been issued an invitation to apply.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 17 of Part 3 modernizes the collective bargaining and recourse systems provided by the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> regime. It amends the dispute resolution process for collective bargaining by removing the choice of dispute resolution method and substituting conciliation, which involves the possibility of the use of a strike as the method by which the parties may resolve impasses. In those cases where 80% or more of the positions in a bargaining unit are considered necessary for providing an essential service, the dispute resolution mechanism is to be arbitration. The collective bargaining process is further streamlined through amendments to the provision dealing with essential services. The employer has the exclusive right to determine that a service is essential and the numbers of positions that will be required to provide that service. Bargaining agents are to be consulted as part of the essential services process. The collective bargaining process is also amended by extending the timeframe within which a notice to bargain collectively may be given before the expiry of a collective agreement or arbitral award.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">In addition, the Division amends the factors that arbitration boards and public interest commissions must take into account when making awards or reports, respectively. It also amends the processes for the making of those awards and reports and removes the compensation analysis and research function from the mandate of the Public Service Labour Relations Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">The Division streamlines the recourse process set out for grievances and complaints in Part 2 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> and for staffing complaints under the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">The Division also establishes a single forum for employees to challenge decisions relating to discrimination in the public service. Grievances and complaints are to be heard by the Public Service Labour Relations Board under the grievance process set out in the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>. The process for the review of those grievances or complaints is to be the same as the one that currently exists under the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>. However, grievances and complaints related specifically to staffing complaints are to be heard by the Public Service Staffing Tribunal. Grievances relating to discrimination are required to be submitted within one year or any longer period that the Public Service Labour Relations Board considers appropriate, to reflect what currently exists under the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Furthermore, the Division amends the grievance recourse process in several ways. With the sole exception of grievances relating to issues of discrimination, employees included in a bargaining unit may only present or refer an individual grievance to adjudication if they have the approval of and are represented by their bargaining agent. Also, the process as it relates to policy grievances is streamlined, including by defining more clearly an adjudicator’s remedial power when dealing with a policy grievance.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">In addition, the Division provides for a clearer apportionment of the expenses of adjudication relating to the interpretation of a collective agreement. They are to be borne in equal parts by the employer and the bargaining agent. If a grievance relates to a deputy head’s direct authority, such as with respect to discipline, termination of employment or demotion, the expenses are to be borne in equal parts by the deputy head and the bargaining agent. The expenses of adjudication for employees who are not represented by a bargaining agent are to be borne by the Public Service Labour Relations Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Finally, the Division amends the recourse process for staffing complaints under the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> by ensuring that the right to complain is triggered only in situations when more than one employee participates in an exercise to select employees that are to be laid off. And, candidates who are found not to meet the qualifications set by a deputy head may only complain with respect to their own assessment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 18 of Part 3 establishes the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board to replace the Public Service Labour Relations Board and the Public Service Staffing Tribunal. The new Board will deal with matters that were previously dealt with by those former Boards under the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> and the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I>, respectively, which will permit proceedings under those Acts to be consolidated.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Division 19 of Part 3 adds declaratory provisions to the <I>Supreme Court Act</I>, respecting the criteria for appointing judges to the Supreme Court of Canada.</Para></Block></Bill_Part><Bill_Part Part_Type="TableProvisions" CountLines="No"><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:TABLE OF PROVISIONS--><Para TopMargin="30" Size="10" Leading="12" AllCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">TABLE OF PROVISIONS</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:A SECOND ACT TO IMPLEMENT CERTAIN PROVISIONS OF THE BUDGET TABLED IN PARLIAMENT ON MARCH 21, 2013 AND OTHER MEASURES--><Para TopMargin="24" BottomMargin="4" Size="10" Leading="12" AllCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">A SECOND ACT TO IMPLEMENT CERTAIN PROVISIONS OF THE BUDGET TABLED IN PARLIAMENT ON MARCH 21, 2013 AND OTHER MEASURES</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:SHORT TITLE--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SHORT TITLE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">1. <Tab /><I>Economic Action Plan 2013 Act, No. 2</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:MEASURES RELATING TO INCOME TAX--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">MEASURES RELATING TO INCOME TAX</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>2–120.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 2</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:EXCISE TAX ACT--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">EXCISE TAX ACT</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>121–124.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 3</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:VARIOUS MEASURES--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">VARIOUS MEASURES</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Employment Insurance--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Employment Insurance</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>125–158.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 2</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Institutions (Conflicts of Interest)--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Institutions (Conflicts of Interest)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>159–166.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 3</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Institutions (Investments)--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Institutions (Investments)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>167–173.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 4</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Passports--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Passports</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>174–175.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 5</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Labour Code--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Labour Code</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>176–203.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 6</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Changes to the Canadian Ministry--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Changes to the Canadian Ministry</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>204–238.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 7</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Dominion Coal Blocks--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Dominion Coal Blocks</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>239–248.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 8</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Reorganization of Certain Crown Corporations (Bridges)--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Reorganization of Certain Crown Corporations (Bridges)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>249–269.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 9</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Administration Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Administration Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>270.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 10</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:National Research Council Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">National Research Council Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>271–275.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 11</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Veterans Review and Appeal Board Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Veterans Review and Appeal Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>276.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 12</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Pension Plan Investment Board Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Pension Plan Investment Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>277–278.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 13</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>279–281.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 14</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>282.</B> <Tab /><B><I>Enactment of Act</I></B></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:AN ACT TO ESTABLISH THE MACKENZIE GAS PROJECT IMPACTS FUND--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">AN ACT TO ESTABLISH THE MACKENZIE GAS PROJECT IMPACTS FUND</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:SHORT TITLE--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SHORT TITLE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">1. <Tab /><I>Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:INTERPRETATION--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">INTERPRETATION</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">2. <Tab />Definitions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:DESIGNATION OF MINISTER--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">DESIGNATION OF MINISTER</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">3. <Tab />Power of Governor in Council</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PURPOSE OF ACT--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PURPOSE OF ACT</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">4. <Tab />Purpose</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:MACKENZIE GAS PROJECT IMPACTS FUND--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">MACKENZIE GAS PROJECT IMPACTS FUND</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">5. <Tab />Account established</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">6. <Tab />Charges</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">7. <Tab />Interest to be credited to Fund</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">8. <Tab />Eligible project</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">9. <Tab />Agreement with regional organizations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:AMENDMENT OF SCHEDULE--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">AMENDMENT OF SCHEDULE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">10. <Tab />Order in council</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PAYMENT OUT OF THE CONSOLIDATED REVENUE FUND--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PAYMENT OUT OF THE CONSOLIDATED REVENUE FUND</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">11. <Tab />Payment of $500,000,000</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>283–287.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 15</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Conflict of Interest Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Conflict of Interest Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>288–289.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 16</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Immigration and Refugee Protection Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>290–293.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 17</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>294–364.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 18</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Reorganization of Federal Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Boards--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Reorganization of Federal Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Boards</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>365.</B> <Tab /><B><I>Enactment of Act</I></B></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:AN ACT TO ESTABLISH THE PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">AN ACT TO ESTABLISH THE PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:SHORT TITLE--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SHORT TITLE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">1. <Tab /><I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:INTERPRETATION--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">INTERPRETATION</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">2. <Tab />Definitions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:DESIGNATION OF MINISTER--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">DESIGNATION OF MINISTER</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">3. <Tab />Power of Governor in Council</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Establishment and Composition--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Establishment and Composition</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">4. <Tab />Establishment of Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Appointment of Members--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Appointment of Members</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">5. <Tab />Qualifications</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">6. <Tab />Appointments of other members from list</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">7. <Tab />Residence of full-time members</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">8. <Tab />Appointment of members</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">9. <Tab />Oath or solemn affirmation</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Remuneration--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Remuneration</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">10. <Tab />Remuneration</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Application of Other Acts--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Application of Other Acts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">11. <Tab />Application of <I>Public Service Superannuation Act</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">12. <Tab />Application of certain Acts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Head Office and Meetings--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Head Office and Meetings</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">13. <Tab />Head office</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">14. <Tab />Services and facilities</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">15. <Tab />Meetings</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">16. <Tab />Quorum</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">17. <Tab />Attendance of part-time members at meetings</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">18. <Tab />Decision of majority</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Board’s Powers, Duties and Functions--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Board’s Powers, Duties and Functions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">19. <Tab />Powers, duties and functions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">20. <Tab />Powers of Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">21. <Tab />Frivolous matters</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">22. <Tab />Determination without oral hearing</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">23. <Tab />General power to assist parties</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">24. <Tab />Delegation by Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Chairperson--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Chairperson</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">25. <Tab />Chief executive officer</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">26. <Tab />Delegation by Chairperson</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">27. <Tab />Acting Chairperson</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Human Resources--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Human Resources</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">28. <Tab />Responsibility for human resources management</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">29. <Tab />Human resources</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">30. <Tab />Experts and advisors</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Protection--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Protection</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">31. <Tab />Evidence respecting information obtained</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">32. <Tab />No disclosure of notes and drafts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">33. <Tab />Immunity from proceedings</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Review and Enforcement of Orders and Decisions--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Review and Enforcement of Orders and Decisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">34. <Tab />No review by court</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">35. <Tab />Filing of Board’s orders in Federal Court</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Regulations--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Regulations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">36. <Tab />Regulations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Panels--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Panels</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">37. <Tab />Panels</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">38. <Tab />Member’s death or incapacity</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">39. <Tab />Powers, rights and privileges</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">40. <Tab />Panel’s decision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Witness Fees--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Witness Fees</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">41. <Tab />Payment of witness fees</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Annual Report--><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Annual Report</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">42. <Tab />Obligation to prepare report</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>366–470.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 19</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Supreme Court Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Supreme Court Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0"><B>471–472.</B> <Tab /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="16" Size="9" Leading="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Left">SCHEDULE</Para></Block></Bill_Part><Bill_Part Part_Type="MainText" CountLines="Yes" RunningHead_E="Economic Action Plan 2013, No. 2"><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="MainText_DocNo">90703</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para Style="Session_Reign">2nd Session, 41st Parliament,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para Style="Session_Reign">62 Elizabeth II, 2013</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para Style="MainBillOrigin">house of commons of canada</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para Bold="Yes" Style="MAIN@BillNo_Title">BILL C-4</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><Para Style="MAIN@ti;04">A second act to implement certain provisions of the budget tabled in Parliament on March 21, 2013 and other measures</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Her Majesty, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate and House of Commons of Canada, enacts as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:SHORT TITLE--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SHORT TITLE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Short title<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>1.</B> This Act may be cited as the <I>Economic Action Plan 2013 Act, No. 2.</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:MEASURES RELATING TO INCOME TAX--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">MEASURES RELATING TO INCOME TAX</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Income Tax Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 1 (5th Supp.)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Income Tax Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>2.</B> (1) Subsections 10(10) and (11) of the <I>Income Tax Act</I> are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10) Notwithstanding subsection (1.01), property described in an inventory of a taxpayer’s business that is an adventure or concern in the nature of trade at the end of the taxpayer’s taxation year that ends immediately before the time at which the taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event is to be valued at the cost at which the taxpayer acquired the property, or its fair market value at the end of the year, whichever is lower, and after that time the cost at which the taxpayer acquired the property is, subject to a subsequent application of this subsection, deemed to be that lower amount.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11) For the purposes of subsections 88(1.1) and 111(5), a taxpayer’s business that is at any time an adventure or concern in the nature of trade is deemed to be a business carried on at that time by the taxpayer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>3.</B> (1) Subsection 11(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Proprietor of business<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>11.</B> (1) Subject to section 34.1, if an individ- ual is a proprietor of a business, the individ- ual’s income from the business for a taxation year is deemed to be the individual’s income from the business for the fiscal periods of the business that end in the year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 22, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>4.</B> (1) Subsection 12(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>z.5</I>), by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>z.6</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>z.6</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Derivative forward agreement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>z.7</I>) the total of all amounts each of which is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) if the taxpayer acquires a property under a derivative forward agreement in the year, the amount by which the fair market value of the property at the time it is acquired by the taxpayer exceeds the cost to the taxpayer of the property, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if the taxpayer disposes of a property under a derivative forward agreement in the year, the amount by which the proceeds of disposition (within the meaning assigned by subdivision c) of the property exceeds the fair market value of the property at the time the agreement is entered into by the taxpayer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Section 12 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (2.01):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Source of income<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.02) For the purposes of this Act, if an amount is included in computing the income of a taxpayer for a taxation year because of paragraph (1)(<I>l.1</I>) and the amount is in respect of interest that is deductible by a partnership in computing its income from a particular source or from sources in a particular place, the amount is deemed to be from the particular source or from sources in the particular place, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) applies to acquisitions and dispositions of property by a taxpayer that occur</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) under a derivative forward agreement entered into after March 20, 2013 unless</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) the agreement is part of a series of agreements and the series</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(A) includes a derivative forward agreement entered into after March 20, 2013 and before July 11, 2013, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(B) has a term of 180 days or less (determined without reference to agreements entered into before March 21, 2013), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) the agreement is entered into after the final settlement of another derivative forward agreement (in this paragraph referred to as the “prior agreement”) and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(A) having regard to the source of the funds used to purchase the property to be sold under the agreement, it is reasonable to conclude that the agreement is a continuation of the prior agreement,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(B) the terms of the agreement and the prior agreement are substantially similar,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(C) the final settlement date under the agreement is before 2015,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(D) subsection (1) would not apply to any acquisitions or dispositions under the prior agreement if this subsection were read without reference to subparagraph (i), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(E) the notional amount of the agreement is at all times less than or equal to the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Bold="Yes" Style="MAIN@Formula">    (A + B + C + D + E) – (F + G)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the notional amount of the agreement when it is entered into,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an increase in the notional amount of the agreement, at or before that time, that is attrib- utable to the underlying interest,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is the amount of the taxpayer’s cash on hand immediately before March 21, 2013 that was committed, before March 21, 2013, to be invested under the agreement,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>D</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an increase, at or before that time, in the notional amount of the agreement that is attrib- utable to the final settlement of another derivative forward agreement (in this description referred to as the “terminated agreement”) if subsection (1) would not apply to any acquisitions or dispositions under the terminated agreement if this subsection were read without reference to subparagraph (i),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>E</keep><Tab />is the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="11" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(I) either</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="13" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">1. if the prior agreement was entered into before March 21, 2013, the amount, if any, by which the amount determined under clause (A) of the description of F in subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii) for the prior agreement immediately before it was finally settled exceeds the total deter-<keep>mined under</keep> clause (B) of the description of F in <keep>subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii)</keep> for the prior agreement immediately before it was finally settled, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="13" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">2. in any other case, the amount, if any, by which the amount determined under this subclause for the prior agreement immediately before it was finally settled exceeds the total determined under subclause (II) for the prior agreement immediately before it was finally settled, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="11" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(II) the total of all amounts each of which is an increase in the notional amount of the agreement before July 11, 2013 that is not otherwise described in this formula,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>F</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is a decrease in the notional amount of the agreement, at or before that time, that is attributable to the underlying interest, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>G</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is the amount of a partial settlement of the agreement, at or before that time, to the extent that it is not reinvested in the agreement;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) after March 20, 2013 and before March 22, 2018 under a derivative forward agreement entered into before March 21, 2013, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) after March 20, 2013, the term of the agreement is extended beyond 2014, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) at any time after March 20, 2013, the notional amount of the agreement exceeds the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Bold="Yes" Style="MAIN@Formula">   (A + B + C + D + E + F) – (G + H)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the notional amount of the agreement immediately before March 21, 2013,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an increase in the notional amount of the agreement, after March 20, 2013 and at or before that time, that is attributable to the underlying interest,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is the amount of the taxpayer’s cash on hand immediately before March 21, 2013 that was committed, before March 21, 2013, to be invested under the agreement,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>D</keep><Tab />is the amount, if any, of an increase, after March 20, 2013 and at or before that time, in the notional amount of the agreement as a consequence of the exercise of an over-allotment option granted before March 21, 2013,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>E</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an increase, after March 20, 2013 and at or before that time, in the notional amount of the agreement that is attributable to the final settlement of another derivative forward agreement (in this description referred to as the “terminated agreement”) if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(A) the final settlement date under the agreement is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="11" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(I) before 2015, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="11" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(II) on or before the date on which the terminated agreement, as it read immediately before March 21, 2013, was to be finally settled, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(B) subsection (1) would not apply to any acquisitions or dispositions under the terminated agreement if this subsection were read without reference to subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(i),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>F</keep><Tab />is the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(A) 5% of the notional amount of the agreement immediately before March 21, 2013, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(B) the total of all amounts each of which is an increase in the notional amount of the agreement after March 20, 2013 and before July 11, 2013 that is not otherwise described in this formula,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>G</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is a decrease in the notional amount of the agreement, after March 20, 2013 and at or before that time, that is attributable to the underlying interest, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>H</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is the amount of a partial settlement of the agreement, after March 20, 2013 and at or before that time, to the extent that it is not reinvested in the agreement; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) after March 21, 2018.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) For the purposes of subsection (3), the notional amount of a derivative forward agreement at any time is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) in the case of a purchase agreement, the fair market value at that time of the property that would be acquired under the agreement if the agreement were finally settled at that time; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) in the case of a sale agreement, the sale price of the property that would be sold under the agreement if the agreement were finally settled at that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection (2) applies to taxation years that begin after 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>5.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 12.5:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>12.6</B> (1) The definitions in section 18.3 apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Where subsection (3) applies<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsection (3) applies for a taxation year of an entity in respect of a security of the entity if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the security becomes, at a particular time in the year, a stapled security of the entity and, as a consequence, amounts described in paragraphs 18.3(3)(<I>a</I>) and (<I>b</I>) are <keep>not deduct-</keep>ible because of subsection 18.3(3);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the security (or any security for which the security was substituted) ceased, at an earlier time, to be a stapled security of any entity and, as a consequence, subsection 18.3(3) ceased to apply to deny the deductibility of amounts that would be described in paragraphs 18.3(3)(<I>a</I>) and (<I>b</I>) if the security were a stapled security; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) throughout the period that began immediately after the most recent time referred to in paragraph (<I>b</I>) and that ends at the particular time, the security (or any security for which the security was substituted) was not a stapled security of any entity.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Income inclusion<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If this subsection applies for a taxation year of an entity in respect of a security of the entity, the entity shall include in computing its income for the year each amount that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) was deducted by the entity (or by another entity that issued a security for which the security was substituted) in computing its income for a taxation year that includes any part of the period described in paragraph <keep>(2)(<I>c</I>);</keep> and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) would not have been deductible if subsection 18.3(3) had applied in respect of the amount.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deemed excess<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) For the purposes of subsection 161(1), if an amount described in paragraph (3)(<I>a</I>) is included in the income of an entity for a taxation year under subsection (3), the entity is deemed to have an excess immediately after the entity’s balance-due day for the year computed as if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the entity were resident in Canada throughout the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the entity’s tax payable for the year were equal to the tax payable by the entity on its taxable income for the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the amount were the entity’s only taxable income for the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the entity claimed no deductions under Division E for the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) the entity had not paid any amounts on account of its tax payable for the year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the tax payable determined under paragraph (<I>b</I>) had been outstanding throughout the period that begins immediately after the end of the taxation year for which the amount was deducted and that ends on the entity’s balance-due day for the year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>6.</B> (1) Paragraph 13(7)(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) if a taxpayer is deemed under paragraph 111(4)(<I>e</I>) to have disposed of and reacquired depreciable property (other than a timber resource property), the capital cost to the taxpayer of the property at the time of the reacquisition is deemed to be equal to the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the capital cost to the taxpayer of the property at the time of the disposition, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) 1/2 of the amount, if any, by which the taxpayer’s proceeds of disposition of the property exceed the capital cost to the taxpayer of the property at the time of the disposition;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 13(18.1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Ascertainment of certain property<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(18.1) For the purpose of determining whether property meets the criteria set out in the <I>Income Tax Regulations</I> in respect of prescribed energy conservation property, the <I>Technical Guide to Class 43.1 and 43.2</I>, as amended from time to time and published by the Department of Natural Resources, shall apply conclusively with respect to engineering and scientific matters.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Clause 13(21.2)(<I>e</I>)(iii)(D) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(D) that is immediately before the transferor is subject to a loss restriction event, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections 13(24) and (25) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(24) If at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event and, within the 12-month period that ended immediately before that time, the taxpayer, a partnership of which the taxpayer was a majority-interest partner or a trust of which the taxpayer was a majority-interest beneficiary (as defined in subsection 251.1(3)) acquired depreciable property (other than property that was held, by the taxpayer, partnership or trust or by a person that would be affiliated with the taxpayer if section 251.1 were read without reference to the definition “controlled” in subsection 251.1(3), throughout the period that began immediately before the 12-month period began and ended at the time the property was acquired by the taxpayer, partnership or trust) that was not used, or acquired for use, by the taxpayer, partnership or trust in a business that was carried on by it immediately before the 12-month period began</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) subject to paragraph (<I>b</I>), for the purposes of the description of A in the definition “undepreciated capital cost” in subsection (21) and of sections 127 and 127.1, the property is deemed</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) not to have been acquired by the taxpayer, partnership or trust, as the case may be, before that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) to have been acquired by it immediately after that time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the property was disposed of by the taxpayer, partnership or trust, as the case may be, before that time and was not reacquired by it before that time, for the purposes of the description of A in that definition, the property is deemed to have been acquired by it immediately before the property was disposed of.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Affiliation — subsection (24)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(25) For the purposes of subsection (24), if the taxpayer referred to in that subsection was formed or created in the 12-month period referred to in that subsection, the taxpayer is deemed to have been, throughout the period that began immediately before the 12-month period and ended immediately after it was formed or created,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in existence; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) affiliated with every person with whom it was affiliated (otherwise than because of a right referred to in paragraph 251(5)(<I>b</I>)) throughout the period that began when it was formed or created and that ended immediately before the time at which the taxpayer was subject to the loss restriction event referred to in that subsection.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsections (1), (3) and (4) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013, except that subsection 13(24) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (4), is to be read as follows before September 13, 2013:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(24) If at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event and, within the 12-month period that ended immediately before that time, the taxpayer or a partnership of which the taxpayer was a majority-interest partner acquired depreciable property (other than property that was held, by the taxpayer or partnership or by a person that would be affiliated with the taxpayer if section 251.1 were read without reference to the definition “controlled” in subsection 251.1(3), throughout the period that began immediately before the 12-month period began and ended at the time the property was acquired by the taxpayer or partnership) that was not used, or acquired for use, by the taxpayer or partnership in a business that was carried on by it immediately before the 12-month period began</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) subject to paragraph (<I>b</I>), for the purposes of the description of A in the definition “undepreciated capital cost” in subsection (21) and of sections 127 and 127.1, the property is deemed</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) not to have been acquired by the taxpayer or partnership, as the case may be, before that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) to have been acquired by it immediately after that time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the property was disposed of by the taxpayer or partnership, as the case may be, before that time and was not reacquired by it before that time, for the purposes of the description of A in that definition, the property is deemed to have been acquired by it immediately before the property was disposed of.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsection (2) comes into force, or is deemed to have come into force, on the day on which the <I>Technical Guide to Class 43.1 and 43.2</I> is first published by the Department of Natural Resources.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>7.</B> (1) Paragraph 14(12)(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) that is immediately before the transferor is subject to a loss restriction event, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>8.</B> (1) Subsection 18(4) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation on deduction of interest<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act (other than subsection (8)), in computing the income for a taxation year of a corporation or a trust from a business (other than the Canadian banking business of an authorized foreign bank) or property, no deduction shall be made in respect of that proportion of any amount otherwise deductible in computing its income for the year in respect of interest paid or payable by it on outstanding debts to specified non-residents that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the amount, if any, by which</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the average of all amounts each of which is, in respect of a calendar month that ends in the year, the greatest total amount at any time in the month of the outstanding debts to specified non-residents of the corporation or trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">exceeds</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) 1.5 times the equity amount of the corporation or trust for the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">is of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the amount determined under subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(i) in respect of the corporation or trust for the year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of the definition “outstanding debts to specified non-residents” in subsection 18(5) of the Act before paragraph (<I>b</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“outstanding debts to specified non-residents”<br />« <I>dettes impayées envers des non-résidents déterminés</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“outstanding debts to specified non-residents”, of a corporation or trust at any particular time in a taxation year, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the total of all amounts each of which is an amount outstanding at that time as or on account of a debt or other obligation to pay an amount</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that was payable by the corporation or trust to a person who was, at any time in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a specified non-resident shareholder of the corporation or a specified non-resident beneficiary of the trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) a non-resident person who was not dealing at arm’s length with a specified shareholder of the corporation or a specified beneficiary of the trust, as the case may be, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) on which any amount in respect of interest paid or payable by the corporation or trust is or would be, but for subsection (4), deductible in computing the income of the corporation or trust for the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">but does not include</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 18(5) of the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“beneficiary”<br />« <I>bénéficiaire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“beneficiary” has the same meaning as in subsection 108(1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“equity amount”<br />« <I>montant des capitaux propres</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“equity amount”, of a corporation or trust for a taxation year, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in the case of a corporation resident in Canada, the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the retained earnings of the corporation at the beginning of the year, except to the extent that those earnings include retained earnings of any other corporation,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the average of all amounts each of which is the corporation’s contributed surplus (other than any portion of that contributed surplus that arose in connection with an investment, as defined in subsection 212.3(10), to which subsection 212.3(2) applies) at the beginning of a calendar month that ends in the year, to the extent that it was contributed by a specified non-resident shareholder of the corporation, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the average of all amounts each of which is the corporation’s paid-up capital at the beginning of a calendar month that ends in the year, excluding the paid-up capital in respect of shares of any class of the capital stock of the corporation owned by a person other than a specified non-resident shareholder of the corporation,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in the case of a trust resident in Canada, the amount, if any, by which</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the average of all amounts each of which is the total amount of all equity contributions to the trust made before a calendar month that ends in the year, to the extent that the contributions were made by a specified non-resident beneficiary of the trust, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the tax-paid earnings of the trust for the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">exceeds</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the average of all amounts each of which is the total of all amounts that were paid or became payable by the trust to a beneficiary of the trust in respect of the beneficiary’s interest under the trust before a calendar month that ends in the year except to the extent that the amount is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) included in the beneficiary’s income for a taxation year because of subsection 104(13),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) an amount from which tax was deducted under Part XIII because of paragraph 212(1)(<I>c</I>), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) paid or payable to a person other than a specified non-resident beneficiary of the trust, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) in the case of a corporation or trust that is not resident in Canada, including a corporation or trust that files a return under this Part in accordance with subsection 216(1) in respect of the year, 40% of the amount, if any, by which</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the average of all amounts each of which is the cost of a property, other than an interest as a member of a partnership, owned by the corporation or trust at the beginning of a calendar month that ends in the year</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) that is used by the corporation or trust in the year in, or held by it in the year in the course of, carrying on business in Canada, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) that is an interest in real property, or a real right in immovables, in Canada, or an interest in, or for civil law a right in, timber resource properties and timber limits, in Canada, and in respect of which the corporation or trust files a return under this Part in accordance with subsection 216(1) in respect of the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">exceeds</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the average of all amounts each of which is the total of all amounts outstanding, at the beginning of a calendar month that ends in the year, as or on account of a debt or other obligation to pay an amount that was payable by the corporation or trust that may reasonably be regarded as relating to a business carried on by it in Canada or to an interest or right described in clause (i)(B), other than a debt or obligation that is included in the outstanding debts to specified non-residents of the corporation or trust;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“equity contribution”<br />« <I>apport de capitaux propres</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“equity contribution”, to a trust, means a transfer of property to the trust that is made</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in exchange for an interest as a beneficiary under the trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in exchange for a right to acquire an interest as a beneficiary under the trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) for no consideration by a person beneficially interested in the trust;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“specified beneficiary”<br />« <I>bénéficiaire déterminé</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“specified beneficiary”, of a trust at any time, means a person who at that time, either alone or together with persons with whom that person does not deal at arm’s length, has an interest as a beneficiary under the trust with a fair market value that is not less than 25% of the fair market value of all interests as a beneficiary under the trust and for the purpose of determining whether a particular person is a specified beneficiary of a trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if the particular person, or a person with whom the particular person does not deal at arm’s length, has at that time a right under a contract, in equity or otherwise, either immediately or in the future and either absolutely or contingently, to, or to acquire, an interest as a beneficiary under a trust, the particular person or the person with whom the particular person does not deal at arm’s length, as the case may be, is deemed at that time to own the interest,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the particular person, or a person with whom the particular person does not deal at arm’s length, has at that time a right under a contract, in equity or otherwise, either immediately or in the future and either absolutely or contingently to cause a trust to redeem, acquire or terminate any interest in it as a beneficiary (other than an interest held by the particular person or a person with whom the particular person does not deal at arm’s length), the trust is deemed at that time to have redeemed, acquired or terminated the interest, unless the right is not exercisable at that time because the exercise of the right is contingent on the death, bankruptcy or permanent disability of an individual, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) if the amount of income or capital of the trust that the particular person, or a person with whom the particular person does not deal at arm’s length, may receive as a beneficiary of the trust depends on the exercise by any person of, or the failure by any person to exercise, a discretionary power, that person is deemed to have fully exercised, or to have failed to exercise, the power, as the case may be;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“specified non-resident beneficiary”<br />« <I>bénéficiaire non-résident déterminé</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“specified non-resident beneficiary”, of a trust at any time, means a specified beneficiary of the trust who at that time is a non-resident person;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“tax-paid earnings”<br />« <I>bénéfices libérés d’impôt</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“tax-paid earnings”, of a trust resident in Canada for a taxation year, means the total of all amounts each of which is the amount in respect of a particular taxation year of the trust that ended before the year determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">A – B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the taxable income of the trust under this Part for the particular year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of tax payable under this Part by the trust, and all income taxes payable by the trust under the laws of a province, for the particular year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections 18(5.1) and (6) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Specified shareholder or specified beneficiary<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) For the purposes of subsections (4) to (6), if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a particular person would, but for this subsection, be a specified shareholder of a corporation or a specified beneficiary of a trust at any time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) there was in effect at that time an agreement or arrangement under which, on the satisfaction of a condition or the occurrence of an event that it is reasonable to expect will be satisfied or will occur, the particular person will cease to be a specified shareholder of the corporation or a specified beneficiary of the trust, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the purpose for which the particular person became a specified shareholder or specified beneficiary was the safeguarding of rights or interests of the particular person or a person with whom the particular person is not dealing at arm’s length in respect of any indebtedness owing at any time to the particular person or a person with whom the particular person is not dealing at arm’s length,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">the particular person is deemed not to be a specified shareholder of the corporation or a specified beneficiary of the trust, as the case may be, at that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Specified shareholder or specified beneficiary<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) For the purposes of subsections (4) to (6), a non-resident corporation is deemed to be a specified shareholder of itself and a non-resident trust is deemed to be a specified beneficiary of itself.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Property used in business — cost attribution<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.3) For the purposes of subparagraph (<I>c</I>)(i) of the definition “equity amount” in subsection (5),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if a property is partly used or held by a taxpayer in a taxation year in the course of carrying on business in Canada, the cost of the property to the taxpayer is deemed for the year to be equal to the same proportion of the cost to the taxpayer of the property (determined without reference to this subsection) that the proportion of the use or holding made of the property in the course of carrying on business in Canada in the year is of the whole use or holding made of the property in the year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if a corporation or trust is deemed to own a portion of a property of a partnership because of subsection (7) at any time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the property is deemed to have, at that time, a cost to the corporation or trust equal to the same proportion of the cost of the property to the partnership as the proportion of the debts and other obligations to pay an amount of the partnership allocated to it under subsection (7) is of the total amount of all debts and other obligations to pay an amount of the partnership, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) in the case of a partnership that carries on business in Canada, the corporation or trust is deemed to use or hold the property in the course of carrying on business in Canada to the extent the partnership uses or holds the property in the course of carrying on business in Canada for the fiscal period of the partnership that includes that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Rules — trust income<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.4) For the purposes of this Act, a trust resident in Canada may designate in its return of income under this Part for a taxation year that all or any portion of an amount paid or credited as interest by the trust, or by a partnership, in the year to a non-resident person is deemed to be income of the trust that has been paid to the non-resident person as a beneficiary of the trust, and not to have been paid or credited by the trust or the partnership as interest, to the extent that an amount in respect of the interest</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) is included in computing the income of the trust for the year under paragraph 12(1)(<I>l.1</I>); or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) is not deductible in computing the income of the trust for the year because of subsection (4).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loans made on condition<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If any loan (in this subsection referred to as the “first loan”) has been made</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) by a specified non-resident shareholder of a corporation or a specified non-resident beneficiary of a trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) by a non-resident person who was not dealing at arm’s length with a specified shareholder of a corporation or a specified non-resident beneficiary of a trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">to another person on condition that a loan (in this subsection referred to as the “second loan”) be made by any person to a particular corporation or trust, for the purposes of subsections (4) and (5), the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the amount of the first loan, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the amount of the second loan</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">is deemed to be a debt incurred by the particular corporation or trust to the person who made the first loan.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) The portion of paragraph 18(7)(<I>a</I>) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) to owe the portion (in this subsection and paragraph 12(1)(<I>l.1</I>) referred to as the “debt amount”) of each debt or other obligation to pay an amount of the partnership and to own the portion of each property of the partnership that is equal to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subparagraph 18(15)(<I>b</I>)(iii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) that is immediately before the transferor is subject to a loss restriction event, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsections (1) to (5) apply to taxation years that begin after 2013, except that if a trust that is resident in Canada on March 21, 2013 elects in writing and files the election with the Minister of National Revenue on or before the trust’s filing-due date for its first taxation year that begins after 2013,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) for the purpose of determining the trust’s equity amount, as defined in subsection 18(5) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (3), the trust is deemed</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) to not have received any equity contributions, as defined in subsection 18(5) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (3), before March 21, 2013,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) to not have paid or made payable any amount to a beneficiary of the trust before March 21, 2013, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) to have tax-paid earnings, as defined in subsection 18(5) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (3), of nil for each taxation year that ends before March 21, 2013, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) each beneficiary of the trust at the beginning of March 21, 2013 is deemed to have made an equity contribution at that time to the trust equal to the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Bold="Yes" Style="MAIN@Formula"> A/B × (C – D)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the fair market value of the beneficiary’s interest as a beneficiary under the trust at that time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the fair market value of all the beneficial interests under the trust at that time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is the total fair market value of all the properties of the trust at that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3" Bold="Yes"><keep>D</keep><Tab />is the total amount of the trust’s liabilities at that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection (6) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>9.</B> (1) Subparagraph 18.1(10)(<I>b</I>)(ii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) that is immediately before the taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>10.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following before section 19:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>18.3</B> (1) The following definitions apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“entity”<br />« <I>entité</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“entity” has the same meaning as in subsection 122.1(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“equity value”<br />« <I>valeur des capitaux propres</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“equity value” has the same meaning as in subsection 122.1(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“real estate investment trust”<br />« <I>fiducie de placement immobilier</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“real estate investment trust” has the same meaning as in subsection 122.1(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“security”<br />« <I>titre</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“security”, of an entity, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a liability of the entity;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the entity is a corporation,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a share of the capital stock of the corporation, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) a right to control in any manner whatever the voting rights of a share of the capital stock of the corporation if it can reasonably be concluded that one of the reasons that a person or partnership holds the right to control is to avoid the application of subsection (3) or 12.6(3);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) if the entity is a trust, an income or a capital interest in the trust; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) if the entity is a partnership, an interest as a member of the partnership.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“stapled security”<br />« <I>titre agrafé</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“stapled security”, of a particular entity at any time, means a particular security of the particular entity if at that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) another security (referred to in this section as the “reference security”)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) is or may be required to be transferred together or concurrently with the particular security as a term or condition of the particular security, the reference security, or an agreement or arrangement to which the particular entity (or if the reference security is a security of another entity, the other entity) is a party, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) is listed or traded with the particular security on a stock exchange or other public market under a single trading symbol;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the particular security or the reference security is listed or traded on a stock exchange or other public market; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) any of the following applies:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the reference security and the particular security are securities of the particular entity and the particular entity is a corporation, SIFT partnership or SIFT trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the reference security is a security of another entity, one of the particular entity or the other entity is a subsidiary of the other, and the particular entity or the other entity is a corporation, SIFT partnership or SIFT trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the reference security is a security of another entity and the particular entity or the other entity is a real estate investment trust or a subsidiary of a real estate investment trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“subsidiary”<br />« <I>filiale</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“subsidiary”, of a particular entity at any time, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an entity in which the particular entity holds at that time securities that have a total fair market value greater than 10% of the equity value of the entity; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) an entity that at that time is a subsidiary of an entity that is a subsidiary of the particular entity.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“transition period”<br />« <I>période de transition</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“transition period”, of an entity, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if one or more securities of the entity would have been stapled securities of the entity on October 31, 2006 and July 19, 2011 had the definition “stapled security” in this subsection come into force on October 31, 2006, the period that begins on July 20, 2011 and ends on the earliest of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) January 1, 2016,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the first day after July 20, 2011 on which any of those securities is materially altered, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the first day after July 20, 2011 on which any security of the entity becomes a stapled security other than by way of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a transaction</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) that is completed under the terms of an agreement in writing entered into before July 20, 2011 if no party to the agreement may be excused from completing the transaction as a result of amendments to this Act, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) that is not the issuance of a security in satisfaction of a right to enforce payment of an amount by the entity, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the issuance of the security in satisfaction of a right to enforce payment of an amount that became payable by the entity on another security of the entity before July 20, 2011, if the other security was a stapled security on July 20, 2011 and the issuance was made under a term or condition of the other security in effect on July 20, 2011;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if paragraph (<I>a</I>) does not apply to the entity and one or more securities of the entity would have been stapled securities of the entity on July 19, 2011 had the definition “stapled security” in this subsection come into force on July 19, 2011, the period that begins on July 20, 2011 and ends on the earliest of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) July 20, 2012,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the first day after July 20, 2011 on which any of those securities is materially altered, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the first day after July 20, 2011 on which any security of the entity becomes a stapled security other than by way of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a transaction</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) that is completed under the terms of an agreement in writing entered into before July 20, 2011 if no party to the agreement may be excused from completing the transaction as a result of amendments to this Act, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) that is not the issuance of a security in satisfaction of a right to enforce payment of an amount by the entity, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the issuance of the security in satisfaction of a right to enforce payment of an amount that became payable by the entity on another security of the entity before July 20, 2011, if the other security was a stapled security on July 20, 2011 and the issuance was made under a term or condition of the other security in effect on July 20, 2011; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) in any other case, if the entity is a subsidiary of another entity on July 20, 2011 and the other entity has a transition period, the period that begins on July 20, 2011 and ends on the earliest of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the day on which the other entity’s transition period ends,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the first day after July 20, 2011 on which the entity ceases to be a subsidiary of the other entity, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the first day after July 20, 2011 on which any security of the entity becomes a stapled security other than by way of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a transaction</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) that is completed under the terms of an agreement in writing entered into before July 20, 2011 if no party to the agreement may be excused from completing the transaction as a result of amendments to this Act, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) that is not the issuance of a security in satisfaction of a right to enforce payment of an amount by the entity, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the issuance of the security in satisfaction of a right to enforce payment of an amount that became payable by the entity on another security of the entity before July 20, 2011, if the other security was a stapled security on July 20, 2011 and the issuance was made under a term or condition of the other security in effect on July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Property representing security<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) For the purpose of determining whether a particular security of an entity is a stapled security, if a receipt or similar property (referred to in this subsection as the “receipt”) represents all or a portion of the particular security and the receipt would be described in paragraphs (<I>a</I>) and (<I>b</I>) of the definition “stapled security” in subsection (1) if it were a security of the entity, then</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the particular security is deemed to be described in those paragraphs; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a security that would be a reference security in respect of the receipt is deemed to be a reference security in respect of the particular security.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Amounts not deductible<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, in computing the income of a particular entity for a taxation year from a business or property, no deduction may be made in respect of an amount</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) that is paid or payable after July 19, 2011, unless the amount is paid or payable in respect of the entity’s transition period; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) that is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) interest paid or payable on a liability of the particular entity that is a stapled security, unless each reference security in respect of the stapled security is a liability, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if a security of the particular entity, a subsidiary of the particular entity or an entity of which the particular entity is a subsidiary is a reference security in respect of a stapled security of a real estate investment trust or a subsidiary of a real estate investment trust, an amount paid or payable to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the real estate investment trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) a subsidiary of the real estate investment trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) any person or partnership on condition that any person or partnership pays or makes payable an amount to the real estate investment trust or a subsidiary of the real estate investment trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>11.</B> (1) The portion of paragraph 20(1)(<I>e.2</I>) of the Act before clause (i)(A) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Premiums on life insurance — <keep>collateral</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e.2</I>) the least of the following amounts in respect of a life insurance policy (other than an annuity contract or LIA policy):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the premiums payable by the taxpayer under the policy in respect of the year, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of paragraph 20(1)(<I>e.2</I>) of the Act after clause (i)(C) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the net cost of pure insurance in respect of the year (other than in respect of a period after 2013 during which the policy is a 10/8 policy), as determined in accordance with the regulations, in respect of the interest in the policy referred to in clause (i)(A), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the portion, of the lesser of the amounts determined under subparagraphs (i) and (ii) in respect of the policy, that can reasonably be considered to relate to the amount owing from time to time during the year by the taxpayer to the institution under the borrowing;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 20(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>vv</I>), by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>ww</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>ww</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Derivative forward agreement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>xx</I>) in respect of a derivative forward agreement of a taxpayer, the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula"> A – B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the total of all amounts each of which is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) if the taxpayer acquires a property under the agreement in the year or a preceding taxation year, the amount by which the cost to the taxpayer of the property exceeds the fair market value of the property at the time it is acquired by the taxpayer, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if the taxpayer disposes of a property under the agreement in the year or a preceding taxation year, the amount by which the fair market value of the property at the time the agreement is entered into by the taxpayer exceeds the proceeds of disposition (within the meaning assigned by subdivision c) of the property, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the amount that is,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) if final settlement of the agreement occurs in the year and it cannot reasonably be considered that one of the main reasons for entering into the agreement is to obtain a deduction under this paragraph, the amount determined under subparagraph (i), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) in any other case, the total of all amounts included under paragraph 12(1)(<I>z.7</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s income in respect of the agreement for the year or a preceding taxation year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts deducted under this paragraph in respect of the agreement for a preceding taxation year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Section 20 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (2):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation of expression “interest” — <keep>10/8</keep> policy<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.01) For the purposes of paragraphs (1)(<I>c</I>) and (<I>d</I>), interest does not include an amount if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the amount</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) is paid, after March 20, 2013 in respect of a period after 2013, in respect of a life insurance policy that is, at the time of the payment, a 10/8 policy, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) is described in paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1); or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the amount</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) is payable, in respect of a life insurance policy, after March 20, 2013 in respect of a period after 2013 during which the policy is a 10/8 policy, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) is described in paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Paragraph 20(8)(<I>d</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the purchaser of the property sold was a partnership in which the taxpayer was, immediately after the sale, a majority-interest partner.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections (1), (2) and (4) apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsection (3) applies to acquisitions and dispositions of property to which subsection 4(1) applies.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>12.</B> Subclause 20.01(2)(<I>b</I>)(i)(A)(II) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) a partnership of which the individual is a majority-interest partner, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>13.</B> Subparagraph 28(1)(<I>a</I>)(ii) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) were in payment of or on account of an amount that would, if the income from the business were not computed in accordance with the cash method, be included in computing income from the business for that or any other year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>14.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 31(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Restricted farm loss<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>31.</B> (1) If a taxpayer’s chief source of income for a taxation year is neither farming nor a combination of farming and some other source of income that is a subordinate source of income for the taxpayer, then for the purposes of sections 3 and 111 the taxpayer’s loss, if any, for the year from all farming businesses carried on by the taxpayer is deemed to be the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraph 31(1)(<I>a</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the amount by which the total of the taxpayer’s losses for the year, determined without reference to this section and before making any deduction under section 37, from all farming businesses carried on by the taxpayer exceeds the total of the taxpayer’s incomes for the year, so determined from all such businesses, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Clause 31(1)(<I>a</I>)(ii)(B) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) $15,000, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subparagraph 31(1)(<I>b</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the amount that would be determined under subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(i) if it were read without reference to “and before making any deduction under section 37”,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 31(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Farming and manufacturing or processing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to a taxpayer for a taxation year if the taxpayer’s chief source of income for the year is a combination of farming and manufacturing or processing in Canada of goods for sale and all or substantially all output from all farming businesses carried on by the taxpayer is used in the manufacturing or processing.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections (1) to (5) apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>15.</B> Subsections 34.1(4) to (7) of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>16.</B> (1) Subsection 34.2(4) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Treatment in following year<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If an amount was included in computing the income of a corporation in respect of a partnership for the immediately preceding taxation year under subsection (2) or (3),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the portion of the amount that, because of subparagraph (5)(<I>a</I>)(i) or (ii), was income for that preceding year is deductible in computing the income of the corporation for the current taxation year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the portion of the amount that, because of subparagraph (5)(<I>a</I>)(i) or (ii), was taxable capital gains for that preceding year is deemed to be an allowable capital loss of the corporation for the current taxation year from the disposition of property.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraphs 34.2(5)(<I>a</I>)(i) to (v) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) an adjusted stub period accrual included under subsection (2) in respect of a partnership for the year is deemed to be income, and taxable capital gains from the disposition of property, having the same character and to be in the same proportions as any income and taxable capital gains that were allocated by the partnership to the corporation for all fiscal periods of the partnership ending in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) an amount included under subsection (3) in respect of a partnership for the year is deemed to be income, and taxable capital gains from the disposition of property, having the same character and to be in the same proportions as any income and taxable capital gains that were allocated by the partnership to the corporation for the particular period referred to in that subsection,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) an amount, a portion of which is deductible or is an allowable capital loss under subsection (4) in respect of a partnership for the year, is deemed to have the same character and to be in the same proportions as the income and taxable capital gains included in the corporation’s income for the immediately preceding taxation year under subsection (2) or (3) in respect of the partnership,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) an amount claimed as a reserve under subsection (11) in respect of a partnership for the year is deemed to have the same character and to be in the same proportions as the qualifying transitional income in respect of the partnership for the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) an amount, a portion of which is included in income under paragraph (12)(<I>a</I>), or is deemed to be a taxable capital gain under paragraph (12)(<I>b</I>), in respect of a partnership for the year, is deemed to have the same character and to be in the same proportions as the amount claimed as a reserve under subsection (11) in respect of the partnership for the immediately preceding taxation year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 34.2(5)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a corporation’s capital dividend account, as defined in subsection 89(1), is to be determined without reference to this section; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the reference in subparagraph 53(2)(<I>c</I>)(i.4) to an amount deducted under subsection (11) by a taxpayer includes an amount deemed to be an allowable capital loss under subparagraph (11)(<I>b</I>)(ii).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection 34.2(11) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Transitional reserve<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11) If a corporation has qualifying transitional income in respect of a partnership for a particular taxation year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the corporation may, in computing its income for the particular year, claim an amount, as a reserve, not exceeding the least of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the specified percentage for the partic- ular year of the corporation’s qualifying transitional income in respect of the partnership,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if, for the immediately preceding taxation year, an amount was claimed under this subsection in computing the corporation’s income in respect of the partnership, the amount that is the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the amount included under subsection (12) in computing the corporation’s income for the particular year in respect of the partnership, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the amount by which the corporation’s qualifying transitional income in respect of the partnership is increased in the particular year because of the application of subsections (16) and (17), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">  A – B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the corporation’s income for the particular year computed before deducting or claiming any amount under this subsection in respect of the partnership or under section 61.3 and 61.4, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an amount deductible by the corporation for the year under section 112 or 113 in respect of a dividend received by the corporation after December 20, 2012; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the portion of the amount claimed under paragraph (<I>a</I>) for the particular year that, because of subparagraph (5)(<I>a</I>)(iv), has</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a character other than capital <keep>is deduct-</keep>ible in computing the income of the corporation for the particular year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the character of capital is deemed to be an allowable capital loss of the corporation for the particular year from the disposition of property.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 34.2(12) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Inclusion of prior year reserve<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(12) Subject to subsection (5), if a reserve was claimed by a corporation under subsection (11) in respect of a partnership for the immediately preceding taxation year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the portion of the reserve that was deducted under subparagraph (11)(<I>b</I>)(i) for that preceding year is to be included in computing the income of the corporation for the current taxation year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the portion of the reserve that was deemed by subparagraph (11)(<I>b</I>)(ii) to be an allowable capital loss of the corporation for that preceding year is deemed to be a taxable capital gain of the corporation for the current taxation year from the disposition of property.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The portion of subsection 34.2(13) of the Act that is before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No reserve<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(13) No claim shall be made under subsection (11) in computing a corporation’s income for a taxation year in respect of a partnership</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) The portion of subsection 34.2(14) of the Act that is before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deemed partner<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(14) A corporation that cannot claim an amount under subsection (11) for a taxation year in respect of a partnership solely because it has disposed of its interest in the partnership is deemed for the purposes of paragraph (13)(<I>a</I>) to be a member of a partnership continuously until the end of the taxation year if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) The portion of subsection 34.2(16) of the Act that is before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Qualifying transition income adjustment — conditions for application<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(16) Subsection (17) applies for a particular taxation year of a corporation and for each subsequent taxation year for which the corporation may claim an amount under subsection (11) in respect of a partnership if the particular year is the first taxation year</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) The description of C in paragraph 34.2(17)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is nil,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subsections (1) to (9) apply to taxation years that end after March 22, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>17.</B> (1) Section 36 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies in respect of expenditures incurred in taxation years that begin after December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>18.</B> (1) Paragraph 37(1)(<I>h</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) if the taxpayer was subject to a loss restriction event before the end of the year, the amount determined for the year under subsection (6.1) with respect to the taxpayer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subsection 37(6.1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6.1) If a taxpayer was, at any time (in this subsection referred to as “that time”) before the end of a taxation year of the taxpayer, last subject to a loss restriction event, the amount determined for the purposes of paragraph (1)(<I>h</I>) for the year with respect to the taxpayer in respect of a business is the amount, if any, by which</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Clauses 37(6.1)(<I>a</I>)(i)(A) to (C) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) an expenditure described in paragraph (1)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>c</I>) that was made by the taxpayer before that time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the lesser of the amounts determined immediately before that time in respect of the taxpayer under subparagraphs (1)(<I>b</I>)(i) and (ii), as those paragraphs read on March 29, 2012, in respect of expenditures made, and property acquired, by the taxpayer before 2014, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) an amount determined in respect of the taxpayer under paragraph (1)(<I>c.1</I>) for its taxation year that ended immediately before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subparagraphs 37(6.1)(<I>a</I>)(ii) and (iii) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the total of all amounts determined in respect of the taxpayer under paragraphs (1)(<I>d</I>) to (<I>g</I>) for its taxation year that ended immediately before that time, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the amount deducted under subsection (1) in computing the taxpayer’s income for its taxation year that ended immediately before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subparagraphs 37(6.1)(<I>b</I>)(i) and (ii) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) if the business to which the amounts described in any of clauses (<I>a</I>)(i)(A) to (C) can reasonably be considered to have been related was carried on by the taxpayer for profit or with a reasonable expectation of profit throughout the year, the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the taxpayer’s income for the year from the business before making any deduction under subsection (1), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if properties were sold, leased, rented or developed, or services were rendered, in the course of carrying on the business before that time, the taxpayer’s income for the year, before making any deduction under subsection (1), from any other business substantially all the income of which was derived from the sale, leasing, rental or development, as the case may be, of similar properties or the rendering of similar services, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the total of all amounts each of which is an amount determined in respect of a preceding taxation year of the taxpayer that ended after that time equal to the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the amount determined under subparagraph (i) with respect to the taxpayer in respect of the business for that preceding year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the amount in respect of the business deducted under subsection (1) in computing the taxpayer’s income for that preceding year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The portion of paragraph 37(9.5)(<I>b</I>) of the English version of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) partnership of which a majority-interest partner is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsections (1) to (5) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013, except that, before January 1, 2014, clause 37(6.1)(<I>a</I>)(i)(B) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (3), is to be read as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the lesser of the amounts determined immediately before that time in respect of the taxpayer under subparagraphs (1)(<I>b</I>)(i) and (ii), as those paragraphs read on March 29, 2012, in respect of expenditures made, and property acquired, by the taxpayer before that time, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>19.</B> (1) Subparagraph 40(2)(<I>a</I>)(iii) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the purchaser of the property sold is a partnership in which the taxpayer was, immediately after the sale, a majority-interest partner;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraph 40(3.4)(<I>b</I>)(iii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) that is immediately before the transferor is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections 40(10) and (11) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of subsection (11)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10) Subsection (11) applies in computing at any particular time a taxpayer’s gain or loss (in this subsection and subsection (11) referred to as the “new gain” or “new loss”, as the case may be), in respect of any part (which in this subsection and subsection (11) is referred to as the “relevant part” and which may for greater certainty be the whole) of a foreign currency debt of the taxpayer, arising from a fluctuation in the value of the currency of the foreign currency debt (other than, for greater certainty, a gain or a capital loss that arises because of the application of subsection 111(12)), if at any time before the particular time the taxpayer realized a capital loss or gain in respect of the foreign currency debt because of subsection 111(12).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Gain or loss on foreign currency debt<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11) If this subsection applies, the new gain is the positive amount, or the new loss is the negative amount, as the case may be, determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">A + B – C</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if the taxpayer would, but for any application of subsection 111(12), recognize a new gain, the amount of the new gain, determined without reference to this subsection, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the taxpayer would, but for any application of subsection 111(12), recognize a new loss, the amount of the new loss, determined without reference to this subsection, multiplied by (–1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is that portion of the amount of a capital loss realized by the taxpayer at any time before the particular time, in respect of the foreign currency debt and because of subsection 111(12), that is reasonably attributable to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the relevant part of the foreign currency debt at the particular time, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the forgiven amount, if any, (as defined in subsection 80(1)) in respect of the foreign currency debt at the particular time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is that portion of the amount of a gain realized by the taxpayer at any time before the particular time, in respect of the foreign currency debt and because of subsection 111(12), that is reasonably attributable to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the relevant part of the foreign currency debt at the particular time, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the forgiven amount, if any, (as defined in subsection 80(1)) in respect of the foreign currency debt at the particular time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections (2) and (3) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>20.</B> Paragraph 44(7)(<I>c</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the former property of the taxpayer was disposed of to a partnership in which the taxpayer was, immediately after the disposition, a majority-interest partner.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>21.</B> (1) Subparagraph 50(1)(<I>b</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the corporation has during the year become a bankrupt,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>22.</B> (1) Clause 53(1)(<I>e</I>)(i)(A) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) paragraphs 38(<I>a.1</I>) to (<I>a.3</I>) and the fractions set out in the formula in paragraph 14(1)(<I>b</I>) and in subsection 14(5), paragraph 38(<I>a</I>) and subsection 41(1),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of paragraph 53(1)(<I>r</I>) of the Act before the formula is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>r</I>) if the time is before 2005, the property is an interest in, or a share of the capital stock of, a flow-through entity described in any of paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>f</I>) and (<I>h</I>) of the definition “flow-through entity” in subsection 39.1(1) and immediately after that time the taxpayer disposed of all their interests in, and shares of the capital stock of, the entity, the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 53(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>q</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>r</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>s</I>) if the property was acquired under a derivative forward agreement, any amount required to be included in respect of the property under subparagraph 12(1)(<I>z.7</I>)(i) in computing the income of the taxpayer for a taxation year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>t</I>) if the property is disposed of under a derivative forward agreement, any amount required to be included in respect of the property under subparagraph 12(1)(<I>z.7</I>)(ii) in computing the income of the taxpayer for the taxation year that includes that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Section 53 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (1.1):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Flow-through entity before 2005<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.2) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(<I>r</I>), if the fair market value of all of a taxpayer’s interests in, and shares of the capital stock of, a flow-through entity is nil when the taxpayer disposes of those interests and shares, the fair market value of each such interest or share at that time is deemed to be $1.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Paragraph 53(2)(<I>b.2</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b.2</I>) if the property is property of a taxpayer that was subject to a loss restriction event at or before that time, any amount required by paragraph 111(4)(<I>c</I>) to be deducted in computing the adjusted cost base of the property;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsection 53(2) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>u</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>v</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>w</I>) if the property was acquired under a derivative forward agreement, any amount deductible in respect of the property under paragraph 20(1)(<I>xx</I>) in computing the income of the taxpayer for a taxation year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>x</I>) if the property is disposed of under a derivative forward agreement, any amount deductible in respect of the property under paragraph 20(1)(<I>xx</I>) in computing the income of the taxpayer for the taxation year that includes that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsection (1) applies in respect of gifts made after February 25, 2008.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsections (2) and (4) apply to dispositions that occur after 2001.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsections (3), (5) and (6) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>23.</B> (1) Paragraph (<I>c</I>) of the definition “superficial loss” in section 54 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) a disposition deemed to have been made by subsection 45(1), section 48 as it read in its application before 1993, section 50 or 70, subsection 104(4), section 128.1, paragraph 132.2(3)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>c</I>), subsection 138(11.3) or 142.5(2), section 142.6 or any of subsections 144(4.1) and (4.2) and 149(10),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph (<I>f</I>) of the definition “superficial loss” in section 54 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) a disposition by a taxpayer that was subject to a loss restriction event within 30 days after the disposition,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that begin after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (2) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>24.</B> (1) Clause 55(3)(<I>a</I>)(iii)(B) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) property (other than shares of the capital stock of the dividend recipient) more than 10% of the fair market value of which was, at any time during the series, derived from any combination of shares of the capital stock and debt of the dividend payer,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Clause 55(3)(<I>a</I>)(iv)(B) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) property more than 10% of the fair market value of which was, at any time during the series, derived from any combination of shares of the capital stock and debt of the dividend recipient, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 55(3.01) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>d</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>e</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) a significant increase in the total direct interest in a corporation that would, but for this paragraph, be described in subparagraph (3)(<I>a</I>)(ii) is deemed not to be described in that subparagraph if the increase was the result of the issuance of shares of the capital stock of the corporation solely for money and the shares were redeemed, acquired or cancelled by the corporation before the dividend was received;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) a disposition of property that would, but for this paragraph, be described in subparagraph (3)(<I>a</I>)(i), or a significant increase in the total direct interest in a corporation that would, but for this paragraph, be described in subparagraph (3)(<I>a</I>)(ii), is deemed not to be described in those subparagraphs if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the dividend payer was related to the dividend recipient immediately before the dividend was received,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the dividend payer did not, as part of the series of transactions or events that includes the receipt of the dividend, cease to be related to the dividend recipient,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the disposition or increase occurred before the dividend was received,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) the disposition or increase was the result of the disposition of shares to, or the acquisition of shares of, a particular corporation, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) at the time the dividend was received, all the shares of the capital stock of the dividend recipient and the dividend payer were owned by the particular corporation, a corporation that controlled the particular corporation, a corporation controlled by the particular corporation or any combination of those corporations; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) a winding-up of a subsidiary wholly-owned corporation to which subsection 88(1) applies, or an amalgamation to which subsection 87(11) applies of a corporation with one or more subsidiary wholly-owned corporations, is deemed not to result in a significant increase in the total direct interest, or in the total of all direct interests, in the subsidiary or subsidiaries, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of paragraph 55(3.1)(<I>a</I>) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in contemplation of and before a distribution (other than a distribution by a specified corporation) made in the course of the reorganization in which the dividend was received, property became property of the distributing corporation, a corporation controlled by it or a predecessor corporation of any such corporation otherwise than as a result of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Clause 55(3.1)(<I>c</I>)(i)(A) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) as a result of a disposition</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) in the ordinary course of business, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) before the distribution for consideration that consists solely of money or indebtedness that is not convertible into other property, or of any combination of the two,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Clause 55(3.1)(<I>d</I>)(i)(A) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) as a result of a disposition</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) in the ordinary course of business, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) before the distribution for consideration that consists solely of money or indebtedness that is not convertible into other property, or of any combination of the two,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsections (1) and (2) apply in respect of dividends received after December 20, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsections (3) to (6) apply in respect of dividends received after 2003.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>25.</B> (1) Subparagraph 56(1)(<I>a</I>)(i) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of clause (E), by adding “and” at the end of clause (F) and by adding the following after clause (F):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(G) an amount received out of or under a registered pension plan as a return of all or a portion of a contribution to the plan to the extent that the amount</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) is a payment made to the taxpayer under subsection 147.1(19) or subparagraph 8502(<I>d</I>)(iii) of the <I>Income Tax Regulations,</I> and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) is not deducted in computing the taxpayer’s income for the year or a preceding taxation year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 56(8) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Prestations du RPC/RRQ pour années antérieures<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">(8) Malgré les paragraphes (1) et (6), dans le cas où une ou plusieurs sommes sont reçues par un particulier (sauf une fiducie) au cours d’une année d’imposition au titre ou en paiement intégral ou partiel d’une prestation prévue par le <I>Régime de pensions du Canada</I> ou par un régime provincial de pensions au sens de l’article 3 de cette loi ou seraient incluses, en l’absence du présent paragraphe, dans le calcul de son revenu pour une année d’imposition en application du paragraphe (6) et qu’une partie d’au moins 300 $ du total de ces sommes se rapporte à une ou plusieurs années d’imposition antérieures, le particulier n’a pas à inclure cette partie dans son revenu, s’il en fait le choix.</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 56(8)(<I>a</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) one or more amounts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) are received by an individual (other than a trust) in a taxation year as, on account of, in lieu of payment of or in satisfaction of, any benefit under the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I> or a provincial pension plan as defined in section 3 of that Act, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) would be, but for this subsection, included in computing the income of an individual for a taxation year under subsection (6), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (1) applies to contributions made on or after the later of January 1, 2014 and the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsections (2) and (3) apply to the 2006 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>26.</B> (1) Subparagraph 60(<I>q</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the amount has been included in computing the income of the taxpayer for the year or a preceding taxation year as an amount described in subparagraph 56(1)(<I>n</I>)(i) or paragraph 56(1)(<I>o</I>) paid to the taxpayer by the payer,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 1, 1994.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>27.</B> (1) Section 60.001 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to orders made after the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>28.</B> The portion of subsection 60.1(1) of the French version of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Pension alimentaire<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><B>60.1</B> (1) Pour l’application de l’alinéa 60<I>b</I>) et du paragraphe 118(5), dans le cas où une ordonnance ou un accord, ou une modification s’y rapportant, prévoit le paiement d’un montant par un contribuable à une personne ou à son profit, au profit d’enfants confiés à sa garde ou à la fois au profit de la personne et de ces enfants, le montant ou une partie de celui-ci est réputé :</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>29.</B> Section 60.11 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>30.</B> (1) Subsections 66(11.4) and (11.5) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11.4) If</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) within the 12-month period that ended immediately before that time, the taxpayer, a partnership of which the taxpayer was a majority-interest partner or a trust of which the taxpayer was a majority-interest beneficiary (as defined in subsection 251.1(3)) acquired a Canadian resource property or a foreign resource property (other than a property that was held, by the taxpayer, partnership or trust or by a person that would be affiliated with the taxpayer if section 251.1 were read without reference to the definition “controlled” in subsection 251.1(3), throughout the period that began immediately before the 12-month period began and ended at the time the property was acquired by the taxpayer, partnership or trust), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) immediately before the 12-month period began the taxpayer, partnership or trust was not, or would not be if it were a corporation, a principal-business corporation,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">for the purposes of subsection (4) and sections 66.2, 66.21 and 66.4, except as those provisions apply for the purposes of section 66.7, the property is deemed not to have been acquired by the taxpayer, partnership or trust, as the case may be, before that time, except that if the property has been disposed of by it before that time and not reacquired by it before that time, the property is deemed to have been acquired by the taxpayer, partnership or trust, as the case may be, immediately before it disposed of the property.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Affiliation — subsection (11.4)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11.5) For the purposes of subsection (11.4), if the taxpayer referred to in that subsection was formed or created in the 12-month period referred to in that subsection, the taxpayer is deemed to have been, throughout the period that began immediately before the 12-month period and ended immediately after it was formed or created,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in existence; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) affiliated with every person with whom it was affiliated (otherwise than because of a right referred to in paragraph 251(5)(<I>b</I>)) throughout the period that began when it was formed or created and that ended immediately before the time at which the taxpayer was subject to the loss restriction event referred to in that subsection.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Trust loss restriction event — <keep>successor</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11.6) If at any time a trust is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) for the purposes of the provisions of this Act relating to deductions in respect of drilling and exploration expenses, prospecting, exploration and development expenses, Canadian exploration and development expenses, foreign resource pool expenses, Canadian exploration expenses, Canadian development expenses and Canadian oil and gas property expenses (in this subsection referred to as “resource expenses”) incurred by the trust before that time, the following rules apply:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the trust is (other than for purposes of this subsection and subsections (11.4), (11.5) and 66.7(10) to (11)) deemed to be a corporation that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) after that time is a successor (within the meaning assigned by any of subsections 66.7(1), (2) and (2.3) to (5)), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) at that time, acquired all the properties held by the trust immediately before that time from an original owner of those properties,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if the trust did not hold a foreign resource property immediately before that time, the trust is deemed to have owned a foreign resource property immediately before that time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) a joint election is deemed to have been filed in accordance with subsections 66.7(7) and (8) in respect of the acquisition described in clause (i)(B),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) the resource expenses incurred by the trust before that time are deemed to have been incurred by an original owner of the properties and not by the trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) the original owner is deemed to have been resident in Canada at every time before that time at which the trust was resident in Canada,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) if at that time the trust is a member of a partnership and the property of the partnership includes a Canadian resource property or a foreign resource property,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) for the purposes of clause (i)(B), the trust is deemed to have held immediately before that time that portion of the partnership’s property at that time that is equal to the trust’s percentage share of the total of amounts that would be paid to all members of the partnership if it were wound up at that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) for the purposes of clauses 66.7(1)(<I>b</I>)(i)(C) and (2)(<I>b</I>)(i)(B), subparagraph 66.7(2.3)(<I>b</I>)(i) and clauses 66.7(3)(<I>b</I>)(i)(C), (4)(<I>b</I>)(i)(B) and <keep>(5)(<I>b</I>)(i)(B)</keep> for a taxation year that <keep>ends after</keep> that time, the lesser of the <keep>following</keep> amounts is deemed to be income of the trust for the year that can reasonably be regarded as attributable to production from the property:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) the trust’s share of the part of the income of the partnership for the fiscal period of the partnership that ends in the year that can reasonably be regarded as attributable to the production from the property, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) an amount that would be determined under subclause (I) for the year if the trust’s share of the income of the partnership for the fiscal period of the partnership that ends in the year were determined on the basis of the percentage share referred to in clause (A), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vii) if after that time the trust disposes of property that was at that time held by the trust to another person, subsections 66.7(1) to (5) do not apply in respect of the acquisition by the other person of the property; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if before that time, the trust or a partnership of which the trust was a member acquired a property that is a Canadian resource property, a foreign resource property or an interest in a partnership and it can reasonably be considered that one of the main purposes of the acquisition is to avoid any limitation provided in any of subsections 66.7(1) to (5) on the deduction in respect of any expenses incurred by the trust, then the trust or the partnership, as the case may be, is deemed, for the purposes of applying those subsections to or in respect of the trust, not to have acquired the property.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraph 66(12.66)(<I>b</I>)(ii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) would be described in paragraph (<I>h</I>) <keep>of the</keep> definition “<keep>Canadian exploration</keep> expense” in subsection 66.1(6) if the <keep>reference</keep> to “paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>) and (<I>f</I>) to (<I>g.4</I>)” in that paragraph were read as “paragraphs (<I>a</I>), (<I>d</I>), (<I>f</I>) and (<I>g.1</I>)”, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013, except that subsection 66(11.4) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (1), is to be read as follows before September 13, 2013:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11.4) If</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) within the 12-month period that ended immediately before that time, the taxpayer or a partnership of which the taxpayer was a majority-interest partner acquired a Canadian resource property or a foreign resource property (other than a property that was held, by the taxpayer or partnership or by a person that would be affiliated with the taxpayer if section 251.1 were read without reference to the definition “controlled” in subsection 251.1(3), throughout the period that began immediately before the 12-month period began and ended at the time the property was acquired by the taxpayer or partnership), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) immediately before the 12-month period began the taxpayer or partnership was not, or would not be if it were a corporation, a principal-business corporation,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">for the purposes of subsection (4) and sections 66.2, 66.21 and 66.4, except as those provisions apply for the purposes of section 66.7, the property is deemed not to have been acquired by the taxpayer or partnership, as the case may be, before that time, except that if the property has been disposed of by it before that time and not reacquired by it before that time, the property is deemed to have been acquired by the taxpayer or partnership, as the case may be, immediately before it disposed of the property.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (2) is deemed to have come into force on March 22, 2011, except that before March 21, 2013 subparagraph 66(12.66)(<I>b</I>)(ii) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (2), is to be read as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) would be described in paragraph (<I>h</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6) if the reference to “paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>) and (<I>f</I>) to (<I>g.2</I>)” in that paragraph were read as “paragraphs (<I>a</I>), (<I>d</I>), (<I>f</I>) and (<I>g.1</I>)”, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>31.</B> (1) The definition “Canadian renewable and conservation expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“Canadian renewable and conservation expense”<br />« <I>frais liés aux énergies renouvelables et à l’économie d’énergie au Canada</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Canadian renewable and conservation expense” has the meaning assigned by regulation, and for the purpose of determining whether an outlay or expense in respect of a prescribed energy conservation property is a Canadian renewable and conservation expense, the <I>Technical Guide to Canadian Renewable and Conservation Expenses (CRCE)</I>, as amended from time to time and published by the Department of Natural Resources, shall apply conclusively with respect to engineering and scientific matters;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph (<I>g</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) any expense incurred by the taxpayer after November 16, 1978 and before March 21, 2013 for the purpose of bringing a new mine in a mineral resource in Canada, other than a bituminous sands deposit or an oil shale deposit, into production in reasonable commercial quantities and incurred before the new mine comes into production in such quantities, including an expense for clearing, removing overburden, stripping, sinking a mine shaft or constructing an adit or other underground entry, but not including any expense that results in revenue or can reasonably be expected to result in reve-<keep>nue earned</keep> before the new mine comes <keep>into production</keep> in reasonable commercial <keep>quantities,</keep> except to the extent that the total of all such expenses exceeds the total of those revenues,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>g.2</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g.3</I>) any expense incurred by the taxpayer that would be described in paragraph (<I>g</I>) if the reference to “March 21, 2013” in that paragraph were “2017” and that is incurred</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) under an agreement in writing entered into by the taxpayer before March 21, 2013, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) as part of the development of a new mine, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the construction of the new mine was started by, or on behalf of, the taxpayer before March 21, 2013 (and for this purpose construction does not include obtaining permits or regulatory approvals, conducting environmental assessments, community consultations or impact benefit studies, and similar activities), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the engineering and design work for the construction of the new mine, as evidenced in writing, was started by, or on behalf of, the taxpayer before March 21, 2013 (and for this purpose engineering and design work does not include obtaining permits or regulatory approvals, conducting environmental assessments, community consultations or impact benefit studies, and similar activities),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g.4</I>) any expense incurred by the taxpayer, the amount of which is determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula"> A × B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is an expense that would be described in paragraph (<I>g</I>) if the reference to “March 21, 2013” in that paragraph were “2018” and that is not described in paragraph (<I>g.3</I>), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) 100% if the expense is incurred before 2015,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) 80% if the expense is incurred in 2015,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) 60% if the expense is incurred in 2016, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) 30% if the expense is incurred in 2017,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Paragraph (<I>h</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) subject to section 66.8, the taxpayer’s share of any expense referred to in any of paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>) and (<I>f</I>) to (<I>g.4</I>) incurred by a partnership in a fiscal period of the partnership, if at the end of the period the taxpayer is a member of the partnership, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) The description of A in the definition “eligible oil sands mine development expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is an expense that would be a Canadian exploration expense of the taxpayer described in paragraph (<I>g</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” if that paragraph were read without reference to “and before March 21, 2013” and “other than a bituminous sands deposit or an oil shale deposit”, but does not include an expense that is a specified oil sands mine development expense, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “specified oil sands mine development expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) would be a Canadian exploration expense described in paragraph (<I>g</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” if that paragraph were read without reference to “and before March 21, 2013” and “other than a bituminous sands deposit or an oil shale deposit”,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsections (2), (3), (5) and (6) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsection (4) is deemed to have come into force on March 22, 2011, except that before March 21, 2013 paragraph (<I>h</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (4), is to be read as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) subject to section 66.8, the taxpayer’s share of any expense referred to in any of paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>) and (<I>f</I>) to (<I>g.2</I>) incurred by a partnership in a fiscal period of the partnership, if at the end of the period the taxpayer is a member of the partnership, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>32.</B> (1) The definition “Canadian development expense” in subsection 66.2(5) of the Act is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>c.1</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c.2</I>) any expense, or portion of any expense, that is not a Canadian exploration expense, incurred by the taxpayer after March 20, 2013 for the purpose of bringing a new mine in a mineral resource in Canada, other than a bituminous sands deposit or an oil shale deposit, into production in reasonable commercial quantities and incurred before the new mine comes into production in such quantities, including an expense for clearing, removing overburden, stripping, sinking a mine shaft or constructing an adit or other underground entry,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>33.</B> (1) Subparagraph 67.1(2)(<I>e</I>)(iii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) is paid or payable in respect of the taxpayer’s duties performed at a work site in Canada that is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) outside any population centre, as defined by the last Census Dictionary published by Statistics Canada before the year, that has a population of at least 40,000 individuals as determined in the last census published by <keep>Statistics Can-</keep>ada before the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) at least 30 kilometres from the nearest point on the boundary of the nearest such population centre;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to the 2013 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>34.</B> (1) Section 70 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (5.3):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Fair market value<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.31) For the purposes of subsections (5) and 104(4), the fair market value at any time of any property deemed to have been disposed of at that time as a consequence of a particular individual’s death is to be determined as though the fair market value at that time of any annuity contract were the total of all amounts each of which is the amount of a premium paid on or before that time under the contract if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the contract is, in respect of an LIA policy, a contract referred to in subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii) of the definition “LIA policy” in subsection 248(1); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the particular individual is the individual, in respect of the LIA policy, referred to in that subparagraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>35.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 75(2) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Trusts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If a trust, that is resident in Canada and that was created in any manner whatever since 1934, holds property on condition</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraphs 75(3)(<I>c</I>) to (<I>c.3</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) by a qualifying environmental trust; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections (1) and (2) apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>36.</B> (1) The definition “relevant loss balance” in subsection 80(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“relevant loss balance”<br />« <I>solde de pertes applicable</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“relevant loss balance”, at a particular time for a commercial obligation and in respect of a debtor’s non-capital loss, farm loss, restricted farm loss or net capital loss, as the case may be, for a particular taxation year, is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) subject to paragraph (<I>b</I>), the amount of such loss that would be deductible in computing the debtor’s taxable income or taxable income earned in Canada, as the case may be, for the taxation year that includes that time if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the debtor had sufficient incomes from all sources and sufficient taxable capital gains,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) subsections (3) and (4) did not apply to reduce such loss at or after that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) paragraph 111(4)(<I>a</I>) and subsection 111(5) did not apply to the debtor, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) nil if the debtor is a taxpayer that was at a previous time subject to a loss restriction event and the particular year ended before the previous time, unless</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the obligation was issued by the debtor before, and not in contemplation of, the loss restriction event, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) all or substantially all of the proceeds from the issue of the obligation were used to satisfy the principal amount of another obligation to which subparagraph (i) or this subparagraph would apply if the other obligation were still outstanding;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of the definition “unrecognized loss” in subsection 80(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>b</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“unrecognized loss”<br />« <I>perte non constatée</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“unrecognized loss”, at a particular time, in respect of an obligation issued by a debtor, from the disposition of a property, is the amount that would, but for subparagraph 40(2)(<I>g</I>)(ii), be a capital loss from the disposition by the debtor at or before the particular time of a debt or other right to receive an amount, except that if the debtor is a taxpayer that is subject to a loss restriction event before the particular time and after the time of the disposition, the unrecognized loss at the particular time in respect of the obligation is nil unless</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the obligation was issued by the debtor before, and not in contemplation of, the loss restriction event, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subparagraph 80(15)(<I>c</I>)(iv) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) if the member is a taxpayer that was subject to a loss restriction event at a particular time that is before the end of that fiscal period and before the taxpayer became a member of the partnership, and the partnership obligation was issued before the particular time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) subject to the application of this subparagraph to the taxpayer after the particular time and before the end of that fiscal period, the obligation referred to in subparagraph (i) is deemed to have been issued by the member after the particular time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii) of the definition “relevant loss balance” in subsection (1), paragraph (<I>f</I>) of the definition “successor pool” in that subsection and paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “unrecognized loss” in that subsection do not apply in respect of the loss restriction event, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections (1) to (3) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>37.</B> (1) Paragraph 80.04(4)(<I>h</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) if the transferee is a taxpayer that is subject to a loss restriction event after the time of issue and the transferee and the debtor were, if the transferee is a corporation, not related to each other — or, if the transferee is a trust, not affiliated with each other — immediately before the loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the obligation referred to in paragraph (<I>e</I>) is deemed to have been issued after the loss restriction event, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii) of the definition “relevant loss balance” in subsection 80(1), paragraph (<I>f</I>) of the definition “successor pool” in that subsection and paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “unrecognized loss” in that subsection do not apply in respect of the loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>38.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 80.5:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Synthetic disposition<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>80.6</B> (1) If a synthetic disposition arrangement is entered into in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer and the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement is one year or more, the taxpayer is deemed</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) to have disposed of the property immediately before the beginning of the synthetic disposition period for proceeds equal to its fair market value at the beginning of the synthetic disposition period; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) to have reacquired the property at the beginning of the synthetic disposition period at a cost equal to that fair market value.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the disposition referred to in subsection (1) would not result in the realization of a capital gain or income;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the property is a mark-to-market property (as defined in subsection 142.2(1)) of the taxpayer;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the synthetic disposition arrangement referred to in subsection (1) is a lease of tangible property or, for civil law, corporeal property;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the arrangement is an exchange of property to which subsection 51(1) applies; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) the property is disposed of as part of the arrangement, within one year after the day on which the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement begins.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to agreements and arrangements entered into after March 20, 2013. Subsection (1) also applies to an agreement or arrangement entered into before March 21, 2013, the term of which is extended after March 20, 2013, as if the agreement or arrangement were entered into at the time of the extension.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>39.</B> (1) Paragraph 87(2)(<I>g.1</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g.1</I>) for the purposes of sections 12.4 and 26, subsection 97(3) and section 256.1, the new corporation is deemed to be the same corporation as, and a continuation of, each predecessor corporation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 87(2)(<I>oo.1</I>) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subparagraph (ii), by adding “and” at the end of subparagraph (iii) and by adding the following after subparagraph (iii):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) a qualifying income limit for the particular year equal to the total of all amounts each of which is a predecessor corporation’s qualifying income limit for its taxation year that ended immediately before the amalgamation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (2) applies to amalgamations that occur after February 25, 2008.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>40.</B> (1) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>c.2</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) “specified person”, at any time, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the parent,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) each person who would be related to the parent at that time if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) this Act were read without reference to paragraph 251(5)(<I>b</I>), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) each person who is the child of a deceased individual were related to each brother or sister of the individual and to each child of a deceased brother or sister of the individual, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) if the time is before the incorporation of the parent, each person who is described in clause (B) throughout the period that begins at the time the parent is incorporated and ends at the time that is immediately before the beginning of the winding-up,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i.1) a person described in clause (i)(B) or (C) is deemed not to be a specified person if it can reasonably be considered that one of the main purposes of one or more transactions or events is to cause the person to be a specified person so as to prevent a property that is distributed to the parent on the winding-up from being an ineligible property for the purposes of paragraph (<I>c</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>c.2</I>)(iii) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of clause (A) and by adding the following after clause (A):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A.1) a corporation controlled by another corporation is, at any time, deemed not to own any shares of the capital stock of the other corporation if, at that time, the corporation does not have a direct or an indirect interest in any of the shares of the capital stock of the other corporation,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A.2) the definition “specified shareholder” in subsection 248(1) is to be read without reference to its paragraph (<I>a</I>) in respect of any share of the capital stock of the subsidiary that the person would, but for this clause, be deemed to own solely because the person has a right described in paragraph 251(5)(<I>b</I>) to acquire shares of the capital stock of a corporation that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) is controlled by the subsidiary, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) does not have a direct or an indirect interest in any of the shares of the capital stock of the subsidiary, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 88(1)(<I>c.2</I>) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subparagraph (ii), by adding “and” at the end of subparagraph (iii) and by adding the following after subparagraph (iii):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) property that is distributed to the parent on the winding-up is deemed not to be acquired by a person if the person acquired the property before the acquisition of control referred to in clause (<I>c</I>)(vi)(A) and the property is not owned by the person at any time after that acquisition of control;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>c.3</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) property (other than a specified property) owned by the person at any time after the acquisition of control referred to in clause (<I>c</I>)(vi)(A) more than 10% of the fair market value of which is, at that time, attributable to the particular property or properties, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>c.4</I>)(ii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) an indebtedness that was issued</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) by the parent as consideration for the acquisition of a share of the capital stock of the subsidiary by the parent, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) for consideration that consists sole- <keep>ly of</keep> money,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subparagraphs 88(1)(<I>c.4</I>)(v) and (vi) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) if the subsidiary was formed on the amalgamation of two or more predecessor corporations at least one of which was a subsidiary wholly-owned corporation of the parent,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a share of the capital stock of the subsidiary that was issued on the amalgamation and that is, before the beginning of the winding-up,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) redeemed, acquired or cancelled by the subsidiary for consideration that consists solely of money or shares of the capital stock of the parent, or of any combination of the two, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) exchanged for shares of the capital stock of the parent, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) a share of the capital stock of the parent issued on the amalgamation in exchange for a share of the capital stock of a predecessor corporation, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) a share of the capital stock of a corporation issued to a person described in clause (<I>c</I>)(vi)(B) if all the shares of the capital stock of the subsidiary were acquired by the parent for consideration that consists solely of money;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Paragraph 88(1)(<I>c.4</I>) of the Act, as amended by subsection (6), is amended by adding “and” at the end of subparagraph (iv), by striking out “and” at the end of subparagraph (v) and by repealing subparagraph (vi).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection 88(1) of the Act is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>c.8)</I>:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c.9</I>) for the purposes of paragraph (<I>c.4</I>), a reference to a share of the capital stock of a corporation includes a right to acquire a share of the capital stock of the corporation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>d</I>)(ii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the amount designated in respect of any such capital property may not exceed the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">  A – (B + C)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the fair market value of the property at the time the parent last acquired control of the subsidiary,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the greater of the cost amount to the subsidiary of the property at the time the parent last acquired control of the subsidiary and the cost amount to the subsidiary of the property immediately before the winding-up, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is the prescribed amount, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>e.9</I>)(i) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of clause (A), by adding “and” at the end of clause (B) and by adding the following after clause (B):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) the parent’s qualifying income limit for that last year is deemed to be the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) its qualifying income limit (determined before applying this paragraph to the winding-up) for that last year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) the total of the subsidiary’s qual- ifying income limits (determined without reference to subparagraph (iii)) for its taxation years that ended in that preceding calendar year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(11) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>e.9</I>)(ii) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of clause (A), by adding “and” at the end of clause (B) and by adding the following after clause (B):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) the parent’s qualifying income limit for that preceding taxation year is deemed to be the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) its qualifying income limit (determined before applying this paragraph to the winding-up) for that preceding taxation year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) the total of the subsidiary’s qual- ifying income limits (determined without reference to subparagraph (iii)) for the subsidiary’s taxation years that end in the calendar year in which that preceding taxation year ended, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(12) Subparagraph 88(1)(<I>e.9</I>)(iii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) where the parent and the subsidiary are associated with each other in the current year, the subsidiary’s taxable income, the subsidiary’s business limit and the subsidiary’s qualifying income limit for each taxation year that ends after the first time that the parent receives an asset of the subsidiary on the winding-up are deemed to be nil;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(13) Subsections (1) to (3), (5), (6) and (8) apply to windings-up that begin, and amalgamations that occur, after 2001.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(14) Subsection (4) applies to windings-up that begin, and amalgamations that occur, after December 20, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(15) Subsections (7) and (9) apply to windings-up that begin, and amalgamations that occur, after December 20, 2012 other than — if a taxable Canadian corporation (in this subsection referred to as the “parent corporation”) has acquired control of another taxable Canadian corporation (in this subsection referred to as the “subsidiary corporation”) — an amalgamation of the parent corporation and the subsidiary corporation that occurs, or a winding-up of the subsidiary corporation into the parent corporation that begins, before July 2013 if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) the parent corporation acquired control of the subsidiary corporation before December 21, 2012, or was obligated as evidenced in writing before December 21, 2012 to acquire control of the subsidiary corporation (except that the parent corporation shall not be considered to be obligated if, as a result of amendments to the Act, it may be excused from the obligation to acquire control); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the parent corporation had the intention as evidenced in writing before December 21, 2012 to amalgamate with, or wind up, the subsidiary corporation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(16) Subsections (10) to (12) apply to windings-up that begin after February 25, 2008.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>41.</B> (1) The portion of paragraph (<I>d</I>) of the definition “capital dividend account” in subsection 89(1) of the Act after subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) all amounts each of which is the proceeds of a life insurance policy (other than an LIA policy) of which the corporation was not a beneficiary on or before June 28, 1982 received by the corporation in the period and after May 23, 1985 in consequence of the death of any person</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">exceeds the total of all amounts each of which is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the adjusted cost basis (within the meaning assigned by subsection 148(9)) of a policy referred to in subparagraph (i) or (ii) to the corporation immediately before the death, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) if the policy is a 10/8 policy immediately before the death and the death occurs after 2013, the amount outstanding, immediately before the death, of the borrowing that is described in subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(i) of the definition “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1) in respect of the policy,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>(2)</B> Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>42.</B> (1) Subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(vi) of the definition “arm’s length transfer” in subsection 94(1) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) a payment made before 2002 to a trust, to a corporation controlled by a trust or to a partnership of which a trust is a majority-interest partner in repayment of or otherwise in respect of a loan made by a trust, corporation or partnership to the transferor, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(vii) of the definition “arm’s length transfer” in subsection 94(1) of the English version of the Act before clause (A) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vii) a payment made after 2001 to a trust, to a corporation controlled by the trust or to a partnership of which the trust is a majority-interest partner, in repayment of or otherwise in respect of a particular loan made by the trust, corporation or partnership to the transferor and either</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii) of the definition “specified party” in subsection 94(1) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) would be a controlled foreign affiliate of a partnership, of which the particular person is a majority-interest partner, if the partnership were a person resident in Canada at that time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of paragraph (<I>c</I>) of the definition “specified party” in subsection 94(1) of the English version of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) a person, or a partnership of which the particular person is a majority-interest partner, for which it is reasonable to conclude that the benefit referred to in subparagraph (8)(<I>a</I>)(iv) was conferred</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) The portion of paragraph (<I>d</I>) of the definition “specified party” in subsection 94(1) of the English version of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) a corporation in which the particular person, or partnership of which the particular person is a majority-interest partner, is a shareholder if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Paragraph 94(4)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) subsections (8.1) and (8.2), paragraph (14)(<I>a</I>), subsections 70(6) and 73(1), the definition “Canadian partnership” in subsection 102(1), paragraph 107.4(1)(<I>c</I>) and paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “mutual fund trust” in subsection 132(6);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Paragraph 94(4)(<I>h</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) determining whether subsection 75(2) applies.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Section 94 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (8):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of subsection (8.2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8.1) Subsection (8.2) applies at any time to a particular person, and to a particular property, in respect of a non-resident trust, if at that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the particular person is resident in Canada; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the trust holds the particular property on condition that the particular property or property substituted for the particular property</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) revert to the particular person, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) pass to one or more persons or partnerships to be determined by the particular person, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) shall not be disposed of by the trust during the existence of the particular person, except with the particular person’s consent or in accordance with the particular person’s direction.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deemed transfer of restricted property<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8.2) If this subsection applies at any time to a particular person, and to a particular property, in respect of a non-resident trust, then in applying this section in respect of the trust for a taxation year of the trust that includes that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) every transfer or loan made at or before that time by the particular person (or by a trust or partnership of which the particular person was a beneficiary or member, as the case may be) of the particular property, of another property for which the particular property is a substitute, or of property from which the particular property derives, or the other property derived, its value in whole or in part, directly or indirectly, is deemed to be a transfer or loan, as the case may be, by the particular person</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that is not an arm’s length transfer, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) that is, for the purposes of paragraph (2)(<I>c</I>) and subsection (9), a transfer or loan of restricted property; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) paragraph (2)(<I>c</I>) is to be read without reference to subparagraph (2)(<I>c</I>)(iii) in its application to each transfer and loan described in paragraph (<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsections (6) to (8) apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>43.</B> (1) Subsection 96(1.6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Members deemed carrying on business<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.6) If a partnership carries on a business in Canada at any time, each taxpayer who is deemed by paragraph (1.1)(<I>a</I>) to be a member of the partnership at that time is deemed to carry on the business in Canada at that time for the purposes of subsection 2(3), sections 34.1 and 150 and (subject to subsection 34.2(18)) section 34.2.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 22, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>44.</B> (1) The portion of paragraph 107(4.1)(<I>b</I>) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) subsection 75(2) was applicable (determined without its reference to “while the person is resident in Canada” and as if subsection 75(3) as it read before March 21, 2013 were read without reference to its paragraph (<I>c.2</I>)), or subsection 94(8.2) was applicable (determined without reference to paragraph 94(8.1)(<I>a</I>)), at a particular time in respect of any property of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>45.</B> (1) Subsection 107.3(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Ceasing to be qualifying environmental trust<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If at any time a trust ceases to be a qualifying environmental trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) for the purposes of subsections 111(5.5) and 149(10), the trust is deemed to cease at that time to be exempt from tax under this Part on its taxable income;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) each beneficiary under the trust immediately before that time is deemed to receive at that time from the trust an amount equal to the percentage of the fair market value of the properties of the trust immediately after that time that can reasonably be considered to be the beneficiary’s interest in the trust; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) each beneficiary under the trust is deemed to acquire immediately after that time an interest in the trust at a cost equal to the amount deemed by paragraph (<I>b</I>) to be received by the beneficiary from the trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>46.</B> (1) The formula in paragraph 110.6(2)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">[$400,000 – (A + B + C + D)] × E</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsections 110.6(31) and (32) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Reserve limit<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(31) If an amount is included in an individ- ual’s income for a particular taxation year because of subparagraph 40(1)(<I>a</I>)(ii) in respect of a disposition of property in a preceding taxation year that is qualified farm property, qualified fishing property or a qualified small business corporation share, the total of all amounts deductible by the individual for the particular year under this section is reduced by the amount, if any, determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">A – B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an amount deductible under this section by the individual for the particular year or a preceding taxation year, computed without reference to this subsection; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is an amount that would be deductible under this section by the individual for the particular year or a preceding taxation year if the individual had not for any preceding taxation year claimed a reserve under subparagraph 40(1)(<I>a</I>)(iii) and had claimed, for each taxation year ending before the particular year, the amount that would have been deductible under this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) applies to the 2014 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (2) applies to taxation years that begin after March 19, 2007.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>47.</B> (1) Subsections 111(4) to (5.3) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — capital losses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Notwithstanding subsection (1), and subject to subsection (5.5), if at any time (in this subsection referred to as “that time”) a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) no amount in respect of a net capital loss for a taxation year that ended before that time is deductible in computing the taxpayer’s taxable income for a taxation year that ends after that time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) no amount in respect of a net capital loss for a taxation year that ends after that time is deductible in computing the taxpayer’s taxable income for a taxation year that ends before that time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) in computing the adjusted cost base to the taxpayer at and after that time of each capital property, other than a depreciable property, of the taxpayer immediately before that time, there is to be deducted the amount, if any, by which the adjusted cost base to the taxpayer of the property immediately before that time exceeds its fair market value immediately before that time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) each amount required by paragraph (<I>c</I>) to be deducted in computing the adjusted cost base to the taxpayer of a property is deemed to be a capital loss of the taxpayer for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time from the disposition of the property;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) if the taxpayer designates — in its return of income under this Part for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time or in a prescribed form filed with the Minister on or before the day that is 90 days after the day on which a notice of assessment of tax payable for the year or notification that no tax is payable for the year is sent to the taxpayer — a property that was a capital property of the taxpayer immediately before that time (other than a property in respect of which an amount would, but for this paragraph, be required by paragraph (<I>c</I>) to be deducted in computing its adjusted cost base to the taxpayer or a depreciable property of a prescribed class to which, but for this paragraph, subsection (5.1) would apply),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer is deemed to have disposed of the property at the time that is immediately before the time that is immediately before that time for proceeds of disposition equal to the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the fair market value of the property immediately before that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the greater of the adjusted cost base to the taxpayer of the property immediately before the disposition and such amount as is designated by the taxpayer in respect of the property,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) subject to subparagraph (iii), the taxpayer is deemed to have reacquired the property at that time at a cost equal to those proceeds of disposition, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) if the property is depreciable property of the taxpayer the capital cost of which to the taxpayer immediately before the disposition exceeds those proceeds of disposition, for the purposes of sections 13 and 20 and any regulations made for the purposes of paragraph 20(1)(<I>a</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the capital cost of the property to the taxpayer at that time is deemed to be the amount that was its capital cost immediately before the disposition, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the excess is deemed to have been allowed to the taxpayer in respect of the property under regulations made for the purposes of paragraph 20(1)(<I>a</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s income for taxation years that ended before that time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) for the purposes of the definition “capital dividend account” in subsection 89(1), each amount that because of paragraph (<I>d</I>) or (<I>e</I>) is a capital loss or gain of the taxpayer from a disposition of a property for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time is deemed to be a capital loss or gain, as the case may be, of the taxpayer from the disposition of the property immediately before the time that a capital property of the taxpayer in respect of which paragraph (<I>e</I>) would be applicable would be deemed by that paragraph to have been disposed of by the taxpayer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — non-capital losses and farm losses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) no amount in respect of the taxpayer’s non-capital loss or farm loss for a taxation year that ended before that time is deductible by the taxpayer for a taxation year that ends after that time, except that the portion of the taxpayer’s non-capital loss or farm loss, as the case may be, for a taxation year that ended before that time as may reasonably be regarded as the taxpayer’s loss from carrying on a business and, if a business was carried on by the taxpayer in that year, the portion of the non-capital loss as may reasonably be regarded as being in respect of an amount deductible under paragraph 110(1)(<I>k</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s taxable income for that year is deductible by the taxpayer for a particular taxation year that ends after that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) only if that business was carried on by the taxpayer for profit or with a reasonable expectation of profit throughout the partic- ular year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) only to the extent of the total of the taxpayer’s income for the particular year from</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) that business, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if properties were sold, leased, rented or developed or services rendered in the course of carrying on that business before that time, any other business substantially all the income of which was derived from the sale, leasing, rental or development, as the case may be, of similar properties or the rendering of similar services; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) no amount in respect of the taxpayer’s non-capital loss or farm loss for a taxation year that ends after that time is deductible by the taxpayer for a taxation year that ended before that time, except that the portion of the taxpayer’s non-capital loss or farm loss, as the case may be, for a taxation year that ended after that time as may reasonably be regarded as the taxpayer’s loss from carrying on a business and, if a business was carried on by the taxpayer in that year, the portion of the non-capital loss as may reasonably be regarded as being in respect of an amount deductible under paragraph 110(1)(<I>k</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s taxable income for that year is deductible by the taxpayer for a particular taxation year that ends before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) only if throughout the taxation year and in the particular year that business was carried on by the taxpayer for profit or with a reasonable expectation of profit, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) only to the extent of the taxpayer’s income for the particular year from</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) that business, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if properties were sold, leased, rented or developed or services rendered in the course of carrying on that business before that time, any other business substantially all the income of which was derived from the sale, leasing, rental or development, as the case may be, of similar properties or the rendering of similar services.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — UCC computation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) Subject to subsection (5.5), if at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event and, if this Act were read without reference to subsection 13(24), the undepreciated capital cost to the taxpayer of depreciable property of a prescribed class immediately before that time would have exceeded the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the fair market value of all the property of that class immediately before that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the amount in respect of property of that class otherwise allowed under regulations made under paragraph 20(1)(<I>a</I>) or deductible under subsection 20(16) in computing the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">the excess is to be deducted in computing the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time and is deemed to have been allowed in respect of property of that class under regulations made under paragraph 20(1)(<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — CEC computation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) Subject to subsection (5.5), if at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event and immediately before that time the taxpayer’s cumulative eligible capital in respect of a business exceeds the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) 3/4 of the fair market value of the eligible capital property in respect of the business, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the amount otherwise deducted under paragraph 20(1)(<I>b</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s income from the business for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">the excess is to be deducted under paragraph 20(1)(<I>b</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — doubtful debts and bad debts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.3) Subject to subsection (5.5), if at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) no amount may be deducted under paragraph 20(1)(<I>l</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in respect of each debt owing to the taxpayer immediately before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the amount that is the greatest amount that would, but for this subsection and subsection 26(2) of this Act and subsection 33(1) of the <I>Income Tax Act</I>, chapter 148 of the Revised Statutes of Canada, 1952, have been deductible under paragraph 20(1)(<I>l</I>)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) is deemed to be a separate debt, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, is to be deducted as a bad debt under paragraph 20(1)(<I>p</I>) in computing the taxpayer’s income for its taxation year that ended immediately before that time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the amount by which the debt exceeds that separate debt is deemed to be a separate debt incurred at the same time and under the same circumstances as the debt was incurred.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 111(5.5) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — special rules<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.5) If at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) paragraphs (4)(<I>c</I>) to (<I>f</I>) and subsections (5.1) to (5.3) do not apply to the taxpayer in respect of the loss restriction event if at that time the taxpayer becomes or ceases to be exempt from tax under this Part on its taxable income; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if it can reasonably be considered that the main reason that the taxpayer is subject to the loss restriction event is to cause paragraph (4)(<I>d</I>) or any of subsections (5.1) to (5.3) to apply with respect to the loss restriction event, the following do not apply with respect to the loss restriction event:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that provision and paragraph (4)(<I>e</I>), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if that provision is paragraph (4)(<I>d</I>), paragraph (4)(<I>c</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the description of A in the definition “farm loss” in subsection 111(8) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the amount that would be the taxpayer’s non-capital loss for the year if the amount determined for D in the definition “non-capital loss” in this subsection were nil, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Paragraph (<I>c</I>) of the description of C in the definition “net capital loss” in subsection 111(8) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) if the taxpayer was subject to a loss restriction event before the end of the year and after the end of the taxpayer’s tenth preceding taxation year, nil, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 111(12) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Foreign currency debt on loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(12) For the purposes of subsection (4), if at any time a taxpayer owes a foreign currency debt in respect of which the taxpayer would have had, if the foreign currency debt had been repaid at that time, a capital loss or gain, the taxpayer is deemed to own at the time (in this subsection referred to as the “measurement time”) that is immediately before that time a property</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the adjusted cost base of which at the measurement time is the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula"> A + B – C</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the amount of principal owed by the taxpayer under the foreign currency debt at the measurement time, calculated, for greater certainty, using the exchange rate applicable at the measurement time,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the portion of any gain, previously recognized in respect of the foreign currency debt because of this section, that is reasonably attributable to the amount described in A, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>C</keep><Tab />is the portion of any capital loss previously recognized in respect of the foreign currency debt because of this section, that is reasonably attributable to the amount described in A; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the fair market value of which is the amount that would be the amount of the principal owed by the taxpayer under the foreign currency debt at the measurement time if that amount were calculated using the exchange rate applicable at the time of the original borrowing.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections (1), (2), (4) and (5) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>48.</B> (1) Section 112 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (7):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Synthetic disposition — holding period<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) If a synthetic disposition arrangement is entered into in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer and the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement is 30 days or more, for the purposes of paragraphs (3.01)(<I>b</I>) and (3.11)(<I>b</I>), subclauses (3.2)(<I>a</I>)(ii)(C)(I) and (3.3)(<I>a</I>)(ii)(C)(I) and paragraphs (3.31)(<I>b</I>), (3.32)(<I>b</I>), (4.01)(<I>b</I>), (4.11)(<I>b</I>), (4.21)(<I>b</I>), (4.22)(<I>b</I>), (5.1)(<I>b</I>) and (5.21)(<I>b</I>) and subsection (9), the taxpayer is deemed not to own the property during the synthetic disposition period.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) Subsection (8) does not apply in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer in respect of a synthetic disposition arrangement if the taxpayer owned the property throughout the 365-day period (determined without reference to this subsection) that ended immediately before the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subject to subsection (3), subsection (1) applies to:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) an agreement or arrangement entered into after March 20, 2013; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) an agreement or arrangement entered into before March 21, 2013, the term of which is extended after March 20, 2013, as if the agreement or arrangement were entered into at the time of the extension.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) In respect of an agreement or arrangement referred to in subsection (2), that is entered into before September 13, 2013 and the term of which is not extended after September 12, 2013, subsection 112(9) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (1), is to be read as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) Subsection (8) does not apply in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer in respect of a synthetic disposition arrangement if the taxpayer owned the property throughout the 365-day period that ended immediately before the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>49.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 117.1(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Annual adjustment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>117.1</B> (1) The amount of $1,000 referred to in the formula in paragraph 8(1)(<I>s</I>), each of the amounts expressed in dollars in subparagraph 6(1)(<I>b</I>)(v.1), subsection 117(2), the description of B in subsection 118(1), subsection 118(2), paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the description of B in subsection 118(10), subsection 118.01(2), the descriptions of C and F in subsection 118.2(1) and subsections 118.3(1), 122.5(3) and 122.51(1) and (2), the amount of $400,000 referred to in the formula in paragraph 110.6(2)(<I>a</I>), the amounts of $925 and $1,680 referred to in the description of A, and the amounts of $10,500 and $14,500 referred to in the description of B, in the formula in subsection 122.7(2), the amount of $462.50 referred to in the description of C, and the amounts of $16,667 and $25,700 referred to in the description of D, in the formula in subsection 122.7(3), and each of the amounts expressed in dollars in Part I.2 in relation to tax payable under this Part or Part I.2 for a taxation year shall be adjusted so that the amount to be used under those provisions for the year is the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to the 2015 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>50.</B> (1) Subparagraph 118.5(3)(<I>c</I>)(iv) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) the provision of financial assistance to students, except to the extent that, if this Act were read without reference to subsection 56(3), the amount of the assistance would be required to be included in computing the income, and not be deduct- ible in computing the taxable income, of the students to whom the assistance is provided, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to the 2012 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>51.</B> (1) The definition “non-portfolio property” in subsection 122.1(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“non-portfolio property”<br />« <I>bien hors portefeuille</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“non-portfolio property”, of a particular entity for a taxation year, means a property, held by the particular entity at any time in the taxation year, that is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a security of a subject entity (other than a portfolio investment entity), if at that time the particular entity holds</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) securities of the subject entity that have a total fair market value that is greater than 10% of the equity value of the subject entity, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) securities of the subject entity that, together with all the securities that the particular entity holds of entities affiliated with the subject entity, have a total fair market value that is greater than 50% of the equity value of the particular entity;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a Canadian real, immovable or resource property, if at any time in the taxation year the total fair market value of all properties held by the particular entity that are Canadian real, immovable or resource properties is greater than 50% of the equity value of the particular entity; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) a property that the particular entity, or a person or partnership with whom <keep>the partic-</keep>ular entity does not deal at arm’s length, uses at that time in the course of carrying on a business in Canada.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “excluded subsidiary entity” in subsection 122.1(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “or” at the end of subparagraph (iv) and by replacing subparagraph (v) with the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) a person or partnership that does not have, in connection with the holding of a security of the entity, property the value of which is determined, all or in part, by reference to a security that is listed or traded on a stock exchange or other public market, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) an excluded subsidiary entity for the taxation year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (2) is deemed to have come into force on October 31, 2006, except that it does not apply for the purpose of determining if an entity is an excluded subsidiary entity for taxation years of the entity that began before July 21, 2011 if the entity so elects in writing filed with the Minister of National Revenue within 365 days after the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>52.</B> Subsection 122.61(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-residents and part-year residents<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) For the purposes of this section, if a person was non-resident at any time in a taxation year, the person’s income for the year is, for greater certainty, deemed to be the amount that would have been the person’s income for the year had the person been resident in Canada throughout the year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>53.</B> Section 122.64 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>54.</B> (1) Subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(iv) of the definition “full rate taxable income” in subsection 123.4(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) if the corporation is a credit union throughout the year and the corporation deducted an amount for the year under subsection 125(1) (because of the application of subsections 137(3) and (4)), the amount, if any, that is the product of the amount, if any, determined for B in subsection 137(3) multiplied by the amount determined for C in subsection 137(3) in respect of the corporation for the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>55.</B> (1) The descriptions of G and H in the definition “specified partnership income” in subsection 125(7) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>G</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is the corporation’s share of the income (determined in accordance with subdivision j of Division B) of the partnership for a fiscal period of the business that ends in the year, or an amount included in the corporation’s income for the year in respect of the business under any of subsections 34.2(2), (3) and (12), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>H</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts deducted in computing the corporation’s income for the year from the business (other than amounts that were deducted in computing the income of the partnership from the business) or in respect of the business under subsection 34.2(4) or (11), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 22, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>56.</B> (1) Section 126 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (4.4):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Synthetic disposition — holding period<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.5) If a synthetic disposition arrangement is entered into in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer and the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement is 30 days or more,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) for the purpose of determining whether the period referred to in subsection (4.2) is one year or less, the period is deemed to begin at the earlier of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the time that is immediately before the particular time referred to in subsection (4.2), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the end, if any, of the synthetic disposition period; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) for the purposes of subsection (4.6), the taxpayer is deemed not to own the property during the synthetic disposition period.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.6) Subsection (4.5) does not apply in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer in respect of a synthetic disposition arrangement if the taxpayer owned the property throughout the one-year period (determined without reference to this subsection) that ended immediately before the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subject to subsection (3), subsection (1) applies to:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) an agreement or arrangement entered into after March 20, 2013; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) an agreement or arrangement entered into before March 21, 2013, the term of which is extended after March 20, 2013, as if the agreement or arrangement were entered into at the time of the extension.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) In respect of an agreement or arrangement referred to in subsection (2), that is entered into before September 13, 2013 and the term of which is not extended after September 12, 2013, subsection 126(4.6) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (1), is to be read as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.6) Subsection (4.5) does not apply in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer in respect of a synthetic disposition arrangement if the taxpayer owned the property throughout the one-year period that ended immediately before the synthetic disposition period of the arrangement.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>57.</B> (1) The definition “non-government assistance” in subsection 127(9) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“non-government assistance”<br />« <I>aide non gouvernementale</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“non-government assistance” means an amount that would be included in income under paragraph 12(1)(<I>x</I>) if that paragraph were read without reference to subparagraphs 12(1)(<I>x</I>)(v) to (vii);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraphs (<I>j</I>) and (<I>k</I>) of the definition “investment tax credit” in subsection 127(9) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j</I>) if the taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event at any time before the end of the year, the amount determined under subsection (9.1) in respect of the taxpayer, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>k</I>) if the taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event at any time after the end of the year, the amount determined under subsection (9.2) in respect of the taxpayer,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The definition “pre-production mining expenditure” in subsection 127(9) of the Act is amended by striking out “or” at the end of subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(i) and by replacing subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(ii) with the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) described in paragraph (<I>g</I>), (<I>g.3</I>) or (<I>g.4</I>) and not in paragraph (<I>f</I>), of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6) if the expression “mineral resource” in paragraph (<I>g</I>) of that definition were defined to mean a mineral deposit from which the principal mineral to be extracted is diamond, a base or precious metal deposit, or a mineral deposit from which the principal mineral to be extracted is an industrial mineral that, when refined, results in a base or precious metal, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Clause (<I>k</I>)(iii)(B) of the definition “specified percentage” in subsection 127(9) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) in 2015, 5% if the expense is described in paragraph (<I>a</I>)(ii) of the definition “pre-production mining expenditure” because of paragraph (<I>g.4</I>) of the definition “Canadian exploration expense” in subsection 66.1(6), and 4% otherwise, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) The portion of subsection 127(9.1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event before end of year<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9.1) If a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event at any time (in this subsection referred to as “that time”) before the end of a taxation year of the taxpayer, the amount determined for the purposes of paragraph (<I>j</I>) of the definition “investment tax credit” in subsection (9) with respect to the taxpayer is the amount, if any, by which</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subparagraph 127(9.1)(<I>d</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) if throughout the year the taxpayer carried on a particular business in the course of which a property was acquired, or an expenditure was made, before that time in respect of which an amount is included in computing its investment tax credit at the end of the year, the amount, if any, by which the total of all amounts each of which is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) its income for the year from the particular business, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) its income for the year from any other business substantially all the income of which was derived from the sale, leasing, rental or development of properties or the rendering of services similar to the properties sold, leased, rented or developed, or the services rendered, as the case may be, by the taxpayer in carrying on the particular business before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">exceeds</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) the total of all amounts each of which is an amount deducted under paragraph 111(1)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>d</I>) for the year by the taxpayer in respect of a non-capital loss or a farm loss, as the case may be, for a taxation year in respect of the particular business or the other business,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) The portion of subsection 127(9.2) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event after end of year<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9.2) If a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event at any time (in this subsection referred to as “that time”) after the end of a taxation year of the taxpayer, the amount determined for the purposes of paragraph (<I>k</I>) of the definition “investment tax credit” in subsection (9) is the amount, if any, by which</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subparagraph 127(9.2)(<I>d</I>)(i) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) if the taxpayer acquired a property or made an expenditure, in the course of carrying on a particular business throughout the portion of a taxation year that is after that time, in respect of which an amount is included in computing its investment tax credit at the end of the year, the amount, if any, by which the total of all amounts each of which is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) its income for the year from the particular business, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if the taxpayer carried on a partic- ular business in the year, its income for the year from any other business substantially all the income of which was derived from the sale, leasing, rental or development of properties or the rendering of services similar to the properties sold, leased, rented or developed, or the services rendered, as the case may be, by the taxpayer in carrying on the particular business before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">exceeds</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) the total of all amounts each of which is an amount deducted under paragraph 111(1)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>d</I>) for the year by the taxpayer in respect of a non-capital loss or a farm loss, as the case may be, for a taxation year in respect of the particular business or the other business</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subsections (2) to (8) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>58.</B> (1) The definition “qualifying corporation” in subsection 127.1(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“qualifying corporation”<br />« <I>société admissible</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“qualifying corporation”, for a particular taxation year that ends in a calendar year, means a particular corporation that is a Canadian-controlled private corporation in the particular taxation year the taxable income of which for its immediately preceding taxation year — together with, if the particular corporation is associated in the particular taxation year with one or more other corporations (in this subsection referred to as “associated corporations”), the taxable income of each associated corporation for its last taxation year that ended in the preceding calendar year (determined before taking into consideration the specified future tax consequences for that last year) — does not exceed the qualifying income limit, if any, of the particular corporation for the particular taxation year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that begin after December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>59.</B> (1) Subsection 127.4(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 127.4(5)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) $500, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 127.4(5)(<I>a</I>) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (2), is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) $250, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection 127.4(5) of the Act, as amended by subsection (3), is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Paragraph 127.4(6)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) 10% of the net cost to the individual (or to a qualifying trust for the individual in respect of the share) for the original acquisition of the share by the individual or by the trust, if the taxation year for which a claim is made under subsection (2) in respect of the original acquisition is 2015,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a.1</I>) 5% of the net cost to the individual (or to a qualifying trust for the individual in respect of the share) for the original acquisition of the share by the individual or by the trust, if the taxation year for which a claim is made under subsection (2) in respect of the original acquisition is 2016,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsection 127.4(6) of the Act, as amended by subsection (5), is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsections (1), (4) and (6) apply to the 2017 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection (2) applies to the 2015 taxation year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsection (3) applies to the 2016 taxation year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subsection (5) applies to the 2015 and 2016 taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>60.</B> (1) The portion of paragraph 127.52(1)(<I>c.1</I>) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c.1</I>) if, during a partnership’s fiscal period that ends in the year (other than a fiscal period that ends because of subsection 99(1)), the individual’s interest in the partnership is an interest for which an identification number is required to be, or has been, obtained under section 237.1,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Clause 127.52(1)(<I>i</I>)(i)(B) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subclause (I) and by replacing subclause (II) with the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) paragraphs (<I>b</I>) to (<I>c.3</I>), (<I>e</I>) and (<I>e.1</I>) of this subsection, as they read in respect of taxation years that began after 1994 and ended before 2012, applied in computing the individual’s non-capital loss, restricted farm loss, farm loss and limited partnership loss for any of those years, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(III) paragraphs (<I>b</I>) to (<I>c.3</I>), (<I>e</I>) and (<I>e.1</I>) of this subsection applied in computing the individual’s non-capital loss, restricted farm loss, farm loss and limited partnership loss for any taxation year that ends after 2011, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Clause 127.52(1)(<I>i</I>)(ii)(B) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subclause (I) and by replacing subclause (II) with the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) paragraphs (<I>c.1</I>) and (<I>d</I>) of this subsection, as they read in respect of taxation years that began after 1994 and ended before 2012, applied in computing the individual’s net capital loss for any of those years, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(III) paragraphs (<I>c.1</I>) and (<I>d</I>) of this subsection applied in computing the individual’s net capital loss for any taxation year that ends after 2011; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections (1) to (3) apply to the 2012 and subsequent taxation years and, if an individual files an election in writing with the Minister of National Revenue before the day that is 90 days after the day on which this Act receives royal assent, for the individual</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) subsections (1) to (3) also apply to the 2006 to 2011 taxation years; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the references in clauses 127.52(1)(<I>i</I>)(i)(B) and (ii)(B) of the Act, as amended by subsections (2) and (3), to “2011” and “2012” are to be read as “2005” and “2006”, respectively.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Notwithstanding subsection 152(4) of the Act, the Minister of National Revenue may make such assessments, reassessments and determinations under Part I of the Act as are necessary to give effect to an election under subsection (4).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>61.</B> (1) Subsection 136(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Cooperative not private corporation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>136.</B> (1) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, a cooperative corporation that would, but for this section, be a private corporation is deemed not to be a private corporation except for the purposes of section 15.1, paragraphs 87(2)(<I>vv</I>) and (<I>ww</I>) (including, for greater certainty, in applying those paragraphs as provided under paragraph 88(1)(<I>e.2</I>)), the definitions “excessive eligible dividend designation”, “general rate income pool” and “low rate income pool” in subsection 89(1), subsections 89(4) to (6) and (8) to (10), sections 123.4, 125, 125.1, 127 and 127.1, the definition “mark-to-market property” in subsection 142.2(1), sections 152 and 157, subsection 185.2(3), the definition “small business corporation” in subsection 248(1) (as it applies for the purposes of paragraph 39(1)(<I>c</I>)) and subsection 249(3.1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that begin after December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>62.</B> (1) Subsection 137(4.1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Payments in respect of shares<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.1) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, an amount paid or payable by a credit union to a person is deemed to be paid or payable, as the case may be, by the credit union as interest and to be received or receivable, as the case may be, by the person as interest, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the amount is in respect of a share held by the person of the capital stock of the credit union, other than an amount paid or payable as or on account of a reduction of the paid-up capital, redemption, acquisition or cancellation of the share by the credit union to the extent of the paid-up capital of the share;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the share is not listed on a stock exchange; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the person is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a member of the credit union, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) a member of another credit union if the share is issued by the credit union after March 28, 2012 and the other credit union is a member of the credit union.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to the 2012 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>63.</B> The portion of subsection 142.2(2) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Significant interest<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) For the purposes of the definitions “excluded property” and “specified debt obligation” in subsection (1) and subsection 142.6(1.6), a taxpayer has a significant interest in a corporation at any time if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>64.</B> (1) Section 147.1 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (18):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Reasonable error<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(19) The administrator of a registered pension plan may make a payment (other than a payment made to avoid the revocation of the registration of the plan) that is a return of all or a portion of a contribution made by a member of the plan, or an employer who participates in the plan, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the contribution was made to the plan as a consequence of a reasonable error;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the payment is made to the member or employer, as the case may be, who made the contribution; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the payment is made no later than December 31 of the year following the year in which the contribution was made.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to contributions made on or after the later of January 1, 2014 and the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>65.</B> (1) Section 148 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (4):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>10/8 policy surrender<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If a policyholder has after March 20, 2013 and before April 2014 disposed of an interest in a 10/8 policy because of a partial or complete surrender of the policy, the policyholder may deduct in computing their income for the taxation year in which the disposition occurs an amount that does not exceed the least of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the portion of an amount, included under subsection (1) in computing their income for the year in respect of the disposition, that is attributable to an investment account described in paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1) in respect of the policy,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the total of all amounts each of which is an amount, to the extent that the amount has not otherwise been included in determining an amount under this paragraph, of a payment made after March 20, 2013 and before April 2014 that reduces the amount outstanding of a borrowing or policy loan, as the case may be, described in paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1) in respect of the policy, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the total of all amounts each of which is an amount, to the extent that the amount has not otherwise been included in determining an amount under this paragraph, that the policyholder is entitled to receive as a result of the disposition and that is paid after March 20, 2013 and before April 2014 out of an investment account described in paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1) in respect of the policy.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>(2)</B> Subsection <B>(1)</B> applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>66.</B> (1) Subsection 149(10) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Becoming or ceasing to be exempt<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10) If at any time (in this subsection referred to as “that time”), a person — that is a corporation or, if that time is after September 12, 2013, a trust — becomes or ceases to be exempt from tax under this Part on its taxable income otherwise than by reason of paragraph (1)(<I>t</I>), the following rules apply:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the taxation year of the person that would, but for this paragraph, have included that time is deemed to end immediately before that time, a new taxation year of the person is deemed to begin at that time and, for the purpose of determining the person’s fiscal period after that time, the person is deemed not to have established a fiscal period before that time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a.1</I>) for the purpose of computing the person’s income for its first taxation year that ends after that time, the person is deemed to have deducted under sections 20, 138 and 140 in computing the person’s income for its taxation year that ended immediately before that time, the greatest amount that could have been claimed or deducted by the person for that year as a reserve under those sections;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the person is deemed to have disposed, at the time (in this subsection referred to as the “disposition time”) that is immediately before the time that is immediately before that time, of each property held by the person immediately before that time for an amount equal to its fair market value at that time and to have reacquired the property at that time at a cost equal to that fair market value;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) for the purposes of applying sections 37, 65 to 66.4, 66.7, 111 and 126, subsections 127(5) to (36) and section 127.3 to the person, the person is deemed to be a new corporation or trust, as the case may be, the first taxation year of which began at that time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) there is to be deducted under paragraph 20(1)(<I>b</I>) in computing the person’s income from a business for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time the amount, if any, by which the person’s cumulative eligible capital immediately before the disposition time in respect of the business exceeds the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) 3/4 of the fair market value of the eligible capital property in respect of the business, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the amount otherwise deducted under paragraph 20(1)(<I>b</I>) in computing the person’s income from the business for the taxation year that ended immediately before that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>67.</B> (1) Paragraph 152(4)(<I>c</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b.1</I>) an information return described in subsection 237.1(7) or 237.3(2) that is required to be filed in respect of a deduction or claim made by the taxpayer in relation to a tax shelter, or in respect of a tax benefit (as defined in subsection 245(1)) to the taxpayer from an avoidance transaction (as defined in subsection 245(3)), is not filed as and when required, and the assessment, reassessment or additional assessment is made before the day that is three years after the day on which the information return is filed;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b.2</I>) the assessment, reassessment or additional assessment is made before the day that is three years after the end of the normal reassessment period for the taxpayer in respect of the year and if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer, or a partnership of which the taxpayer is a member, has failed to file for the year a prescribed form as and when required under subsection 233.3(3) or to report on the prescribed form the information required in respect of a specified foreign property (as defined in subsection 233.3(1)) held by the taxpayer at any time during the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the taxpayer has failed to report, in the return of income for the year, an amount in respect of a specified foreign property that is required to be included in computing the taxpayer’s income for the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the taxpayer or person filing the return of income has filed with the Minister a waiver in prescribed form within the additional three-year period referred to in paragraph (<I>b</I>) or (<I>b.1</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c.1</I>) the taxpayer or person filing the return of income has filed with the Minister a waiver in prescribed form within the additional three-year period referred to in paragraph (<I>b.2</I>); or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subsection 152(4.01) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Extended period assessment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.01) Notwithstanding subsections (4) and (5), an assessment, reassessment or additional assessment to which paragraph (4)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>), (<I>b.1</I>) or (<I>c</I>) applies in respect of a taxpayer for a taxation year may be made after the taxpayer’s normal reassessment period in respect of the year to the extent that, but only to the extent that, it can reasonably be regarded as relating to,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The portion of paragraph 152(4.01)(<I>b</I>) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if paragraph (4)(<I>b</I>), (<I>b.1</I>) or (<I>c</I>) applies to the assessment, reassessment or additional assessment,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Paragraph 152(4.01)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is amended by striking out “or” at the end of subparagraph (v), by adding “or” at the end of subparagraph (vi) and by adding the following after subparagraph (vi):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vii) the deduction, claim or tax benefit referred to in paragraph (4)(<I>b.1</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 152(4.1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>If waiver revoked<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.1) If the Minister would, but for this subsection, be entitled to reassess, make an additional assessment or assess tax, interest or penalties by virtue only of the filing of a waiver under subparagraph (4)(<I>a</I>)(ii) or paragraph <keep>(4)(<I>c</I>)</keep> or (<I>c.1</I>), the Minister may not make such a reassessment, additional assessment or assessment after the day that is six months after the date on which a notice of revocation of the waiver in prescribed form is filed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections (1) and (5) apply to the 2013 and subsequent taxation years, except that, in its application to taxation years that end before March 21, 2013, subsection 152(4) of the Act, as amended by subsection (1), is to be read without reference to paragraph (<I>b.1</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsections (2) to (4) apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>68.</B> (1) Section 156 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (3):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Payments by SIFT trusts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Subsections (1) to (3) and section 156.1 do not apply to a SIFT trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that begin after July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>69.</B> (1) Clause 157(1.5)(<I>a</I>)(ii)(B) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the amount obtained when the estimated tax payable by the corporation, if any, under Parts VI and XIII.1 for the taxation year is divided by the number of months that end in the taxation year and after the particular time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 157(1.5)(<I>b</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the remainder of the taxes payable by it under this Part and Parts VI, VI.1 and XIII.1 for the taxation year on or before its balance-due day for the year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Section 157 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (1.5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application to SIFT trusts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsections (1), (2.1) and (4) apply to a SIFT trust with any modifications that the circumstances require.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections (1) and (2) apply to taxation years that begin after 2007.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection (3) applies to taxation years that begin after July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>70.</B> (1) Section 162 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Failure to provide claim preparer information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) Every person or partnership who makes, or participates in, assents to or acquiesces in the making of, a false statement or omission in respect of claim preparer information required to be included in an SR&amp;ED form is jointly and severally, or solidarily, liable, together with any claim preparer of the form, to a penalty equal to $1,000.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Due diligence<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) A claim preparer of an SR&amp;ED form is not liable for a penalty under subsection (5.1) in respect of a false statement or omission if the claim preparer has exercised the degree of care, diligence and skill to prevent the making of the false statement or omission that a reasonably prudent person would have exercised in comparable circumstances.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.3) The following definitions apply in this subsection and subsections (5.1) and (5.2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“claim preparer”<br />« <I>préparateur</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“claim preparer”, of an SR&amp;ED form, means a person or partnership who agrees to accept consideration to prepare, or assist in the preparation of, the form but does not include an employee who prepares, or assists in the preparation of, the form in the course of performing their duties of employment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“claim preparer information”<br />« <I>renseignements relatifs au préparateur</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“claim preparer information” means prescribed information regarding </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the identity of the claim preparer, if any, of an SR&amp;ED form, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the arrangement under which the claim preparer agrees to accept consideration in respect of the preparation of the form.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“SR&amp;ED form”<br />« <I>formulaire de RS&amp;DE</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“SR&amp;ED form” means a prescribed form required to be filed under subsection 37(11).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) comes into force on the later of January 1, 2014 and the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>71.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 163.2:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>163.3</B> (1) The following definitions apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“electronic cash register”<br />« <I>caisse enregistreuse électronique</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“electronic cash register” means a device that keeps a register or supporting documents through the means of an electronic device or computer system designed to record transaction data or any other electronic point-of-sale system.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“electronic suppression of sales device”<br />« <I>appareil de suppression électronique des ventes</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“electronic suppression of sales device” means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a software program that falsifies the records of electronic cash registers, including transaction data and transaction reports; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a hidden programming option, whether preinstalled or installed at a later time, embedded in the operating system of an electronic cash register or hardwired into the electronic cash register that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) may be used to create a virtual second till, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) may eliminate or manipulate transaction records, which may or may not be preserved in digital formats, in order to represent the actual or manipulated record of transactions in the electronic cash register.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“service”<br />« <I>service</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“service” has the same meaning as in subsection 123(1) of the <I>Excise Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty — use<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Every person that uses, or that knowingly, or under circumstances attributable to neglect, carelessness or wilful default, participates in, assents to or acquiesces in the use of, an electronic suppression of sales device or a similar device or software in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230 is liable to a penalty of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) unless paragraph (<I>b</I>) applies, $5,000; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) $50,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under this section or section 285.01 of the <I>Excise Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty — <keep>possession</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Every person that acquires or possesses an electronic suppression of sales device or a right in respect of an electronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230 is liable to a penalty of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) unless paragraph (<I>b</I>) applies, $5,000; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) $50,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under this section or section 285.01 of the <I>Excise Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty — <keep>manufacturing</keep> <keep>or making</keep> <keep>available</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Every person that designs, develops, manufactures, possesses for sale, offers for sale, sells, transfers or otherwise makes available to another person, or that supplies installation, upgrade or maintenance services for, an elec- tronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230 is liable to a penalty of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) unless paragraph (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>) applies, $10,000;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) unless paragraph (<I>c</I>) applies, $50,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under subsection (2) or (3) or subsection 285.01(2) or (3) of the <I>Excise Tax Act</I>; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) $100,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under this subsection or subsection 285.01(4) of the <I>Excise Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Assessment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) The Minister may at any time assess a taxpayer in respect of any penalty payable by a person under subsections (2) to (4), and the provisions of this Division apply, with any modifications that the circumstances require, in respect of an assessment made under subsections (2) to (4) as though it had been made under section 152.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) Despite section 152, if at any time the Minister assesses a penalty payable by a person under subsections (2) to (4), the Minister is not to assess, at or after that time, another penalty payable by the person under subsections (2) to (4) that is in respect of an action of the person that occurred before that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Certain defences not available<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) Except as otherwise provided in subsection (8), a person does not have a defence in relation to a penalty assessed under subsections (2) to (4) by reason that the person exercised due diligence to prevent the action from occurring.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Due diligence<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) A person is not liable for a penalty under subsection (3) or (4) in respect of an action of the person if the person exercised the degree of care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would have exercised in comparable circumstances to prevent the action from occurring.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Assessment vacated<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) For the purposes of subsections (2) to (8), if an assessment of a penalty under subsections (2) to (4) is vacated, the penalty is deemed to have never been assessed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>(2)</B> Subsection (1) comes into force on the later of the day on which this Act receives royal assent and January 1, 2014.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>72.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 197(6) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Provisions applicable to Part<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) Subsection 150(2), section 152, subsections 157(1), (2.1) and (4), sections 158, 159 and 161 to 167 and Division J of Part I apply to this Part, with any modifications that the circumstances require, and for greater certainty,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that begin after July 20, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>73.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 204.81(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Conditions for registration<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>204.81</B> (1) The Minister may register a corporation for the purposes of this Part if the corporation’s application for registration was received before March 21, 2013 and if, in the opinion of the Minister, it complies with the following conditions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>74.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 207.01(1) of the Act before the first definition is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>207.01</B> (1) The following definitions and the definitions in subsections 146(1) (other than the definition “benefit”), 146.2(1) and 146.3(1) apply in this Part and Part XLIX of the <I>Income Tax Regulations</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The definition “specified non-qualified investment income” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“specified non-qualified investment income”<br />« <I>revenu de placement non admissible déterminé</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“specified non-qualified investment income”, in respect of a registered plan and its controlling individual, means income (determined without reference to paragraph 82(1)(<I>b</I>)), or a capital gain, that is reasonably attributable, directly or indirectly, to an amount in respect of which tax was payable under Part I by a trust governed by the registered plan or by any other registered plan of the controlling individual.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “advantage” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subparagraph (iii), by adding “and” at the end of subparagraph (iv) and by adding the following after subparagraph (iv):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) a benefit provided under an incentive program that is — in a normal commercial or investment context in which parties deal with each other at arm’s length and act prudently, knowledgeably <keep>and willing-</keep>ly — offered to a broad class of persons, if it is reasonable to conclude that none of the main purposes of the program is to enable a person or partnership to benefit from the exemption from tax under Part I of any amount in respect of the plan;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Clause (<I>b</I>)(i)(A) of the definition “advantage” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) would not have occurred in a normal commercial or investment context in which parties deal with each other at arm’s length and act prudently, knowledgeably and willingly, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) The portion of paragraph (<I>c</I>) of the definition “advantage” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) a benefit that is income (determined without reference to paragraph 82(1)(<I>b</I>)), or a capital gain, that is reasonably attributable, directly or indirectly, to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Paragraph (<I>c</I>) of the definition “exempt contribution” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the survivor designates, in prescribed form filed in prescribed manner within 30 days after the day on which the contribution is made (or at any later time that is acceptable to the Minister), the contribution in relation to the survivor payment; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) The portion of the definition “prohibited investment” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“prohibited investment”<br />« <I>placement interdit</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“prohibited investment”, at any time for a trust governed by a registered plan, means property (other than excluded property for the trust) that is at that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subparagraph (<I>b</I>)(ii) of the defini-<keep>tion “prohibited investment”</keep> in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) a person or partnership that does not deal at arm’s length with the controlling individual;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) The portion of the definition “RRSP strip” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“RRSP strip”<br />« <I>sommme découlant d’un dépouillement de REER</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“RRSP strip”, in respect of a RRIF or RRSP, means the amount of a reduction in the fair market value of property held in connection with the RRIF or RRSP, if the value is reduced as part of a transaction or event or a series of transactions or events one of the main purposes of which is to enable the controlling individual of the RRIF or RRSP, or a person who does not deal at arm’s length with the controlling individual, to obtain a benefit in respect of property held in connection with the RRIF or RRSP or to obtain a benefit as a result of the reduction, but does not include an amount that is </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) The definition “RRSP strip” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is amended by adding “or” at the end of paragraph (<I>b</I>), by striking out “or” at the end of paragraph (<I>c</I>) and by repealing paragraph (<I>d</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(11) Paragraph (<I>c</I>) of the definition “swap transaction” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) a transfer of a prohibited investment or a non-qualified investment from the registered plan for consideration, in circumstances where the controlling individual is entitled to a refund under subsection 207.04(4) on the transfer;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(12) The definition “swap transaction” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>d</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) a transfer of a prohibited investment from the registered plan for consideration, if subsection (13) applies in respect of all or part of the consideration received by the registered plan;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) a transfer of property from the registered plan in consideration for the issuance of a debt obligation that is an excluded property for the trust governed by the registered plan; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) a payment into the registered plan that is a payment of, or in satisfaction of, the principal amount of, or interest on, a debt obligation that is an excluded property for the trust governed by the registered plan.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(13) The descriptions of A and B in the definition “transitional prohibited investment benefit” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is income (determined without reference to paragraph 82(1)(<I>b</I>)) earned, or a capital gain realized, in the taxation year by a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the controlling individual that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) is reasonably attributable, directly or indirectly, to a property that is a prohibited investment, and a transitional prohibited property, for the trust, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in the case of income, is earned after March 22, 2011 and, in the case of a capital gain, accrues after March 22, 2011; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the total of all amounts each of which is a capital loss (determined without reference to subparagraph 40(2)(<I>g</I>)(i) and subsection 40(3.4)) realized in the taxation year by a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the controlling individual that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) is reasonably attributable, directly or indirectly, to a property that is a prohibited investment, and a transitional prohibited property, for the trust, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) accrues after March 22, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(14) Subsection 207.01(1) of the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“equity”<br />« <I>droit sur l’actif</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“equity”, of a corporation, trust or partnership, means </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in the case of a corporation, a share of the capital stock of the corporation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in the case of a trust, an income or capital interest in the trust; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) in the case of a partnership, an interest as a member of the partnership.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“excluded property”<br />« <I>bien exclu</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“excluded property”, at any time for a trust governed by a registered plan, means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) property described in paragraph 4900(1)(<I>j.1</I>) of the <I>Income Tax Regulations;</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) an equity of a mutual fund corporation, mutual fund trust or registered investment if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) either</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the equity is equity of a mutual fund corporation or mutual fund trust that derives all or substantially all its value from one or more mutual funds that are subject to, and substantially comply with, the requirements of <I>National Instrument 81–102 Mutual Funds</I>, as amended from time to time, of the Canadian Securities Administrators, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the corporation, trust or registered investment follows a reasonable policy of investment diversification,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the time is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) during the 24-month period that begins on the day on which the first taxation year of the corporation, trust or registered investment begins,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) during the 24-month period that ends on the day on which the last taxation year of the corporation, trust or registered investment ends, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) where the equity is a share of the capital stock of a mutual fund corporation and the share derives all or substantially all its value from a partic- ular mutual fund,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(I) during the 24-month period that begins on the day on which the particular mutual fund is established, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="8" FirstLineIndent="0">(II) during the 24-month period that ends on the day on which the particular mutual fund is terminated,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) it is reasonable to conclude that none of the main purposes of the structure of the corporation, trust or registered investment, or of the terms and conditions of the equity, is to accommodate transactions or events that could affect the fair market value of the property held by the trust governed by the registered plan in a manner that would not occur in a normal commercial or investment context in which parties deal with each other at arm’s length and act prudently, knowledgeably and willingly, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) it is reasonable to conclude that none of the main purposes of the incorporation, establishment or operation of the corporation, trust or registered investment, or of the particular mutual fund, is to benefit from this paragraph; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) equity of a corporation, partnership or trust (in this paragraph referred to as the “investment entity”) if at that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the fair market value of the equity (in this paragraph referred to as the “arm’s length equity”) of the investment entity that is owned by persons who deal at arm’s length with the controlling individual of the registered plan is at least 90% of the fair market value of all the equity of the investment entity,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the total fair market value of the arm’s length equity and the debt of the investment entity that is owned by persons who deal at arm’s length with the controlling individual is at least 90% of the total fair market value of all the equity and debt of the investment entity,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) the controlling individual, either alone or together with persons with whom the controlling individual does not deal at arm’s length, does not have the right to cast at least 10% of the votes, if any, that could be cast regarding the governance of the investment entity,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) the specific terms and conditions <keep>of each</keep> share or unit of equity of <keep>the investment</keep> entity held by the trust <keep>governed</keep> by the registered plan are the same as, or substantially similar to, the terms and conditions of particular equity that is included in the arm’s length equity,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) the fair market value of the particular equity referred to in subparagraph (iv) is equal to at least 10% of the total fair market value of all equity of the investment entity having the specific terms and conditions referred to in subparagraph (iv) or terms and conditions that are substantially similar to those terms and conditions,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) the controlling individual deals at arm’s length with the investment entity, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(vii) it is reasonable to conclude that none of the main purposes of the structure of the investment entity, or of the terms and conditions of the equity, is to accommodate transactions or events that could affect the fair market value of the property held by the trust governed by the registered plan in a manner that would not occur in a normal commercial or investment context in which parties deal with each other at arm’s length and act prudently, knowledgeably and willingly.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“transitional prohibited property”<br />« <I>bien interdit transitoire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“transitional prohibited property”, at any time, for a particular trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of a controlling individual, means a property that is held by the particular trust at that time, that was held on March 22, 2011 by a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the controlling individual and that was a prohibited investment for that trust on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(15) Paragraph 207.01(4)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in the case of a corporation, the individ- ual would, at that time, be a specified shareholder of the corporation if the references in the portion of the definition “specified shareholder” in subsection 248(1) before paragraph (<I>a</I>) to “in a taxation year” and “at any time in the year” were read as “at any time” and “at that time”, respectively;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(16) Section 207.01 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deemed disposition and reacquisition of investments<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If, at any time, a property held by a trust governed by a registered plan becomes, or ceases to be, a prohibited investment or non-qualified investment for the trust, the trust is deemed to have disposed of the property immediately before that time for proceeds of disposition equal to the fair market value of the property at that time and to have reacquired the property at that time at a cost equal to that fair market value.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Adjusted cost base<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) For the purpose of computing the adjusted cost base to a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of a property that is a transitional prohibited property for the trust, the cost to the trust of the property until the property is disposed of by the trust is deemed to be equal to the fair market value of the property at the end of March 22, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Prohibited investment status<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) Subsection (9) applies in respect of a property if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the property would, in the absence of subsection (9), have ceased at any time (in this subsection and subsection (9) referred to as the “relevant time”) to be a prohibited investment for a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of a controlling individual;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the property is a transitional prohibited property for the trust immediately before the relevant time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the controlling individual elected under subsection 207.05(4); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the controlling individual elects in prescribed form that subsection (9) apply in respect of the property and the election is filed with the Minister on or before the day that is 90 days after the end of the taxation year of the controlling individual that includes the relevant time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Prohibited investment status<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) If this subsection applies in respect of a property, the property is deemed to be a prohibited investment at and after the relevant time for every trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the controlling individual referred to in paragraph (8)(<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Breakdown of marriage or common-law partnership<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10) Subsection (11) applies in respect of a property if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the property is transferred at any time (in this subsection and subsection (11) referred to as the “transfer time”) by a trust (in this subsection and subsection (11) referred to as the “transferor trust”) governed by a RRIF or RRSP of a controlling individual (in this subsection and subsection (11) referred to as the “transferor”) under paragraph 146(16)(<I>b</I>) or subsection 146.3(14) to a trust (in subsection (11) referred to as the “recipient trust”) governed by a RRIF or RRSP of which the spouse or common-law partner or former spouse or common-law partner (in this subsection and subsection (11) referred to as the “recipient”) of the transferor is the controlling individual;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the property is a prohibited investment, and a transitional prohibited property, for the transferor trust immediately before the transfer time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the transferor elected under subsection 207.05(4); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the transferor and the recipient jointly elect in prescribed form that subsection (11) apply in respect of the property and the election</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) is filed with the Minister on or before the day that is 90 days after the end of the taxation year of the transferor that includes the transfer time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) designates an amount (in subsec-<keep>tion (11)</keep> referred to as the “designated amount”) in respect of the property that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) is not less than the adjusted cost base to the transferor trust of the property immediately before the transfer time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) does not exceed the greater of the amount determined under clause (A) and the fair market value of the property at the transfer time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Breakdown of marriage or common-law partnership<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11) If this subsection applies in respect of a property,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the property is deemed to be, at and after the transfer time, a property that was held on March 22, 2011 by a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the recipient and that was a prohibited investment for the trust on March 23, 2011;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) where the property would, in the absence of this paragraph, not be a prohibited investment for the recipient trust immediately after the transfer time, the property is deemed to be a prohibited investment at and after the transfer time for every trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the recipient;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the recipient is deemed to have elected under subsection 207.05(4); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, the designated amount is deemed to be</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the proceeds of disposition to the transferor trust from the transfer described in paragraph (10)(<I>a</I>), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the cost of the property to a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the recipient until the property is disposed of by the trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exchange of property<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(12) Subsection (13) applies in respect of a property other than money if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the property is acquired at any time (in this subsection and subsection (13) referred to as the “exchange time”) by a trust (in this section and subsection (13) referred to as the “exchanging trust”) governed by a RRIF or RRSP of a controlling individual in exchange for another property (in this subsection referred to as the “exchanged property”) in a transaction to which any of section 51, subsection 85(1) and sections 85.1, 86 and 87 apply;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the exchanged property is a prohibited investment, and a transitional prohibited property, for the exchanging trust immediately before the exchange time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the property is, or would be, if subsection 4900(14) of the <I>Income Tax Regulations</I> were read without reference to its paragraph (<I>b</I>), a qualified investment for the exchanging trust immediately after the exchange time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the controlling individual elected under subsection 207.05(4).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exchange of property<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(13) If this subsection applies in respect of a property,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) other than for the purposes of subsection (7), the property is deemed to be, at and after the exchange time, a property that was held on March 22, 2011 by a trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the controlling individual referred to in subsection (12) and that was a prohibited investment for the trust on March 23, 2011; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) where the property would, in the absence of this paragraph, not be a prohibited investment for the exchanging trust immediately after the exchange time, the property is deemed to be a prohibited investment at and after the exchange time for every trust governed by a RRIF or RRSP of the controlling individual.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(17) Subsections (1) to (6), (9), (10), (13), (14) and (16) are deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011, except that an election referred to in paragraph 207.01(8)(<I>d</I>) or (10)(<I>d</I>) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (16), is deemed to have been filed with the Minister of National Revenue on a timely basis if it is filed with the Minister on or before the day that is 90 days after the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(18) Subsections (7) and (8) apply after March 22, 2011 in respect of investments acquired at any time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(19) Subsections (11) and (12) are deemed to have come into force on July 1, 2011, except that they do not apply in relation to a swap transaction undertaken before 2022 to remove a property from a RRIF or RRSP if it is reasonable to conclude that tax would be payable under Part XI.01 of the Act if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) that Part were read without reference to subsection 207.05(4) of the Act; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the property were retained in the RRIF or RRSP.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(20) Subsection (15) is deemed to have come into force on January 1, 2009.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>75.</B> (1) Subsection 207.04(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Tax payable on prohibited or non-qualified investment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>207.04</B> (1) The controlling individual of a registered plan that governs a trust shall pay a tax under this Part for a calendar year if, at any time in the year, the trust acquires property that is a prohibited investment, or a non-qualified investment, for the trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 207.04(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Both prohibited and non-qualified investment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) For the purposes of this section and subsections 146(10.1), 146.2(6), 146.3(9) and 207.01(6), if a trust governed by a registered plan holds property at any time that is, for the trust, both a prohibited investment and a non-qualified investment, the property is deemed at that time not to be a non-qualified investment, but remains a prohibited investment, for the trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 207.04(5) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections (1) to (3) are deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>76.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 207.05(4) of the Act before paragraph (<I>b</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Transitional rule<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If an individual so elects before March 2, 2013 in prescribed form, subsection (1) does not apply in respect of any advantage that is an amount included in the calculation of the transitional prohibited investment benefit of the individual for a taxation year provided that the transitional prohibited investment benefit</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) is paid to the individual, from a RRIF or RRSP of the individual, on or before the later of April 2, 2013 and the day that is 90 days after the end of the taxation year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>77.</B> (1) Subsection 207.06(2) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>a</I>), by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>b</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>b</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the extent to which payments have been made from the person’s registered plan.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 207.06(3) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections (1) and (2) are deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>78.</B> (1) Section 207.061 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Income inclusion<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>207.061</B> A holder of a TFSA shall include in computing the holder’s income for a taxation year under Part I any portion of a distribution made in the year that is described in subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(ii) of the definition “specified distribution” in subsection 207.01(1) or subparagraph 207.06(1)(<I>b</I>)(ii) or that is specified by the Minister as part of an agreement to waive or cancel a liability for tax under this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>79.</B> The portion of subsection 207.07(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Return and payment of tax<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>207.07</B> (1) A person who is liable to pay tax under this Part for all or any part of a calendar year shall before July of the following calendar year</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>80.</B> (1) The definition “labour-sponsored funds tax credit” in subsection 211.7(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>a</I>) and by replacing paragraph (<I>b</I>) with the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the original acquisition of the share occurred after 1995 and before March 2, 2017, the amount that would be determined under subsection 127.4(6) — as that subsection would apply in respect of a claim made by the taxpayer under subsection 127.4(2) in respect of the original acquisition if subsection 127.4(6) were read without reference to paragraphs 127.4(6)(<I>b</I>) and (<I>d</I>) — in respect of the share; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) in any other case, nil.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>81.</B> (1) Section 211.81 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Tax for failure to reacquire certain shares<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>211.81</B> If a particular amount is payable under a prescribed provision of a provincial law for a taxation year of an individual as determined for the purposes of that provincial law (referred to in this section as the “relevant provincial year”), and an amount has been included in the computation of the labour-sponsored funds tax credit of the individual under subsection 127.4(6) in respect of an approved share that has been disposed of by a qualifying trust in respect of the individual, the individual shall pay a tax for the taxation year in which the relevant provincial year ends equal to the amount deducted by the individual under subsection 127.4(2) in respect of the share.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on October 24, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>82.</B> (1) Subparagraph 212.1(3)(<I>b</I>)(iv) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) a partnership of which the taxpayer or a person described in one of subparagraphs (i) to (iii) is a majority-interest partner or a member of a majority-interest group of partners (as defined in subsection 251.1(3))</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 212.1(3)(<I>e</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) a “designated partnership” means a partnership of which either a majority-interest partner or every member of a majority-interest group of partners (as defined in subsection 251.1(3)) is a non-resident person; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>83.</B> (1) Paragraph 214(3)(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) where subsection 104(13) would, if Part I were applicable, require any part of an amount payable by a trust in its taxation year to a beneficiary to be included in computing the income of the non-resident person who is a beneficiary of the trust, that part is deemed to be an amount paid or credited to that person as income of or from the trust</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) on, or at, the earliest of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) the day on which the amount was paid or credited,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) the day that is 90 days after the end of the taxation year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) if the taxation year is deemed by subparagraph 128.1(4)(<I>a</I>)(i) to end after July 25, 2012, the time that is immediately before the end of the taxation year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) not at any later time;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on July 25, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>84.</B> (1) Subparagraph 219(1)(<I>d</I>)(ii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) an amount deductible because of paragraphs 111(1)(<I>b</I>) and 115(1)(<I>d</I>) in computing the corporation’s base amount,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 219(1.1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Excluded gains<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) For the purposes of subsection (1), the definition “taxable Canadian property” in subsection 248(1) shall be read without reference to paragraphs (<I>a</I>) and (<I>c</I>) to (<I>e</I>) of that definition and as if the only options, interests or rights referred to in paragraph (<I>f</I>) of that definition were those in respect of property described in paragraph (<I>b</I>) of that definition.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection (1) applies to the 1998 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection (2) is deemed to have come into force on March 5, 2010.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>85.</B> (1) Paragraph 239(2.21)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) who is an official to whom taxpayer information has been provided for a particular purpose under paragraph 241(4)(<I>a</I>), (<I>d</I>), (<I>f</I>), (<I>f.1</I>), (<I>i</I>), (<I>j.1</I>) or (<I>j.2</I>)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 239(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty on conviction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If a person is convicted under this section, the person is not liable to pay a penalty imposed under any of sections 162, 163, 163.2 and 163.3 for the same contravention unless the penalty is assessed before the information or complaint giving rise to the conviction was laid or made.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>(3)</B> Subsection (2) comes into force on the later of the day on which this Act receives royal assent and January 1, 2014.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>86.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 239:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>239.1</B> (1) The definitions in subsection 163.3(1) apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Offences<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Every person that, without lawful excuse, the proof of which lies on the person,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) uses an electronic suppression of sales device or a similar device or software in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) acquires or possesses an electronic suppression of sales device, or a right in respect of an electronic suppression of sales device, that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) designs, develops, manufactures, possesses for sale, offers for sale, sells, transfers or otherwise makes available to another person an electronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) supplies installation, upgrade or maintenance services for an electronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 230, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) participates in, assents to or acquiesces in the commission of, or conspires with any person to commit, an offence described in any of paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">is guilty of an offence and, in addition to any penalty otherwise provided, is liable on summary conviction to a fine of not less than $10,000 and not more than $500,000 or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years, or to both.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Prosecution on indictment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Every person that is charged with an offence described in subsection (2) may, at the election of the Attorney General of Canada, be prosecuted on indictment and, if convicted, is, in addition to any penalty otherwise provided, liable to a fine of not less than $50,000 and not more than $1,000,000 or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding five years, or to both.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty on conviction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A person that is convicted of an offence under this section is not liable to pay a penalty imposed under any of sections 162, 163, 163.2 and 163.3 for the same action unless a notice of assessment for that penalty was issued before the information or complaint giving rise to the conviction was laid or made.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Stay of appeal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If, in any appeal under this Act, substantially the same facts are at issue as those that are at issue in a prosecution under this section, the Minister may file a stay of proceedings with the Tax Court of Canada and, upon that filing, the proceedings before that Court are stayed pending final determination of the outcome of the prosecution.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) comes into force on the later of the day on which this Act receives royal assent and January 1, 2014.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>87.</B> (1) Subparagraphs 241(4)(<I>d</I>)(ix) and (x) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ix) to an official of a department or agency of the Government of Canada or of a province as to the name, address, telephone number, occupation, size or type of business of a taxpayer, solely for the purpose of enabling that department or agency to obtain statistical data for research and analysis,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(x) to an official of the Canada Employment Insurance Commission or the Department of Employment and Social Development, solely for the purpose of the administration or enforcement of the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I>, an employment program of the Government of Canada (including, for greater certainty, any activity relating to a program for temporary foreign workers for which the administration or enforcement is the responsibility of the Minister of Employ-<keep>ment and Social</keep> Development under the <I><keep>Immigration and</keep> Refugee Protection Regulations</I>) or the evaluation or formation of policy for that Act or program,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 241(4)(<I>j.1</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j.1</I>) provide taxpayer information to an official or a designated person solely for the purpose of permitting the making of an adjustment to a social assistance payment made on the basis of a means, needs or income test if the purpose of the adjustment is to take into account the amount determined for C in subsection 122.61(1) in respect of a person for a taxation year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j.2</I>) provide information obtained under section 122.62 to an official of the government of a province solely for the purposes of the administration or enforcement of a prescribed law of the province;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>88.</B> (1) Section 247 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (7):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exclusion — <keep>certain</keep> guarantees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7.1) Subsection (2) does not apply to adjust an amount of consideration paid, payable or accruing to a corporation resident in Canada (in this subsection referred to as the “parent”) in a taxation year of the parent for the provision of a guarantee to a person or partnership (in this subsection referred to as the “lender”) for the repayment, in whole or in part, of a particular amount owing to the lender by a non-resident person, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the non-resident person is a controlled foreign affiliate of the parent for the purposes of section 17 throughout the period in the year during which the particular amount is owing; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) it is established that the particular amount would be an amount owing described in paragraph 17(8)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) if it were owed to the parent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that begin after 1997 and in applying subsection 247(7.1) of the Act, as enacted by subsection (1), to taxation years that begin before February 24, 1998, section 17 of the Act is to be read as it read on January 24, 2005, except that if a taxpayer elects under this subsection in writing and files the election with the Minister of National Revenue on or before the taxpayer’s filing-due date for the taxation year that includes the day on which this Act receives royal assent,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) notwithstanding the time limitations in subsection 152(4) of the Act, the Minister of National Revenue may make such assessments, reassessments and determinations under Part I of the Act as are necessary to give effect to this subsection for a taxation year that ends before that day; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) if the taxpayer so indicates in the election, subsection (1) does not apply to taxation years of the taxpayer that begin before December 22, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>89.</B> (1) The definition “trust” in subsection 248(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“trust”<br />« <I>fiducie</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“trust” has the meaning assigned by subsection 104(1) and, unless the context otherwise requires, includes an estate;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The definition “estate” in subsection 248(1) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“estate”<br />« <I>succession</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“estate” has the meaning assigned by subsection 104(1) and includes, for civil law, a succession;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Clause (<I>e</I>)(iii)(B) of the definition “automobile” in subsection 248(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) at least 30 kilometres outside the nearest point on the boundary of the nearest population centre, as defined by the last census dictionary published by Statistics Canada before the year, that has a population of at least 40,000 individuals as determined in the last census published by Statistics Canada before the year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of the definition “majority interest partner” in subsection 248(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“majority-interest partner”<br />« <I>associé détenant une participation majoritaire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“majority-interest partner”, of a particular partnership at any time, means a person or partnership (in this definition referred to as the “taxpayer”)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 248(1) of the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“derivative forward agreement”<br />« <I>contrat dérivé à terme</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“derivative forward agreement”, of a taxpayer, means an agreement entered into by the taxpayer to purchase or sell a capital property if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the term of the agreement exceeds 180 days or the agreement is part of a series of agreements with a term that exceeds 180 days,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in the case of a purchase agreement, the difference between the fair market value of the property delivered on settlement, including partial settlement, of the agreement and the amount paid for the property is attribut- able, in whole or in part, to an underlying interest (including a value, price, rate, variable, index, event, probability or thing) other than</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) revenue, income or cashflow in respect of the property over the term of the agreement, changes in the fair market value of the property over the term of the agreement, or any similar criteria in respect of the property, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if the purchase price is denominated in the currency of a country other than Canada, changes in the value of the Canadian currency relative to that other currency, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) in the case of a sale agreement,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the difference between the sale price of the property and the fair market value of the property at the time the agreement is entered into by the taxpayer is attributable, in whole or in part, to an underlying interest (including a value, price, rate, variable, index, event, probability or thing) other than</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) revenue, income or cashflow in respect of the property over the term of the agreement, changes in the fair market value of the property over the term of the agreement, or any similar criteria in respect of the property, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if the sale price is denominated in the currency of a country other than Canada, changes in the value of the Canadian currency relative to that other currency, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the agreement is part of an arrangement that has the effect — or would have the effect if the agreements that are part of the arrangement and that were entered into by persons or partnerships not dealing at arm’s length with the taxpayer were entered into by the taxpayer instead of non-arm’s length persons or partnerships— of eliminating a majority of the taxpayer’s risk of loss and opportunity for gain or profit in respect of the property for a period of more than 180 days;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“LIA policy”<br />« <I>police RAL</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“LIA policy” means a life insurance policy (other than an annuity) where </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a particular person or partnership becomes obligated after March 20, 2013 to repay an amount to another person or partnership (in this definition referred to as the “lender”) at a time determined by reference to the death of a particular individ- ual whose life is insured under the policy, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the lender is assigned an interest in</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the policy, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) an annuity contract the terms of which provide that payments are to continue for a period that ends no earlier than the death of the particular individual;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“synthetic disposition arrangement”<br />« <I>arrangement de disposition factice</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“synthetic disposition arrangement”, in respect of a property owned by a taxpayer, means one or more agreements or other arrangements that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) are entered into by the taxpayer or by a person or partnership that does not deal at arm’s length with the taxpayer,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) have the effect, or would have the effect if entered into by the taxpayer instead of the person or partnership, of eliminating all or substantially all the taxpayer’s risk of loss and opportunity for gain or profit in respect of the property for a definite or indefinite period of time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) can, in respect of any agreement or arrangement entered into by a person or partnership that does not deal at arm’s length with the taxpayer, reasonably be considered to have been entered into, in whole or in part, with the purpose of obtaining the effect described in paragraph (<I>b</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“synthetic disposition period”<br />« <I>période de disposition factice</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“synthetic disposition period”, of a synthetic disposition arrangement, means the definite or indefinite period of time during which the synthetic disposition arrangement has, or would have, the effect described in paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “synthetic disposition arrangement” in this subsection;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“10/8 policy”<br />« <I>police 10/8</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“10/8 policy” means a life insurance policy (other than an annuity) where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an amount is or may become</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) payable, under the terms of a borrowing, to a person or partnership that has been assigned an interest in the policy or in an investment account in respect of the policy, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) payable (within the meaning assigned by the definition “amount payable” in subsection 138(12)) under a policy loan (as defined in subsection 148(9)) made in accordance with the terms and conditions of the policy, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) either</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the return credited to an investment account in respect of the policy</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) is determined by reference to the rate of interest on the borrowing or policy loan, as the case may be, described in paragraph (<I>a</I>), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) would not be credited to the account if the borrowing or policy loan, as the case may be, were not in existence, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the maximum amount of an investment account in respect of the policy is determined by reference to the amount of the borrowing or policy loan, as the case may be, described in paragraph (<I>a</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsection (3) applies to the 2013 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsection (5) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013, except that the definitions “LIA policy” and “10/8 policy” in subsection 248(1) of the Act, as amended by subsection (5), apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>90.</B> (1) Subsection 249(4) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event — year end<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If at any time a taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event (other than a foreign affiliate, of a taxpayer resident in Canada, that did not carry on a business in Canada at any time in its last taxation year that began before that time), then for the purposes of this Act,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) subject to paragraph (<I>b</I>), the taxpayer’s taxation year that would, but for this paragraph, have included that time is deemed to end immediately before that time, a new taxation year of the taxpayer is deemed to begin at that time and, for the purpose of determining the taxpayer’s fiscal period after that time, the taxpayer is deemed not to have established a fiscal period before that time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) subject to paragraph 128(1)(<I>d</I>), section 128.1 and paragraphs 142.6(1)(<I>a</I>) and 149(10)(<I>a</I>), and notwithstanding subsections (1) and (3), if the taxpayer’s taxation year that would, but for this subsection, have been its last taxation year that ended before that time, would, but for this paragraph, have ended within the seven-day period that ended immediately before that time, that taxation year is, except if the taxpayer is subject to a loss restriction event within that period, deemed to end immediately before that time, provided that the taxpayer so elects in its return of income under Part I for that taxation year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>91.</B> (1) Paragraph 251.1(1)(<I>e</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) a partnership and a majority-interest partner of the partnership;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “majority-interest group of partners” in subsection 251.1(3) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if one person held the interests of all members of the group, that person would be a majority-interest partner of the partnership; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subparagraph 251.1(4)(<I>d</I>)(iv) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) in determining whether a contributor to one trust is affiliated with a contributor to another trust, individuals connected by blood relationship, marriage, common-law partnership or adoption are deemed to be affiliated with one another.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>92.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 251.1:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>251.2</B> (1) The following definitions apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“beneficiary”<br />« <I>bénéficiaire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“beneficiary” has the same meaning as in subsection 251.1(3).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“equity”<br />« <I>capitaux propres</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“equity” has the same meaning as in subsection 122.1(1) read without reference to paragraph (<I>e</I>) of the definition “equity” in that subsection.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“equity value”<br />« <I>valeur des capitaux propres</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“equity value” has the same meaning as in subsection 122.1(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“majority-interest beneficiary”<br />« <I>bénéficiaires détenant une participation majoritaire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“majority-interest beneficiary” has the same meaning as in subsection 251.1(3).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“majority-interest group of beneficiaries”<br />« <I>groupe de bénéficiaires détenant une participation majoritaire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“majority-interest group of beneficiaries” has the same meaning as in subsection 251.1(3).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“majority-interest group of partners”<br />« <I>groupe d’associés détenant une participation majoritaire</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“majority-interest group of partners” has the same meaning as in subsection 251.1(3).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“person”<br />« <I>personne</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“person” includes a partnership.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“specified right”<br />« <I>droit déterminé</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“specified right”, held at any time by a person in respect of a trust, means a right under a contract, in equity or otherwise, to acquire, either immediately or in the future and either absolutely or contingently, equity of the trust, or to cause the trust to redeem or cancel equity of the trust, unless the right is not exercisable at that time because its exercise is contingent on the death, bankruptcy or permanent disability of an individual.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“subsidiary”<br />« <I>filiale</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“subsidiary”, of a particular person at any time, means a corporation, partnership or trust (in this definition referred to as the “subject entity”) where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the particular person holds at that time property</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that is equity of the subject entity, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) that derives all or part of its fair market value, directly or indirectly, from equity of the subject entity; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the total of the following amounts is at that time equal to more than 50% of the equity value of the subject entity:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) each amount that is the fair market value at that time of equity of the subject entity that is held at that time by the particular person or a person with whom the particular person is affiliated, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) each amount (other than an amount described in subparagraph (i)) that is the portion of the fair market value at that time — derived directly or indirectly from equity of the subject entity — of a property that is held at that time by the particular person or a person with whom the particular person is affiliated.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Loss restriction event<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) For the purposes of this Act, a taxpayer is at any time subject to a loss restriction event if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the taxpayer is a corporation and at that time control of the corporation is acquired by a person or group of persons; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the taxpayer is a trust and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that time is after March 20, 2013 and after the time at which the trust is created, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) at that time a person becomes a majority-interest beneficiary, or a group of persons becomes a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, of the trust.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Trusts — <keep>exceptions</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) For the purposes of paragraph (2)(<I>b</I>), a person is deemed not to become a majority-interest beneficiary, and a group of persons is deemed not to become a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, as the case may be, of a particular trust solely because of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the acquisition of equity of the particular trust by</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a particular person from another person with whom the particular person was affiliated immediately before the acquisition,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) a particular person who was affiliated with the particular trust immediately before the acquisition,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) an estate from an individual, if the estate arose on and as a consequence of the death of the individual and the estate acquired the equity from the individual as a consequence of the death, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) a particular person from an estate that arose on and as a consequence of the death of an individual, if the estate acquired the equity from the individual as a consequence of the death and the individual was affiliated with the particular person immediately before the death;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a variation in the terms of the particular trust, the satisfaction of, or failure to satisfy, a condition under the terms of the particular trust, the exercise by any person of, or the failure by any person to exercise, a power, or (without limiting the generality of the foregoing) the redemption, surrender or termination of equity of the particular trust at any time, if each majority-interest beneficiary, and each member of a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, of the particular trust immediately after that time was affiliated with the particular trust immediately before</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that time, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) in the case of the redemption or surrender of equity of the particular trust that was held, immediately before that time, by an estate and that was acquired by the estate from an individual as described in subparagraph (<I>a</I>)(iii), the individual’s death;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the transfer at any time of all the equity of the particular trust to a corporation, partnership or another trust (in this paragraph referred to as the “acquirer”), if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the only consideration for the transfer is equity (determined without reference to paragraph (<I>d</I>) of the definition “equity” in subsection 122.1(1)) of the acquirer,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) at all times before that time the acquirer held no property or held only property having a nominal value, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) immediately after that time the acquirer is neither</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a subsidiary of any person, nor</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) a corporation controlled, directly or indirectly in any manner whatever, by a person or group of persons;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the transfer at any time of equity of the particular trust to a corporation, partnership or another trust (in this paragraph referred to as the “acquirer”), if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) immediately before that time a person was a majority-interest beneficiary, or a group of persons was a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, of the particular trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) immediately after that time the person, or group of persons, as the case may be, described in subparagraph (i) in respect of the particular trust, and no other person or group of persons, is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) if the acquirer is a corporation, a person by whom, or a group of persons by which, the corporation is controlled directly or indirectly in any manner whatever,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) if the acquirer is a partnership, a majority-interest partner, or a majority-interest group of partners, of the partnership, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) if the acquirer is a trust, a majority-interest beneficiary, or a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, of the trust, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) at no time during a series of transactions or events that includes the transfer does the person or group of persons, as the case may be, described in subparagraph (i) in respect of the particular trust, cease to be a person or group of persons described in any of clauses (ii)(A) to (C) in respect of the acquirer; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) a transaction (other than a transaction one or more of the parties to which may be excused from completing as a result of changes to this Act) the parties to which are obligated to complete under the terms of an agreement in writing between the parties entered into before March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Trusts — <keep>additional</keep> cases<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) For the purposes of paragraph (2)(<I>b</I>) and subject to subsection (3), a person is deemed to become at a particular time a majority-interest beneficiary of a particular trust if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a particular person is at and immediately before the particular time a majority-interest beneficiary, or a member of a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, of the partic- ular trust, and the particular person is at the particular time, but is not immediately before the particular time, a subsidiary of another person (in this paragraph referred to as the “acquirer”), unless</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the acquirer is immediately before the particular time affiliated with the particular trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) this paragraph previously applied to deem a person to become a majority-interest beneficiary of the particular trust because the particular person became, as part of a series of transactions or events that includes the particular person becoming at the particular time a subsidiary of the acquirer, a subsidiary of another person that is at the particular time a subsidiary of the acquirer; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) at the particular time, as part of a series of transactions or events, two or more persons acquire equity of the particular trust in exchange for or upon a redemption or surrender of equity of, or as a consequence of a distribution from, a corporation, partnership or another trust, unless</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a person affiliated with the corporation, partnership or other trust was immediately before the particular time a majority-interest beneficiary of the particular trust,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) if all the equity of the particular trust that was acquired at or before the particular time as part of the series were acquired by one person, the person would not at the particular time be a majority-interest beneficiary of the particular trust, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) this paragraph previously applied to deem a person to become a majority-interest beneficiary of the particular trust because of an acquisition of equity of the particular trust that was part of the series.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Trusts — special rules of application<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) For the purposes of this section,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in determining whether persons are affiliated with each other</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) except for the purposes of paragraph (<I>b</I>) of the definition “subsidiary” in subsection (1), section 251.1 is to be read without reference to the definition “controlled” in subsection 251.1(3),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) in determining whether an individual (other than a trust) is affiliated with another individual (other than a trust), individuals connected by blood relationship, marriage or common-law partnership or adoption are deemed to be affiliated with one another, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) if, at any time as part of a series of transactions or events a person acquires equity of a corporation, partnership or trust, and it can reasonably be concluded that one of the reasons for the acquisition, or for making any agreement or undertaking in respect of the acquisition, is to cause a condition in paragraph (3)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) or subparagraph (4)(<I>a</I>)(i) or (<I>b</I>)(i) regarding affiliation to be satisfied at a particular time, the condition is deemed not to be satisfied at the particular time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in determining whether a particular person becomes at any time a majority-interest beneficiary, or a particular group of persons becomes at any time a majority-interest group of beneficiaries, of a trust, the fair market value of each person’s equity of the trust is to be determined at and immediately before that time</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) without reference to the portion of that fair market value that is attributable to property acquired if it can reasonably be concluded that one of the reasons for the acquisition is to cause paragraph (2)(<I>b</I>), or any provision that applies by reference to a trust being subject to a loss restriction event at any time, not to apply,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) without reference to the portion of that fair market value that is attributable to a change in the fair market value of all or part of any equity of the trust if it can reasonably be concluded that one of the reasons for the change is to cause paragraph (2)(<I>b</I>), or any provision that applies by reference to a trust being subject to a loss restriction event at any time, not to apply, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) as if each specified right held immediately before that time by the particular person, or by a member of the particular group, in respect of the trust is at that time exercised if it can reasonably be concluded that one of the reasons for the acquisition of the right is to cause paragraph (2)(<I>b</I>), or any provision that applies by reference to a trust being subject to a loss restriction event at any time, not to apply.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Trusts — time of day<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) For the purposes of this Act, if a trust is subject to a loss restriction event at a particular time during a day, the trust is deemed to be subject to the loss restriction event at the beginning of that day and not at the particular time unless the trust elects in its return of income under Part I filed for its taxation year that ends immediately before the loss restriction event to have this subsection not apply.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>93.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 256(7) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Acquiring control<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) For the purposes of this subsection, of section 55, subsections 66(11), 66.5(3), 66.7(10) and (11), 85(1.2), 88(1.1) and (1.2), 110.1(1.2) and 111(5.4) and paragraph 251.2(2)(<I>a</I>) and of subsection 5905(5.2) of the <I>Income Tax Regulations</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Clause 256(7)(<I>a</I>)(i)(D) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(D) a particular person who acquired the shares from an estate that arose on and as a consequence of the death of an individual, if the estate acquired the shares from the individual as a consequence of the death and the individual was related to the particular person immediately before the death,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 256(7) of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>f</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>g</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) if at any time after September 12, 2013 a trust is subject to a loss restriction event and immediately before that time the trust, or a group of persons a member of which is the trust, controls a corporation, control of the corporation and of each corporation controlled by it immediately before that time is deemed to have been acquired at that time by a person or group of persons; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>i</I>) if at any time after September 12, 2013 a trust controls a corporation, control of the corporation is deemed not to be acquired solely because of a change in the trustee or legal representative having ownership or control of the trust’s property if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the change is not part of a series of transactions or events that includes a change in the beneficial ownership of the trust’s property, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) no amount of income or capital of the trust to be distributed, at any time at or after the change, in respect of any interest in the trust depends upon the exercise by any person or partnership, or the failure of any person or partnership, to exercise any discretionary power.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of subsection 256(8) of the French version of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Présomption d’exercice de droit<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">(8) Pour ce qui est de déterminer, d’une part, si le contrôle d’une société a été acquis pour l’application des paragraphes 10(10) et 13(24), de l’article 37, des paragraphes 55(2), 66(11), (11.4) et (11.5), 66.5(3) et 66.7(10) et (11), de l’article 80, de l’alinéa 80.04(4)<I>h</I>), du sous-alinéa 88(1)<I>c</I>)(vi), de l’alinéa 88(1)<I>c.3</I>), des paragraphes 88(1.1) et (1.2), des articles 111 et 127, des paragraphes 181.1(7), 190.1(6) et 249(4) et de l’alinéa 251.2(2)<I>a</I>) et, d’autre part, si une société est contrôlée par une personne ou par un groupe de personnes pour l’application de l’article 251.1 et des alinéas 251.2(3)<I>c</I>) et <I>d</I>), le contribuable qui a acquis un droit visé à l’alinéa 251(5)<I>b</I>) afférent à une action est réputé être dans la même position relativement au contrôle de la société que si le droit était immédiat et absolu et que s’il l’avait exercé au moment de l’acquisition, dans le cas où il est raisonnable de conclure que l’un des principaux motifs de l’acquisition du droit consistait :</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Paragraph 256(8)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) to avoid the application of subsection 10(10) or 13(24), paragraph 37(1)(<I>h</I>) or subsection 55(2) or 66(11.4) or (11.5), paragraph 88(1)(<I>c.3</I>) or subsection 111(4), (5.1), (5.2) or (5.3), 181.1(7), 190.1(6) or 251.2(2),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The portion of subsection 256(8) of the English version of the Act after paragraph (<I>e</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">the taxpayer is deemed to be in the same position in relation to the control of the corporation as if the right were immediate and absolute and as if the taxpayer had exercised the right at that time for the purpose of determining whether control of a corporation has been acquired for the purposes of subsections 10(10) and 13(24), section 37, subsections 55(2), 66(11), (11.4) and (11.5), 66.5(3), 66.7(10) and (11), section 80, paragraph 80.04(4)(<I>h</I>), subparagraph 88(1)(<I>c</I>)(vi), paragraph 88(1)(<I>c.3</I>), subsections 88(1.1) and (1.2), sections 111 and 127, subsections 181.1(7), 190.1(6) and 249(4) and paragraph 251.2(2)(<I>a</I>) and in determining for the purposes of section 251.1 and paragraphs 251.2(3)(<I>c</I>) and (<I>d</I>) whether a corporation is controlled by any other person or group of persons.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsections (1) and (3) to (6) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection (2) is deemed to have come into force on September 13, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>94.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 256:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>256.1</B> (1) The following definitions apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“attribute trading restriction”<br />« <I>restriction au commerce d’attributs</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“attribute trading restriction” means a restriction on the use of a tax attribute arising on the application, either alone or in combination with other provisions, of any of this section, subsections 10(10) and 13(24), section 37, subsections 66(11.4) and (11.5), 66.7(10) and (11), 69(11) and 88(1.1) and (1.2), sections 111 and 127 and subsections 181.1(7), 190.1(6), 249(4) and 256(7).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“person”<br />« <I>personne</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“person” includes a partnership.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“specified provision”<br />« <I>dispositions déterminées</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“specified provision” means any of subsections 10(10) and 13(24), paragraph 37(1)(<I>h</I>), subsections 66(11.4) and (11.5), 66.7(10) and (11), 69(11) and 111(4), (5), (5.1), (5.2) and (5.3), paragraphs (<I>j</I>) and (<I>k</I>) of the definition “investment tax credit” in subsection 127(9), subsections 181.1(7) and 190.1(6) and any provision of similar effect.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of subsection (3)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsection (3) applies at a particular time in respect of a corporation if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) shares of the capital stock of the corporation held by a person, or the total of all shares of the capital stock of the corporation held by members of a group of persons, as the case may be, have at the particular time a fair market value that exceeds 75% of the fair market value of all the shares of the capital stock of the corporation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) shares, if any, of the capital stock of the corporation held by the person, or the total of all shares, if any, of the capital stock of the corporation held by members of the group, have immediately before the particular time a fair market value that does not exceed 75% of the fair market value of all the shares of the capital stock of the corporation;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the person or group does not control the corporation at the particular time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) it is reasonable to conclude that one of the main reasons that the person or group does not control the corporation is to avoid the application of one or more specified provisions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deemed acquisition of control<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If this subsection applies at a particular time in respect of a corporation, then for the purposes of the attribute trading restrictions,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the person or group referred to in subsection (2)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) is deemed to acquire control of the corporation, and each corporation controlled by the corporation, at the particular time, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) is not deemed to have control of the corporation, and each corporation controlled by the corporation, at any time after the particular time solely because this paragraph applied at the particular time; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) during the period that the condition in paragraph (2)(<I>a</I>) is satisfied, each corporation referred to in paragraph (<I>a</I>) — and any corporation incorporated or otherwise formed subsequent to that time and controlled by that corporation — is deemed not to be related to, or affiliated with, any person to which it was related to, or affiliated with, immediately before paragraph (<I>a</I>) applies.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Special rules<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) For the purpose of applying paragraph <keep>(2)(<I>a</I>)</keep> in respect of a person or group of persons,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if it is reasonable to conclude that one of the reasons that one or more transactions or events occur is to cause a person or group of persons not to hold shares having a fair market value that exceeds 75% of the fair market value of all the shares of the capital stock of a corporation, the paragraph is to be applied without reference to those transactions or events; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the person, or each member of the group, is deemed to have exercised each right that is held by the person or a member of the group and that is referred to in paragraph 251(5)(<I>b</I>) in respect of a share of the corporation referred to in paragraph (2)(<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deeming rules — if share value nil<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) For the purposes of subsections (2) to (4), if the fair market value of the shares of the capital stock of a corporation is nil at any time, then for the purpose of determining the fair market value of those shares, the corporation is deemed, at that time, to have assets net of liabilities equal to $100,000 and to have $100,000 of income for the taxation year that includes that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deemed acquisition of control<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If, at any time as part of a transaction or event or series of transactions or events, control of a particular corporation is acquired by a person or group of persons and it can reasonably be concluded that one of the main reasons for the acquisition of control is so that a specified provision does not apply to one or more corporations, the attribute trading restrictions are deemed to apply to each of those corporations as if control of each of those corporations were acquired at that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013, except that it does not apply to an event or transaction that occurs</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) before March 21, 2013, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) after March 20, 2013 pursuant to an obligation created by the terms of an agreement in writing entered into between parties before March 21, 2013, and for the purposes of this paragraph, parties will be considered not to be obligated if one or more of those parties may be excused from fulfilling the obligation as a result of changes to the Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Keeping Canada’s Economy and Jobs Growing Act--><MarginalNote>2011, c. 24<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Keeping Canada’s Economy and Jobs Growing Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>95.</B> (1) Paragraph 64(6)(<I>a</I>) of the <I>Keeping Canada’s Economy and Jobs Growing Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) after 2021 in relation to a swap transaction undertaken to remove a property from a RRIF or RRSP if it is reasonable to conclude that tax would be payable under Part XI.01 of the Act if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) that Part were read without reference to subsection 207.05(4) of the Act, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) the property were retained in the RRIF or RRSP; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on December 15, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Income Tax Regulations--><MarginalNote>C.R.C., c. 945<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Income Tax Regulations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>96.</B> (1) Section 201 of the <I>Income Tax Regulations</I> is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) Subsection (5) applies to an insurer in respect of an LIA policy in respect of a calendar year only if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the insurer is notified in writing — before the end of the calendar year and by, or on behalf, of the policyholder — that the policy is an LIA policy; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) it is reasonable to conclude that the insurer knew, or ought to have known, before the end of the calendar year, that the policy is an LIA policy.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>(2)</B> Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>97.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 306(1) of the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>306.</B> (1) For the purposes of this Part and subsection 12.2(11) of the Act, “exempt policy” at any time means a life insurance policy (other than an annuity contract, LIA policy or a deposit administration fund policy) in respect of which the following conditions are met at that time:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>(2)</B> Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>98.</B> (1) Paragraph 600(<I>b</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) subsections 13(4), (7.4) and (29), 14(6), 20(24), 44(1) and (6), 45(2) and (3), 50(1), 53(2.1), 56.4(13), 70(6.2), (9.01), (9.11), (9.21) and (9.31), 72(2), 73(1), 80.1(1), 82(3), 83(2), 104(14), 107(2.001), 143(2), 146.01(7), 146.02(7), 164(6) and (6.1), 184(3), 251.2(6) and 256(9) of the Act;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>99.</B> (1) The portion of section 806.2 of the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>806.2</B> For the purposes of the definition “participating debt interest” in subsection 212(3) of the Act, an obligation is a prescribed obligation if it is an indexed debt obligation and no amount payable in respect of it is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on January 1, 2008.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>100.</B> (1) Paragraph 1100(1)(<I>a</I>) of the Regulations is amended by adding the following after subparagraph (xxvii.1):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(xxvii.2) of Class 41.2, 25 per cent,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraph 1100(1)(<I>w</I>)(i) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mine, before making any deduction under this paragraph, paragraph (<I>x</I>), (<I>y</I>), (<I>y.1</I>), (<I>y.2</I>), (<I>ya</I>), (<I>ya.1</I>) or (<I>ya.2</I>), section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subparagraph 1100(1)(<I>x</I>)(i) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mines, before making any deduction under this paragraph, paragraph (<I>ya</I>), (<I>ya.1</I>) or (<I>ya.2</I>), section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subparagraph 1100(1)(<I>y</I>)(i) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mine, before making any deduction under this paragraph, paragraph (<I>x</I>), (<I><I>ya</I></I>), (<I>ya.1</I>) or (<I>ya.2</I>), section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subparagraph (i) of the description of A in paragraph 1100(1)(<I>y.1</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mine, before making any deduction under this paragraph, paragraph (<I>x</I>), (<I>y</I>), (<I>y.2</I>), (<I>ya</I>), (<I>ya.1</I>) or (<I>ya.2</I>), section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The description of B in paragraph 1100(1)(<I>y.1</I>) of the Regulations is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subparagraph (iv), by adding “and” at the end of subparagraph (v) and by adding the following after subparagraph (v):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) 0%, if one or more days in the year are after 2014;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Subsection 1100(1) of the Regulations is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>y.1</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Center"><I>Additional Allowances — Class 41.2 — Single Mine Properties</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>y.2</I>) such additional amount as the taxpayer may claim in respect of property acquired for the purpose of gaining or producing income from a mine and for which a separate class is prescribed by subsection 1101(4g), not exceeding the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula"> A × B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mine, before making any deduction under this paragraph, paragraph (<I>x</I>), (<I>y</I>), (<I>ya</I>), (<I>ya.1</I>) or (<I>ya.2</I>), section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the undepreciated capital cost to the taxpayer of property of that class as of the end of the year computed</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) without reference to subsection (2),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) after making any deduction under paragraph (<I>a</I>) for the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) before making any deduction under this paragraph, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the percentage that is the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that proportion of 100% that the number of days in the year that are before 2017 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) that proportion of 90% that the number of days in the year that are in 2017 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) that proportion of 80% that the number of days in the year that are in 2018 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) that proportion of 60% that the number of days in the year that are in 2019 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) that proportion of 30% that the number of days in the year that are in 2020 is of the number of days in the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) 0%, if one or more days in the year are after 2020;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subparagraph (i) of the description of A in paragraph 1100(1)(<I>ya.1</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mines, before making any deduction under this paragraph, paragraph (<I>ya</I>) or (<I>ya.2</I>), section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) The description of B in paragraph 1100(1)(<I>ya.1</I>) of the Regulations is amended by striking out “and” at the end of subparagraph (iv), by adding “and” at the end of subparagraph (v) and by adding the following after subparagraph (v):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) 0%, if one or more days in the year are after 2014;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subsection 1100(1) of the Regulations is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>ya.1</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Center"><I>Additional allowances Class 41.2 — Multiple Mine Properties</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>ya.2</I>) such additional amount as the taxpayer may claim in respect of a property acquired for the purpose of gaining or producing income from more than one mine and for which a separate class is prescribed by subsection 1101(4h), not exceeding the amount determined by the formula</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula"> A × B</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>A</keep><Tab />is the lesser of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the taxpayer’s income for the taxation year from the mines, before making any deduction under this <keep>paragraph,</keep> <keep>paragraph (<I>ya</I>),</keep> section 65, 66, 66.1, 66.2 or 66.7 of the Act or section 29 of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the undepreciated capital cost to the taxpayer of property of that class as of the end of the year computed</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) without reference to subsection (2),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) after making any deduction under paragraph (<I>a</I>) for the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="9" FirstLineIndent="0">(C) before making any deduction under this paragraph, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="5" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>B</keep><Tab />is the percentage that is the total of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) that proportion of 100% that the number of days in the year that are before 2017 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) that proportion of 90% that the number of days in the year that are in 2017 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) that proportion of 80% that the number of days in the year that are in 2018 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) that proportion of 60% that the number of days in the year that are in 2019 is of the number of days in the year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(v) that proportion of 30% that the number of days in the year that are in 2020 is of the number of days in the year, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="7" FirstLineIndent="0">(vi) 0%, if one or more days in the year are after 2020;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(11) Paragraph 1100(12)(<I>b</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a partnership each member of which was</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a corporation described in paragraph (<I>a</I>), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) another partnership described in this paragraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(12) Paragraph 1100(16)(<I>b</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a partnership each member of which was</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a corporation described in paragraph (<I>a</I>), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) another partnership described in this paragraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(13) Subparagraph 1100(25)(<I>b</I>)(iv) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iv) a partnership each member of which was</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(A) a corporation described in subparagraph (iii) or paragraph (26)(<I>a</I>), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="6" FirstLineIndent="0">(B) another partnership described in this subparagraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(14) Paragraph 1100(26)(<I>b</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a partnership each member of which was</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) a corporation described in paragraph (<I>a</I>), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) another partnership described in this paragraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(15) Subsections (1) to (10) apply to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(16) Subsections (11) to (14) apply to fiscal periods that end after October 2010.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>101.</B> (1) Section 1101 of the Regulations is amended by adding the following after subsection (4f):<PageBreak /></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Center"><I>Class 41.2 — Single Mine Properties</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(4g) If one or more properties of a taxpayer are described in paragraph (<I>a</I>) of Class 41.2 of Schedule II and some or all of the properties were acquired for the purpose of gaining or producing income from one mine and not from any other mine (in this subsection referred to as “single mine properties”), a separate class is prescribed for the single mine properties that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) were acquired for the purpose of gaining or producing income from that mine;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) would otherwise be included in Class 41.2 because of paragraph (<I>a</I>) of that class; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>c</I>) are not included in a separate class because of subsection (4h).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Center"><I>Class 41.2 — Multiple Mine Properties</I></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(4h) If more than one property of a taxpayer is described in paragraph (<I>a</I>) of Class 41.2 in Schedule II and some or all of the properties were acquired for the purpose of gaining or producing income from particular mines and not from any other mine (in this subsection referred to as “multiple mine properties”), a separate class is prescribed for the multiple mine properties that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) were acquired for the purpose of gaining or producing income from the particular mines; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) would otherwise be included in Class 41.2 because of paragraph (<I>a</I>) of that class.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to taxation years that end after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>102.</B> (1) Paragraph 1102(8)(<I>d</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) Class 41, 41.1 or 41.2 in Schedule II in any other case, unless the property would otherwise be included in Class 43.1 or 43.2 in Schedule II and the taxpayer has, by a letter filed with the taxpayer’s return of income filed with the Minister in accordance with section 150 of the Act for the taxation year in which the property was acquired, elected to include the property in Class 43.1 or 43.2, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 1102(9)(<I>d</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) Class 41, 41.1 or 41.2 in Schedule II in any other case, unless the property would otherwise be included in Class 43.1 or 43.2 in Schedule II and the taxpayer has, by a letter filed with the taxpayer’s return of income filed with the Minister in accordance with section 150 of the Act for the taxation year in which the property was acquired, elected to include the property in Class 43.1 or 43.2, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 1102(10) of the Regulations and the heading before it are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of subsection 1102(14) of the Regulations that is before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(14) Subject to subsections (14.11) and (14.12), for the purposes of this Part and Schedule II, if a property is acquired by a taxpayer</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Section 1102 of the Regulations is amended by adding the following after subsection (14.11):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(14.12) If, after March 20, 2013, a taxpayer acquires a property (other than an oil sands property) in circumstances to which subsection (14) applies and the property was depreciable property that was included in Class 41, because of paragraph (<I>a</I>) or (<I>a.1</I>) of that Class, by the person or partnership from whom the taxpayer acquired the property, the following rules apply:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) there may be included in Class 41 of the taxpayer only that portion of the property the capital cost of which portion to the taxpayer is the lesser of the undepreciated capital cost of Class 41 of that person or partnership immediately before the disposition of the property by the person or partnership and the amount, if any, by which that undepreciated capital cost is reduced as a result of that disposition; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) there shall be included in Class 41.2 of the taxpayer that portion, if any, of the property that is not the portion included in Class 41 of the taxpayer under paragraph (<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections (1), (2), (4) and (5) apply to property acquired after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) An election referred to in paragraph 1102(8)(<I>d</I>) or (9)(<I>d</I>) of the Regulations, as enacted by subsections (1) and (2), made by a taxpayer in respect of a property is deemed to have been filed in the manner described in those paragraphs for the taxation year in which the property was acquired if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) the election is filed with the Minister in writing on or before the day that is 180 days after the day on which this Act receives royal assent; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the property is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) an eligible mine development property as defined in subsection 1104(2) of the Regulations, as amended by subsection 103(1), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) described in Class 41.2 in Schedule II to the Regulations, as enacted by subsection 118(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection (3) applies in respect of expenditures incurred in taxation years that begin after December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>103.</B> (1) Subsection 1104(2) of the Regulations is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“eligible mine development property” means a property acquired by a taxpayer after March 20, 2013 and before 2018 for the purpose of gaining or producing income</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) from a new mine or an expansion of a mine, if the property was acquired under a written agreement entered into by the taxpayer before March 21, 2013,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) from a new mine, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the construction of the new mine was started by, or on behalf of, the taxpayer before March 21, 2013 (and for this purpose construction does not include obtaining permits or regulatory approvals, conducting environmental assessments, community consultations or impact benefit studies, and similar activities), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the engineering and design work for the construction of the new mine, as evidenced in writing, was started by, or on behalf of, the taxpayer before March 21, 2013 (and for this purpose engineering and design work does not include obtaining permits or regulatory approvals, conducting environmental assessments, community consultations or impact benefit studies, and similar activities), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) from an expansion of a mine, if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) the construction for the expansion of the mine was started by, or on behalf of, the taxpayer before March 21, 2013 (and for this purpose construction does not include obtaining permits or regulatory approvals, conducting environmental assessments, community consultations or impact benefit studies, and similar activities), or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the engineering and design work for the construction of the expansion of the mine, as evidenced in writing, was started by, or on behalf of, the taxpayer before March 21, 2013 (and for this purpose engineering and design work does not include obtaining permits or regulatory approvals, conducting environmental assessments, community consultations or impact benefit studies, and similar activities); (<AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>bien admissible à l’aménagement d’une mine</I>)</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subsection 1104(5) of the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) For the purposes of paragraphs 1100(1)(<I>w</I>) to (<I>ya.2</I>), subsections 1101(4a) to (4h) and Classes 10, 28 and 41 to 41.2 of Schedule II, a taxpayer’s “income from a mine”, or any expression referring to a taxpayer’s income from a mine, includes income reasonably attributable to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The portion of subsection 1104(5.1) of the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) For the purposes of Classes 41 to 41.2 of Schedule II, a taxpayer’s “gross revenue from a mine” includes</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of subsection 1104(7) of the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) For the purposes of paragraphs 1100(1)(<I>w</I>) to (<I>ya.2</I>), subsections 1101(4a) to (4h) and 1102(8) and (9), section 1107 and Classes 12, 28 and 41 to 41.2 of Schedule II,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 1104(8.1) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8.1) For greater certainty, for the purposes of paragraphs (<I>c</I>) and (<I>e</I>) of Class 28 and paragraph (<I>a</I>) of Classes 41 to 41.2 in Schedule II, “production” means production in reasonable commercial quantities.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The definition “biogas” in subsection 1104(13) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“biogas” means the gas produced by the anaerobic digestion of organic waste that is food and animal waste, manure, plant residue, pulp and paper by-product, separated organics, wood waste or sludge from an eligible sewage treatment facility. (<AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>biogaz</I></AltLang>)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Paragraphs (<I>a</I>) and (<I>b</I>) of the definition “food and animal waste” in subsection 1104(13) of the Regulations are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) generated during the preparation or processing of food or beverage for human or animal consumption;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) food or beverage that is no longer fit for human or animal consumption; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection 1104(13) of the Regulations is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“pulp and paper by-product” means tall oil soaps and crude tall oil that are produced as by-products of the processing of wood into pulp or paper and the by-product of a pulp or paper plant’s effluent treatment or its de-inking processes. (<AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>sous-produit d’usine de pâtes ou papiers</I></AltLang>)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“separated organics” means organic waste (other than waste that is considered to be toxic or hazardous waste under any law of Canada or a province) that could, but for its use in a system that converts biomass into biogas, be disposed of in an eligible waste management facility or eligible landfill site. (<AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>matières organiques séparées</I></AltLang>)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsections (1) to (5) and (8) are deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subsections (6) and (7) apply in respect of property acquired after March 20, 2013 that has not been used or acquired for use before March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>104.</B> (1) Paragraph 3003(<I>c</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) <I>Individual and Family Assistance Act</I>, <keep>R.S.Q.,</keep> c. A-13.1.1, as it relates to the additional amounts for dependent children.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on January 1, 2007.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>105.</B> Part XXX of the Regulations, as amended by section 104, is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>106.</B> (1) Paragraph 4600(1)(<I>b</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) that is included or would, but for Class 28, 41, 41.1 or 41.2 in Schedule II, be included in paragraph (<I>g</I>) of Class 10 in Schedule II.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 4600(2)(<I>j</I>) of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j</I>) a property included in Class 28, in paragraph (<I>a</I>), (<I>a.1</I>), (<I>a.2</I>) or (<I>a.3</I>) of Class 41 or in Class 41.1 or 41.2 in Schedule II that would, but for Class 28, 41, 41.1 or 41.2, as the case may be, be included in paragraph (<I>k</I>) or (<I>r</I>) of Class 10 of Schedule II;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections (1) and (2) apply to property acquired after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>107.</B> (1) The headings before section 4900 of the Regulations are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Previous"><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART XLIX</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:REGISTERED PLANS — INVESTMENTS--><Para TopMargin="5" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">REGISTERED PLANS — INVESTMENTS</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>108.</B> (1) Section 4900 of the Regulations is amended by adding the following after subsection (14):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(15) For the purposes of the definition “prohibited investment” in subsection 207.01(1) of the Act, property that is a qualified investment for a trust governed by a RRIF, RRSP or TFSA solely because of subsection (14) is prescribed property for the trust at any time if, at that time, the property is not described in any of subparagraphs (14)(<I>a</I>)(i) to (iii).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>109.</B> (1) Part L of the Regulations is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 23, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>110.</B> The portion of the definition “gross cost” in section 5204 of the Regulations after paragraph (<I>b</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">and, for the purposes of paragraph (<I>a</I>), if the partnership acquired the property from a person who was a majority-interest partner of the partnership immediately after the property was acquired, the capital cost to the partnership of the property is to be computed as if the property had been acquired at a capital cost equal to the gross cost to the person of the property, except that if the property was partnership property on December 31, 1971, its gross cost is its capital cost to the partnership as determined under subsection 20(3) or (5) of the <I>Income Tax Application Rules</I>. (<AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>coût brut</I></AltLang>)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>111.</B> (1) Section 5600 of the Regulations is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>b</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>c</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the distribution by Fiat S.p.A., on January 1, 2011 to its common shareholders, of common shares of Fiat Industrial S.p.A;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) the distribution by Foster’s Group Limited, on May 9, 2011 to its common shareholders, of common shares of Treasury Wine Estates Limited; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the distribution by Telecom Corporation of New Zealand Limited, on November 30, 2011 to its common shareholders, of common shares of Chorus Limited.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on January 1, 2011.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>112.</B> The Regulations are amended by adding the following before section 6501:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>6500.</B> For the purposes of paragraph 241(4)(<I>j.2</I>) of the Act, the following are prescribed laws of the Province of Quebec:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) <I>An Act respecting the Québec Pension Plan</I>, R.S.Q., c. R-9; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) <I>Individual and Family Assistance Act</I>, <keep>R.S.Q.,</keep> c. A-13.1.1, as it relates to the additional amounts for dependent children.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>113.</B> (1) The Regulations are amended by adding the following after section 6701:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>6701.1</B> Notwithstanding section 6701, a corporation that applies after March 20, 2013 for registration under a provincial act listed in that section is not a prescribed labour-sponsored venture capital corporation for the purposes of the definition “approved share” in subsection 127.4(1) of the Act and the definition “eligible investment” in subsection 204.8(1) of the Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>114.</B> (1) Section 8200.1 of the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>8200.1</B> For the purposes of subsection 13(18.1), the definition “Canadian renewable and conservation expense” in subsection 66.1(6) and subparagraph 241(4)(<I>d</I>)(vi.1) of the Act, “prescribed energy conservation property” means property described in Class 43.1 or 43.2 in Schedule II.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on December 21, 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>115.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 8900(1) of the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>8900.</B> (1) For the purposes of subparagraph 110(1)(<I>f</I>)(iii) and paragraph 126(3)(<I>a</I>) of the Act, the following international organizations are prescribed:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to the 2013 and subsequent taxation years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>116.</B> (1) The portion of Class 10 in Sched- ule II to the Regulations after paragraph (<I>f.2</I>) and before paragraph (<I>g</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">and property (other than property included in Class 41, 41.1 or 41.2 or property included in Class 43 that is described in paragraph (<I>b</I>) of that Class) that would otherwise be included in another Class in this Schedule, that is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to property acquired after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>117.</B> (1) The portion of Class 41 in Sched- ule II to the Regulations before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Property (other than property included in Class 41.1 or 41.2)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) applies to property acquired after March 20, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>118.</B> (1) Schedule II to the Regulations is amended by adding the following after Class 41.1:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Center"><SC SC_PerCent="85">Class 41.2</SC></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">Property, other than an oil sands property or eligible mine development property,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) that is acquired by a taxpayer after March 20, 2013 and before 2021 and that, if acquired on March 20, 2013, would be included in paragraph (<I>a</I>) or (<I>a.1</I>) of Class 41; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) that is acquired by a taxpayer after 2020 and that, if acquired on March 20, 2013, would be included in paragraph (<I>a</I>) or (<I>a.1</I>) of Class 41.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>119.</B> (1) Subparagraph (<I>d</I>)(viii) of Class 43.1 in Schedule II to the Regulations is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(viii) equipment used by the taxpayer, or by a lessee of the taxpayer, primarily for the purpose of collecting landfill gas or digester gas, including such equipment that consists of piping (including above or below ground piping and the cost of drilling a well, or trenching, for the purpose of installing that piping), fans, compressors, storage tanks, heat exchang- ers and related equipment used to collect gas, to remove non-combustibles and contaminants from the gas or to store the gas, but not including property otherwise included in Class 10 or 17,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subparagraph (<I>d</I>)(xiii) of Class 43.1 in Schedule II to the Regulations before clause (A) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(xiii) property that is part of a system that is used by the taxpayer, or by a lessee of the taxpayer, primarily to produce and store biogas, including equipment that is an anaerobic digester reactor, a buffer tank, a pre-treatment tank, biogas piping, a fan, a compressor, a heat exchanger, a biogas storage tank and equipment used to remove non-combustibles and contaminants from the gas, but not including</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections (1) and (2) apply in respect of property acquired after March 20, 2013 that has not been used or acquired for use before March 21, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coordinating Amendment--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coordinating Amendment</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>120.</B> If this Act receives royal assent on or before January 1, 2014, then subsection 9(5) of the <I>Jobs and Growth Act, 2012</I> is deemed never to have come into force and is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 2</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:EXCISE TAX ACT--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. E-15<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">EXCISE TAX ACT</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>121.</B> (1) The <I>Excise Tax Act</I> is amended by adding the following after section 285:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>285.01</B> (1) The following definitions apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“electronic cash register”<br />« <I>caisse enregistreuse électronique</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“electronic cash register” means a device that keeps a register or supporting documents through the means of an electronic device or computer system designed to record transaction data or any other electronic point-of-sale system.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“electronic suppression of sales device”<br />« <I>appareil de suppression électronique des ventes</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“electronic suppression of sales device” means</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a software program that falsifies the records of electronic cash registers, including transaction data and transaction reports; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a hidden programming option, whether preinstalled or installed at a later time, embedded in the operating system of an electronic cash register or hardwired into the electronic cash register that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) may be used to create a virtual second till, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) may eliminate or manipulate transaction records, which may or may not be preserved in digital formats, in order to represent the actual or manipulated record of transactions in the electronic cash register.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty — use<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Every person that uses, or that knowingly, or under circumstances attributable to neglect, carelessness or wilful default, participates in, assents to or acquiesces in the use of, an electronic suppression of sales device or a similar device or software in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286 is liable to a penalty of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) unless paragraph (<I>b</I>) applies, $5,000; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) $50,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under this section or section 163.3 of the <I>Income Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty — <keep>possession</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Every person that acquires or possesses an electronic suppression of sales device or a right in respect of an electronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286 is liable to a penalty of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) unless paragraph (<I>b</I>) applies, $5,000; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) $50,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under this section or section 163.3 of the <I>Income Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty — <keep>manufacturing</keep> or making available<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Every person that designs, develops, manufactures, possesses for sale, offers for sale, sells, transfers or otherwise makes available to another person, or that supplies installation, upgrade or maintenance services for, an elec- tronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286 is liable to a penalty of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) unless paragraph (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>) applies, $10,000;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) unless paragraph (<I>c</I>) applies, $50,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under subsection (2) or (3) or subsection 163.3(2) or (3) of the <I>Income Tax Act</I>; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) $100,000 if the action of the person occurs after the Minister has assessed a penalty payable by the person under this subsection or subsection 163.3(4) of the <I>Income Tax Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) Despite section 296, if at any time the Minister assesses a penalty payable by a person under this section, the Minister is not to assess, at or after that time, another penalty payable by the person under this section that is in respect of an action of the person that occurred before that time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Certain defences not available<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) Except as otherwise provided in subsection (7), a person does not have a defence in relation to a penalty assessed under this section by reason that the person exercised due diligence to prevent the action from occurring.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Diligence<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) A person is not liable for a penalty under subsection (3) or (4) in respect of an action of the person if the person exercised the degree of care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would have exercised in comparable circumstances to prevent the action from occurring.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Assessment vacated<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) For the purposes of this section, if an assessment of a penalty under this section is vacated, the penalty is deemed to have never been assessed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) comes into force on the later of the day on which this Act receives royal assent and January 1, 2014.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 4, s. 154(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>122.</B> (1) Paragraph 298(1)(<I>e</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) in the case of any penalty payable by the person, other than a penalty under section 280.1, 285, 285.01 or 285.1, more than four years after the person became liable to pay the penalty;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) comes into force on the later of the day on which this Act receives royal assent and January 1, 2014.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>123.</B> (1) The Act is amended by adding the following after section 327:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>327.1</B> (1) The definitions in subsection 285.01(1) apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Offences<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Every person that, without lawful excuse, the proof of which lies on the person,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) uses an electronic suppression of sales device or a similar device or software in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) acquires or possesses an electronic suppression of sales device, or a right in respect of an electronic suppression of sales device, that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) designs, develops, manufactures, possesses for sale, offers for sale, sells, transfers or otherwise makes available to another person an electronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) supplies installation, upgrade or maintenance services for an electronic suppression of sales device that is, or is intended to be, capable of being used in relation to records that are required to be kept by any person under section 286, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) participates in, assents to or acquiesces in the commission of, or conspires with any person to commit, an offence described in any of paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">is guilty of an offence and, in addition to any penalty otherwise provided, is liable on summary conviction to a fine of not less than $10,000 and not more than $500,000 or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years, or to both.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Prosecution on indictment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Every person that is charged with an offence described in subsection (2) may, at the election of the Attorney General of Canada, be prosecuted on indictment and, if convicted, is, in addition to any penalty otherwise provided, liable to a fine of not less than $50,000 and not more than $1,000,000 or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding five years, or to both.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Penalty on conviction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A person that is convicted of an offence under this section is not liable to pay a penalty imposed under any of sections 280.1, 280.11 and 283 to 285.1 or under a regulation made under this Part for the same action unless a notice of assessment for that penalty was issued before the information or complaint giving rise to the conviction was laid or made.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Stay of appeal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If, in any appeal under this Part, substantially the same facts are at issue as those that are at issue in a prosecution under this section, the Minister may file a stay of proceedings with the Tax Court and upon that filing the proceedings before the Tax Court are stayed pending final determination of the outcome of the prosecution.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) comes into force on the later of the day on which this Act receives royal assent and January 1, 2014.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1997, c. 10, s. 109(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>124.</B> (1) Section 10 of Part VI of Schedule V to the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">10. A supply made by a public sector body of any property or service if all or substantially all of the supplies of the property or service by the body are made for no consideration, but not including a supply of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>a</I>) blood or blood derivatives; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">(<I>b</I>) a parking space if the supply is made for consideration by way of lease, licence or similar arrangement in the course of a business carried on by the body.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection (1) is deemed to have come into force on December 17, 1990.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 3</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:VARIOUS MEASURES--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">VARIOUS MEASURES</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Employment Insurance--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Employment Insurance</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Employment Insurance Act--><MarginalNote>1996, c. 23<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Employment Insurance Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 433(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>125.</B> (1) Paragraph 4(2)(<I>a</I>) of the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the average for the 12-month period ending on April 30 in the preceding year of the Average Weekly Earnings for each month in that period</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 433(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 4(2)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the ratio that the average for the 12-month period ending on April 30 in that preceding year of the Average Weekly Earnings for each month in that 12-month period bears to the average for the 12-month period ending 12 months prior to April 30 of that preceding year of the Average Weekly Earnings for each month in that 12-month period ending 12 months prior to April 30 of that preceding year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 433(3)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 4(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Subsequent years<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) For years subsequent to the year in which the maximum yearly insurable earnings exceeds $39,000, before rounding down under subsection (4), the maximum yearly insurable earnings is the maximum yearly insurable earnings for the preceding year, before rounding down under that subsection, multiplied by the ratio that the average for the 12-month period ending on April 30 in that preceding year of the Average Weekly Earnings for each month in that 12-month period bears to the average for the 12-month period ending 12 months prior to April 30 of that preceding year of the Average Weekly Earnings for each month in that 12-month period ending 12 months prior to April 30 of that preceding year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 435(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>126.</B> (1) Subsection 66(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Annual premium rate setting<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.</B> (1) Subject to subsection (7) and section 66.32, the Commission shall set the premium rate for each year in order to generate just enough premium revenue to ensure that, at the end of the seven-year period that commences at the beginning of that year, the total of the amounts credited to the Employment Insurance Operating Account after December 31, 2008 is equal to the total of the amounts charged to that Account after that date.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2009, c. 2, s. 230(3)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 66(1.1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Premium rate for 2015 and 2016<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) Despite subsection (1), the premium rate for the years 2015 and 2016 is 1.88%.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of sections 66.1 to 66.31<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.2) Sections 66.1 to 66.31 apply in the years 2014 and 2015 even though the premium rates for the years 2015 and 2016 are set under subsection (1.1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections 66(1.1) and (1.2) of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 435(2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of subsection 66(2) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Factors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Commission shall set the premium rate based on</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 66(2) of the Act is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>a</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the actuary’s report provided under section 66.3 for that year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 609(4)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Paragraph 66(2)(<I>e</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) any changes, announced by the Minister on or before July 22 in a year, to payments to be made under paragraph 77(1)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>) during the following year; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2008, c. 28, s. 127; 2010, c. 12, s. 2204(1); 2012, c. 31, s. 435(6)(E)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) Paragraph 66(2)(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) any other information that the Commission considers relevant.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Section 66 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (7):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7.1) Despite subsection (7), the premium rate may be decreased by more than five one-hundredths of one per cent (0.05%) from 2016 to 2017.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) Subsection 66(7.1) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 435(8)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) Subsection 66(9) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Time limit<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) On or before September 14 in a year, the Commission shall set the premium rate for the following year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 436(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>127.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 66.1(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.1</B> The Minister shall, on or before July 22 in a year, provide the actuary with the following information:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 436(7)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 66.1(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Section 66.1 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.1</B> (1) The Minister shall, on or before July 22 in a year, provide the actuary and the Commission with the following information:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if the Minister has made an announcement referred to in paragraph 66(2)(<I>e</I>), the forecast change in the amount of the payments to be made during each of the following seven years under paragraph 77(1)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>), as the case may be;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the forecast costs to be paid under paragraphs 77(1)(<I>d</I>), (<I>d.1</I>) and (<I>g</I>) during each of the following seven years, including any forecast change in those costs resulting from any change to the payments referred to in paragraph (<I>a</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the total of the amounts charged to the Employment Insurance Operating Account as of the last day of the most recent month for which that total is known by the Minister; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) any prescribed information.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Regulations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) On the recommendation of the Minister, the Governor in Council may make regulations prescribing information referred to in paragraph (1)(<I>d</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 437(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>128.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 66.2(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.2</B> (1) The Minister of Finance shall, on or before July 22 in a year, provide the actuary with the following information:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 437(5)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsections 66.2(2) and (3) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information provided to Governor in Council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) When a joint recommendation is made under subsection 66(1) in a year, the Minister of Finance shall provide the Governor in Council with the information that was provided to the actuary under subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Section 66.2 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.2</B> (1) The Minister of Finance shall, on or before July 22 in a year, provide the actuary and the Commission with the following information:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the most current available forecast values of the economic variables that are relevant to the determination under section 66 of a premium rate for the following year;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the amounts forecast under subparagraphs 77.1(<I>a</I>)(i) and (ii) and the total estimated under subparagraph 77.1(<I>a</I>)(iii); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) any prescribed information.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Regulations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) On the recommendation of the Minister of Finance, the Governor in Council may make regulations prescribing information referred to in paragraph (1)(<I>c</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 438(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>129.</B> The portion of section 66.3 of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Actuary’s report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.3</B> The actuary shall prepare actuarial forecasts and estimates for the purposes of sections 4, 66 and 69 and shall, on or before August 22 in a year, provide the Commission with a report that sets out</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 438(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>130.</B> Section 66.31 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Report and summary<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.31</B> (1) The Commission shall, on or before September 14 in a year, make available to the public the report referred to in section 66.3 and a summary of that report.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Tabling in Parliament<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) After the report and its summary are made available to the public, the Minister shall cause them to be laid before each House of Parliament on any of the next 10 days during which that House is sitting.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>131.</B> Sections 66.31 to 67 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Report and summary<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.31</B> (1) The Commission shall, on or before August 31 in a year, provide the Minister and the Minister of Finance with the report referred to in section 66.3 and a summary of that report.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Available to public<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Commission shall, on the day on which a premium rate is set under section 66 or 66.32, make available to the public the report and its summary.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Tabling in Parliament<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) After a premium rate is set, the Minister shall cause the report and its summary to be laid before each House of Parliament on any of the next 10 days during which that House is sitting.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Premium rate setting by Governor in Council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.32</B> (1) On the joint recommendation of the Minister and the Minister of Finance, the Governor in Council may, on or before September 30 in a year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if the Governor in Council considers it to be in the public interest, substitute a premium rate for the following year that is different from the one set by the Commission under section 66; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the Commission has not set a premium rate under that section by September 14 in the year, set one for the following year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection 66(7)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsection 66(7) does not apply to the setting of the premium rate under subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Rounding percentage rates<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.4</B> If the calculation of a premium rate under section 66 or 66.32 results in a rate that includes a fraction of one per cent, the resulting percentage is to be rounded to the nearest one hundredth of one per cent or, if the resulting percentage is equidistant from two one-hundredths of one percent, to the higher of them.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Publication in <I>Canada Gazette</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.5</B> As soon as possible after a premium rate is set under section 66 or 66.32, the Commission shall publish it in Part I of the <I>Canada Gazette</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>User Fees Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.6</B> For greater certainty, the <I>User Fees Act</I> does not apply in respect of the premium rate set under section 66 or 66.32 or the premiums determined under sections 67 and 68.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employee’s premium<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>67.</B> Subject to section 70, a person employed in insurable employment shall pay, by deduction as provided in subsection 82(1), a premium equal to their insurable earnings multiplied by the premium rate set under section 66 or 66.32, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 438(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>132.</B> Section 66.5 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 30, s. 126<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>133.</B> Section 67 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employee’s premium<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>67.</B> Subject to section 70, a person employed in insurable employment shall pay, by deduction as provided in subsection 82(1), a premium equal to their insurable earnings multiplied by the premium rate set under section 66.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 440(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>134.</B> The portion of section 77.1 of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Forecasts and estimates<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>77.1</B> On or before July 22 in a year,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>135.</B> (1) Section 96 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (8.93):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Temporary measure — small business refund 2013<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8.94) If an employer’s premium is $15,000 or less for 2012, the Minister shall refund to the employer a portion of the premium for 2013 determined by the following formula if that amount is more than $2:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Previous"><Para Style="MAIN@Formula">P2 – P1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">where</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>P1 </keep><Tab />is the amount of the employer’s premium in 2012; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="3" FirstLineIndent="-3"><keep>P2 </keep><Tab />is the amount of the employer’s premium in 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>P1 can equal zero<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8.95) For the purposes of subsection (8.94), P1 is equal to zero if a person was not required to pay an employer’s premium in 2012.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Maximum refund<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8.96) A refund under subsection (8.94) shall not exceed $1,000.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31, s. 307(2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 96(13.1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No interest payable<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(13.1) Despite subsection (13), no interest shall be paid on refunds payable under subsection (8.7), (8.91) or (8.94).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2009, c. 33, s. 16<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>136.</B> Subsection 152.21(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Premium<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>152.21</B> (1) Every self-employed person who has entered into an agreement referred to in subsection 152.02(1) that has not been terminated or that is not deemed to have been terminated shall, in respect of every year, pay a self-employment premium equal to the amount determined under subsection (2) multiplied by the premium rate set under section 66 or 66.32, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Employment Insurance Financing Board Act--><MarginalNote>2008, c. 28, s. 121<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Employment Insurance Financing Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>137.</B> The <I>Canada Employment Insurance Financing Board Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Consequential Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Consequential Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Not-for-profit Corporations Act--><MarginalNote>2009, c. 23<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Not-for-profit Corporations Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>138.</B> Section 348 of the <I>Canada Not-for-profit Corporations Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Jobs, Growth and Long-term Prosperity Act--><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Jobs, Growth and Long-term Prosperity Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>139.</B> (1) Subsection 609(2) of the <I>Jobs, Growth and Long-term Prosperity Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 609(6) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>140.</B> Subsection 610(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>141.</B> Subsection 611(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>142.</B> Subsection 619(3) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Jobs and Growth Act, 2012--><MarginalNote>2012, c. 31<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Jobs and Growth Act, 2012</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>143.</B> (1) Subsection 433(2) of the <I>Jobs and Growth Act, 2012</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 433(4) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>144.</B> Subsection 434(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>145.</B> (1) Subsection 435(3) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 435(5) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 435(7) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection 435(9) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>146.</B> (1) Subsection 436(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 436(6) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 436(8) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>147.</B> (1) Subsection 437(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 437(4) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 437(6) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>148.</B> Subsection 438(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>149.</B> Subsections 439(2) and (3) of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>150.</B> (1) Subsection 440(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 440(4) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>151.</B> Subsection 441(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>152.</B> Subsection 442(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>153.</B> Subsection 443(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>154.</B> Sections 448 and 449 of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>155.</B> Subsection 461(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>156.</B> Subsections 463(2) to (4) of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Employment Insurance (Fishing) Regulations--><MarginalNote>SOR/96-445<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Employment Insurance (Fishing) Regulations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>157.</B> Subsection 13(1) of the <I>Employment Insurance (Fishing) Regulations</I> is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>a</I>) and by replacing paragraph (<I>b</I>) with the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the date of delivery of a catch falls within the qualifying period described in section 8 of the Act, the earnings of the fisher from employment as a fisher, as determined in accordance with subsections 5(2) and (3), shall be allocated equally to each day of the fishing trip; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the earnings allocated under paragraph (<I>b</I>) to any day falling within the qualifying period are deemed, for the purposes of subsection 14(2) of the Act, to be insurable earnings in the calculation period but are not to be used to determine the calculation period under subsection 14(4) of the Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>April 1, 2016<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>158.</B> (1) Subsections 126(1), (4), (5), (7), (8) and (10), 127(3) and 128(3) and sections 131 and 136 come into force on April 1, 2016.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>January 1, 2017<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 126(3) comes into force on January 1, 2017.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>January 1, 2018<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 126(9) comes into force on January 1, 2018.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>April 7, 2013<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Section 157 is deemed to have come into force on April 7, 2013.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 2</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Institutions (Conflicts of Interest)--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Institutions (Conflicts of Interest)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 18 (3rd Supp.), <keep>Part I</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>159.</B> Section 20 of the <I>Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Trust and Loan Companies Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 45<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Trust and Loan Companies Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>160.</B> Paragraph 164(<I>g</I>) of the <I>Trust and Loan Companies Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Bank Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 46<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Bank Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>161.</B> Paragraph 160(<I>g</I>) of the <I>Bank Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2001, c. 9, s. 71<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>162.</B> Section 160.1 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2001, c. 9, s. 183<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>163.</B> Paragraph 750(<I>g</I>) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Insurance Companies Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 47<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Insurance Companies Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>164.</B> (1) Paragraph 168(1)(<I>g</I>) of the <I>Insurance Companies Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 168(3) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2001, c. 9, s. 465<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>165.</B> Paragraph 797(<I>g</I>) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act--><MarginalNote>2001, c. 9<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>166.</B> Section 15 of the <I>Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 3</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Institutions (Investments)--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Institutions (Investments)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Trust and Loan Companies Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 45<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Trust and Loan Companies Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>167.</B> Section 451 of the <I>Trust and Loan Companies Act</I> is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) No company shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 453(1)(<I>j</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) If a company holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 453(1)(<I>j</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (5.1), the company may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Bank Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 46<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Bank Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>168.</B> Section 466 of the <I>Bank Act</I> is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) No bank shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 468(1)(<I>j</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) If a bank holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 468(1)(<I>j</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (5.1), the bank may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>169.</B> Section 928 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (4):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.1) No bank holding company shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 930(1)(<I>j</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.2) If a bank holding company holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 930(1)(<I>j</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (4.1), the bank holding company may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Insurance Companies Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 47<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Insurance Companies Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>170.</B> Section 493 of the <I>Insurance Companies Act</I> is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) No company shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 495(1)(<I>j</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) If a company holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 495(1)(<I>j</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (5.1), the company may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>171.</B> Section 552 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (4):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.1) No society shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 554(1)(<I>c</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.2) If a society holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 554(1)(<I>c</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (4.1), the society may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>172.</B> Section 969 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (4):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.1) No insurance holding company shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 971(1)(<I>j</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4.2) If an insurance holding company holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 971(1)(<I>j</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (4.1), the insurance holding company may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Cooperative Credit Associations Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 48<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>173.</B> Section 388 of the <I>Cooperative Credit Associations Act</I> is amended by adding the following after subsection (5):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of subsection (2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.1) No association shall, under subsection (2), acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in paragraph 390(1)(<I>h</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Holding<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5.2) If an association holds a substantial investment in an entity referred to in paragraph 390(1)(<I>h</I>) that it acquired or increased under subsection (2) before the coming into force of subsection (5.1), the association may continue to hold that substantial investment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 4</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Passports--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Passports</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Criminal Code--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. C-46<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Criminal Code</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1995, c. 5, par. 25(1)(<I>g</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>174.</B> Subsection 57(5) of the <I>Criminal Code</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definition of “passport”<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) In this section, “passport” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the <I>Canadian Passport Order</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendment to the Department of Foreign Affairs, Trade and Development Act--><MarginalNote>2013, c. 33, s. 174<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendment to the Department of Foreign Affairs, Trade and Development Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>175.</B> Paragraph 11(1)(<I>a</I>) of the <I>Department of Foreign Affairs, Trade and Development Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) documents issued by the Minister of Citizenship and Immigration for travel purposes for which fees are payable; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 5</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Labour Code--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. L-2<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Labour Code</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 2(5)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>176.</B> (1) The definitions “health and safety officer” and “regional health and safety officer” in subsection 122(1) of the <I>Canada Labour Code</I> are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 2(3)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The definition “danger” in subsection 122(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“danger”<br />« <I>danger</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“danger” means any hazard, condition or activity that could reasonably be expected to be an imminent or serious threat to the life or health of a person exposed to it before the hazard or condition can be corrected or the activity altered;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 5<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>177.</B> (1) The portion of paragraph 125(1)(<I>d</I>) of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) post in a conspicuous place accessible to every employee</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 5<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subparagraph 125(1)(<I>d</I>)(iii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) any other printed material related to health and safety that is prescribed or that may be directed by the Minister;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 5<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 125(1)(<I>x</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>x</I>) comply with every oral or written direction given to the employer by the Minister or an appeals officer concerning the health and safety of employees;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 8<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>178.</B> Paragraph 126(1)(<I>i</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>i</I>) comply with every oral or written direction of the Minister or an appeals officer concerning the health and safety of employees; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 9<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>179.</B> The portion of subsection 127(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Interference at accident scene prohibited<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>127.</B> (1) Subject to subsection (2), if an employee is killed or seriously injured in a work place, no person shall, unless authorized to do so by the Minister, remove or in any way interfere with or disturb any wreckage, article or thing related to the incident except to the extent necessary to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>180.</B> (1) Subsection 127.1(7) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subsection 127.1(8) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Referral to the Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) The employee or employer may refer a complaint that there has been a contravention of this Part to the Minister in the following circumstances:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 127.1(9) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Investigation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) The Minister shall investigate the complaint referred to in subsection (8).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of subsection 127.1(10) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Duty and power of Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10) On completion of the investigation, the Minister</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Paragraphs 127.1(10)(<I>b</I>) and (<I>c</I>) of the English version of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) may, if in the Minister’s opinion it is appropriate, recommend that the employee and employer resolve the matter between themselves; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) shall, if the Minister concludes that a danger exists as described in subsection 128(1), issue directions under subsection 145(2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsection 127.1(11) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Interpretation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11) For greater certainty, nothing in this section limits the Minister’s authority under section 145.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>181.</B> (1) Subsection 128(8) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Investigation by employer<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7.1) The employer shall, immediately after being informed of a refusal under subsection (6), investigate the matter in the presence of the employee who reported it. Immediately after concluding the investigation, the employer shall prepare a written report setting out the results of the investigation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employer to take immediate action<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) If, following its investigation, the employer agrees that a danger exists, the employer shall take immediate action to protect employees from the danger. The employer shall inform the work place committee or the health and safety representative of the matter and the action taken to resolve it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 128(10) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Investigation of continued refusal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10) If the work place committee receives a report under subsection (9), it shall designate, to investigate the matter immediately in the presence of the employee who reported it, two members of the committee, namely, one employee member from those chosen under paragraph 135.1(1)(<I>b</I>) and one employer member who is not from those chosen under that paragraph. If the health and safety representative receives a report under subsection (9), they shall immediately investigate the matter in the presence of the employee who reported it and a person who is designated by the employer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10.1) Immediately after concluding the investigation, the members of the work place committee designated under subsection (10) or the health and safety representative shall provide a written report to the employer that sets out the results of the investigation and their recommendations, if any.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Additional information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(10.2) After receiving a report under subsection (10.1) or under this subsection, the employer may provide the members of the work place committee or the health and safety representative with additional information and request that they reconsider their report taking into consideration that additional information. If the work place committee members or the health and safety representative considers it appropriate, they may provide a revised report to the employer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 128(11) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>If more than one report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(11) If more than one employee has made a report of a similar nature, those employees may designate one employee from among themselves to be present at the investigation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsections 128(12) to (14) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Absence of employee<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(12) The employer, the members of a work place committee or the health and safety representative may proceed with their investigation in the absence of the employee who reported the matter if that employee or a person designated under subsection (11) chooses not to be present.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision of employer<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(13) After receiving a report under subsection (10.1) or (10.2) and taking into account any recommendations in it, the employer, if it does not intend to provide additional information under subsection (10.2), shall make one of the following decisions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) agree that a danger exists;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) agree that a danger exists but consider that the circumstances provided for in paragraph (2)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) apply;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) determine that a danger does not exist.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision — <keep>paragraph</keep> <keep>(13)(<I>a</I>)</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(14) If the employer agrees that a danger exists under paragraph (13)(<I>a</I>), the employer shall take immediate action to protect employees from the danger. The employer shall inform the work place committee or the health and safety representative of the matter and the action taken to resolve it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision — <keep>paragraph</keep> <keep>(13)(<I>b</I>)</keep> or (<I>c</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(15) If the employer makes a decision under paragraph (13)(<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>), the employer shall notify the employee in writing. If the employee disagrees with the employer’s decision, the employee is entitled to continue the refusal, subject to subsections 129(1.2), (1.3), (6) and (7).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information to Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(16) If the employee continues the refusal under subsection (15), the employer shall immediately inform the Minister and the work place committee or the health and safety representative of its decision and the continued refusal. The employer shall also provide a copy of the report on the matter prepared under subsection (7.1) to the Minister along with a copy of any report referred to in subsection (10.1) or (10.2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>182.</B> (1) Subsection 129(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Minister’s investigation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>129.</B> (1) If the Minister is informed of the employer’s decision and the continued refusal under subsection 128(16), the Minister shall investigate the matter unless the Minister is of the opinion that</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the matter is one that could more appropriately be dealt with, initially or completely, by means of a procedure provided for under Part I or III or under another Act of Parliament;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the matter is trivial, frivolous or vexatious; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the continued refusal by the employee under 128(15) is in bad faith.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notices of decision not to investigate<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) If the Minister does not proceed with an investigation, the Minister shall inform the employer and the employee in writing, as soon as feasible, of that decision. The employer shall then inform in writing, as the case may be, the members of the work place committee who were designated under subsection 128(10) or the health and safety representative and the person who is designated by the employer under that subsection of the Minister’s decision.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Return to work<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.2) On being informed of the Minister’s decision not to proceed with an investigation, the employee is no longer entitled to continue their refusal under subsection 128(15).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Refusal of work during investigation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.3) If the Minister proceeds with an investigation, the employee may continue to refuse, for the duration of the investigation, to use or operate the machine or thing, to work in the place or to perform the activity that may constitute a danger.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Persons present during the investigation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.4) If the Minister proceeds with an investigation, the Minister may do so in the presence of the employer, the employee and one other person who is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an employee member of the work place committee;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the health and safety representative; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) if a person mentioned in paragraph (<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) is not available, another employee from the work place who is designated by the employee.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 129(2) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Rapports multiples<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">(2) Si l’enquête touche plusieurs employés, ceux-ci peuvent désigner l’un d’entre eux pour agir en leur nom dans le cadre de l’enquête.</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsections 129(3) and (4) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Absence of any person<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Minister may proceed with an investigation in the absence of any person mentioned in subsection (1.4) or (2) if that person chooses not to be present.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Precedent<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3.1) During the Minister’s investigation, the Minister shall verify if there are previous or ongoing investigations in relation to the same employer that involve substantially the same issues and may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if there was a previous investigation, rely on the findings of that investigation to decide whether a danger exists; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if there is an ongoing investigation, combine that investigation with the investigation the Minister is conducting and issue a single decision.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision of Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) The Minister shall, on completion of an investigation made under subsection (1), make one of the decisions referred to in paragraphs 128(13)(<I>a</I>) to (<I>c</I>) and shall immediately give written notification of the decision to the employer and the employee.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of subsection 129(5) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of work<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If the employee has exercised their right under subsection (1.3), the employer may, during the investigation and until the Minister has issued a decision, require that the employee concerned remain at a safe location near the place in respect of which the investigation is being made or assign the employee reasonable alternative work, and shall not assign any other employee to use or operate the machine or thing, work in that place or perform the activity referred to in subsection (1) unless</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsections 129(6) and (7) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Directions by Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If the Minister makes a decision referred to in paragraph 128(13)(<I>a</I>), the Minister shall issue the directions under subsection 145(2) that the Minister considers appropriate, and an employee may continue to refuse to use or operate the machine or thing, work in that place or perform that activity until the directions are complied with or until they are varied or rescinded under this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appeal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) If the Minister makes a decision referred to in paragraph 128(13) (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>), the employee is not entitled under section 128 or this section to continue to refuse to use or operate the machine or thing, work in that place or perform that activity, but the employee, or a person designated by the employee for the purpose, may appeal the decision, in writing, to an appeals officer within 10 days after receiving notice of the decision.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>183.</B> Subsection 133(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Restriction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) A complaint in respect of the exercise of a right under section 128 or 129 may not be made unless the employee has complied with subsection 128(6) or the Minister has received the reports referred to in subsection 128(16), as the case may be, in relation to the matter that is the subject-matter of the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>184.</B> Paragraph 134.1(4)(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) shall cooperate with the Minister;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>185.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 135(6) of the Act before paragraph (<I>b</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exemption if collective agreement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If, under a collective agreement or any other agreement between an employer and the employer’s employees, a committee of persons has been appointed and the committee has, in the opinion of the Minister, a responsibility for matters relating to health and safety in the work place to such an extent that a work place committee established under subsection (1) for that work place would not be necessary,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the Minister may, in writing, exempt the employer from the requirements of subsection (1) in respect of that work place;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 135(7)(<I>h</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) shall cooperate with the Minister;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>186.</B> (1) Subsection 135.1(4) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notification<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If a trade union fails to select a person under subparagraph (1)(<I>b</I>)(ii), the Minister may notify in writing the local branch of the trade union, and shall send a copy of any such notification to the trade union’s national or international headquarters and to the employer, indicating that the committee is not established until a person is selected in accordance with that subparagraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 135.1(9) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Records<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) A committee shall ensure that accurate records are kept of all of the matters that come before it and that minutes are kept of its meetings. The committee shall make the minutes and records available to the Minister at the Minister’s request.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>187.</B> (1) Subsection 136(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notification<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If a trade union fails to select a person under subsection (2), the Minister may so notify in writing the local branch of the trade union. The Minister shall send a copy of the notification to the trade union’s national or international headquarters and to the employer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 136(5)(<I>h</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) shall cooperate with the Minister;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>188.</B> Section 137 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Committees or <keep>representatives</keep>— specified work places<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>137.</B> Despite sections 135 and 136, if an employer controls more than one work place or the size or nature of the operations of the employer or those of the work place precludes the effective functioning of a single work place committee or health and safety representative, as the case may be, for those work places, the employer shall, subject to the approval or in accordance with the direction of the Minister, establish or appoint in accordance with section 135 or 136, as the case may be, a work place committee or health and safety representative for the work places that are specified in the approval or direction.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 11(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>189.</B> Subsection 137.1(5) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Ineligibility<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) No person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection 140(1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), is eligible to be appointed to the Commission or as alternate chairperson under subsection (2.1), or to be designated for the purposes of subsection 137.2(1) or (2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>190.</B> Section 140 of the Act and the heading before it are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Exercise of Minister’s Powers in Relation to Health and Safety--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Exercise of Minister’s Powers in Relation to Health and Safety</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Delegation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>140.</B> (1) Subject to any terms and conditions specified by the Minister, the Minister may delegate to any qualified person or class of persons any of the powers, duties or functions the Minister is authorized to exercise or perform for the purposes of this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Agreements — delegating provincial employees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subject to subsection (3), the Minister may, with the approval of the Governor in Council, enter into an agreement with any province or any provincial body specifying the terms and conditions under which the Minister may delegate to a person employed by that province or provincial body the powers, duties or functions that the Minister is authorized to exercise or perform for the purposes of this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The powers, duties or functions of the Minister provided for in section 130, subsections 135(3), 137.1(1) to (2.1), and (7) to (9), 137.2(4), 138(1) to (2) and (4) to (6), 140(1), (2) and (4), 144(1) and 149(1), sections 152 and 155 and subsections 156.1(1), 157(3) and 159(2), shall not be the subject of an agreement under subsection (2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Certificate of authority<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) The Minister may provide any person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection (1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection (2), with a certificate of authority and, when exercising those powers or performing those duties or functions, that person shall show the certificate to any person who asks to see it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation of liability<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) A person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection (1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection (2), is not personally liable for anything done or omitted to be done by them in good faith in the actual or purported exercise of those powers or performance of those duties or functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Duty of Her Majesty<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) Despite subsection (5), and for greater certainty, Her Majesty in right of Canada is not relieved of any civil liability to which Her Majesty in right of Canada may otherwise be subject.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>191.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 141(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Accessory powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>141.</B> (1) Subject to section 143.2, the Minister may, in carrying out the Minister’s duties and at any reasonable time, enter any work place controlled by an employer and, in respect of any work place, may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 141(1)(<I>c</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) be accompanied or assisted by any person and bring any equipment that the Minister deems necessary to carry out the Minister’s duties;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraphs 141(1)(<I>f</I>) to (<I>j</I>) of the English version of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) direct the employer to ensure that any place or thing specified by the Minister not be disturbed for a reasonable period pending an examination, test, inquiry, investigation or inspection in relation to the place or thing;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) direct any person not to disturb any place or thing specified by the Minister for a reasonable period pending an examination, test, inquiry, investigation or inspection in relation to the place or thing;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) direct the employer to produce documents and information relating to the health and safety of the employer’s employees or the safety of the work place and to permit the Minister to examine and make copies of or take extracts from those documents and that information;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>i</I>) direct the employer or an employee to make or provide statements, in the form and manner that the Minister may specify, respecting working conditions and material and equipment that affect the health or safety of employees;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j</I>) direct the employer or an employee or a person designated by either of them to accompany the Minister while the Minister is in the work place; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection 141(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Directions whether or not in work place<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Minister may issue a direction under subsection (1) whether or not the Minister is in the work place at the time the direction is issued.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Subsection 141(3) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Return of material and equipment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) On request by the person from whom material or equipment was taken or removed for testing under paragraph (1)(<I>d</I>), the Minister shall return that material or equipment to the person after testing is completed unless it is required for the purposes of a prosecution under this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections 141(4) to (9) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Investigation of deaths<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) The Minister shall investigate every death of an employee that occurred in the work place or while the employee was working, or that was the result of an injury that occurred in the work place or while the employee was working.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Investigation of motor vehicle accidents<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If the death results from a motor vehicle accident on a public road, as part of the investigation the Minister shall obtain a copy of any police report as soon as possible after the accident.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) Within 10 days after completing a written report on the findings of an inquiry or investigation, the Minister shall provide the employer and the work place committee or the health and safety representative with a copy of the report.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>192.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 141.1(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Inspections<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>141.1</B> (1) If the Minister conducts an inspection of the work place at the work place, it shall be done in the presence of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraphs 141.1(1)(<I>a</I>) and (<I>b</I>) of the French version of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>a</I>) soit de deux membres du comité local, l’un ayant été désigné par les employés ou en leur nom et l’autre par l’employeur;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>b</I>) soit du représentant et d’une personne désignée par l’employeur.</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 141.1(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Inspection not to be delayed<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Minister may proceed with an inspection in the absence of any person mentioned in subsection (1) if that person chooses not to be present.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>193.</B> Sections 142 to 143.1 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Duty to assist<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>142.</B> The person in charge of a work place and every person employed at, or in connection with, a work place shall give all reasonable assistance to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) every appeals officer and the Minister to enable them to carry out their duties under this Part; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) every person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection 140(1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), who is exercising those powers or performing those duties or functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Obstruction and false statements<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>143.</B> No person shall obstruct or hinder, or make a false or misleading statement either orally or in writing to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an appeals officer or the Minister engaged in carrying out their duties under this Part; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) any person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection 140(1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), who is exercising those powers or performing those duties or functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Provision of information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>143.1</B> No person shall prevent an employee from providing information to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an appeals officer or the Minister engaged in carrying out their duties under this Part; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) any person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection 140(1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), who is exercising those powers or performing those duties or functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>194.</B> (1) Subsection 144(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Evidence in civil suits precluded<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>144.</B> (1) No person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated under subsection 140(1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), and no person who has accompanied or assisted that person in exercising those powers or performing those duties or functions may be required to give testimony in a civil suit with regard to information obtained in exercising those powers or performing those duties or functions, except with the written permission of the Minister.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Evidence in civil suits precluded — Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) The Minister shall not be required to give testimony in a civil suit with regard to information obtained in the exercise of powers or the performance of duties or functions the Minister is authorized to exercise or perform under this Part, except for those powers, duties or functions that shall not be the subject of an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsections 144(3) to (5) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-disclosure of information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Subject to subsection (4), none of the Minister, an appeals officer who is admitted to a work place under the powers conferred by section 141 and a person who is admitted to a work place under the powers conferred by section 141 that are delegated to them under subsection 140(1), or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), and no person accompanying them, shall disclose to any person any information obtained in the work place by the Minister, officer or person with regard to any secret process or trade secret, except for the purposes of this Part or as required by law.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Privileged information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) All information that, under the <I>Hazard- ous Materials Information Review Act</I>, an employer is exempt from disclosing under paragraph 125.1(<I>d</I>) or (<I>e</I>) of this Act or under paragraph 13(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) or 14(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) of the <I>Hazardous Products Act</I> and that is obtained in a work place under section 141 is privileged and, notwithstanding the <I>Access to Information Act</I> or any other Act or law, shall not be disclosed to any other person except for the purposes of this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Information not to be published<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) No person shall, except for the purposes of this Part or for the purposes of a prosecution under this Part, publish or disclose the results of an analysis, examination, testing, inquiry, investigation or sampling made or taken under section 141.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>195.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 145(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Direction to terminate contravention<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>145.</B> (1) If the Minister is of the opinion that a provision of this Part is being contravened or has recently been contravened, the Minister may direct the employer or employee concerned, or both, to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subsection 145(1.1) of the English version of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Confirmation in writing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) If the Minister has issued a direction orally, the Minister shall provide a written version of it</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The portion of subsection 145(2) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dangerous situations — <keep>direction</keep> to employer<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the Minister considers that the use or operation of a machine or thing, a condition in a place or the performance of an activity constitutes a danger to an employee while at work,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The portion of paragraph 145(2)(<I>a</I>) of the English version of the Act before subparagraph (i) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the Minister shall notify the employer of the danger and issue directions in writing to the employer directing the employer, immediately or within the period that the Minister specifies, to take measures to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) Paragraph 145(2)(<I>b</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the Minister may, if the Minister considers that the danger or the hazard, condition or activity that constitutes the danger cannot otherwise be corrected, altered or protected against immediately, issue a direction in writing to the employer directing that the place, machine, thing or activity in respect of which the direction is issued not be used, operated or performed, as the case may be, until the Minister’s directions are complied with, but nothing in this paragraph prevents the doing of anything necessary for the proper compliance with the direction.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) Subsections 145(2.1) to (4) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dangerous situations — <keep>direction</keep> to employee<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.1) If the Minister considers that the use or operation of a machine or thing by an employee, a condition in a place or the performance of an activity by an employee constitutes a danger to the employee or to another employee, the Minister shall, in addition to the directions issued under paragraph (2)(<I>a</I>), issue a direction in writing to the employee to discontinue the use, operation or activity or cease to work in that place until the employer has complied with the directions issued under that paragraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Posting notice of danger<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If the Minister issues a direction under paragraph (2)(<I>a</I>), the Minister shall affix or cause to be affixed to or near the place, machine or thing in respect of which the direction is issued, or in the area in which the activity in respect of which the direction is issued is performed, a notice of danger in the form and containing the information that the Minister may specify, and no person shall remove the notice unless authorized to do so by the Minister.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Cessation of use<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If the Minister issues a direction under paragraph (2)(<I>b</I>) in respect of a place, machine, thing or activity, the employer shall cause the use of the place, the use or operation of the machine or thing or the performance of the activity to be discontinued, and no person shall use or operate the machine or thing, work in that place or perform the activity until the measures directed by the Minister have been taken.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) The portion of subsection 145(5) of the Act before paragraph (<I>b</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Copies of directions and reports<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If the Minister issues a direction in writing under subsection (1) or (2) or makes a report in writing to an employer on any matter under this Part, the employer shall without delay</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) cause a copy or copies of the direction or report to be posted in a conspicuous place accessible to every employee;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsections 145(6) to (8) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Copy to person who made complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If the Minister issues a direction under subsection (1), (2) or (2.1) or makes a report referred to in subsection (5) in respect of an investigation made by the Minister following a complaint, the Minister shall immediately provide a copy of the direction or report to each person, if any, whose complaint led to the investigation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Copy to employer<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) If the Minister issues a direction to an employee under subsection (1) or (2.1), the Minister shall immediately provide a copy of the direction to the employee’s employer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Response to direction or report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) If the Minister issues a direction under subsection (1), (2) or (2.1) or makes a report referred to in subsection (5), the Minister may require the employer or the employee to whom the direction is issued or to whom the report relates to respond in writing to the direction or report, within the time that the Minister may specify. The employer or employee shall provide a copy of the response to the policy committee and a copy to the work place committee or the health and safety representative.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>196.</B> Subsection 145.1(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Status<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) For the purposes of sections 146 to 146.5, an appeals officer has all of the powers, duties and functions of the Minister under this Part, except for those referred to in subsection (1), section 130, subsections 135(3), 137.1(1) to (2.1), and (7) to (9), 137.2(4), 138(1) to (2) and (4) to (6), 140(1), (2) and (4), 144(1) and <keep>149(1),</keep> sections 152 and 155 and subsections 156.1(1), 157(3) and 159(2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation of liability<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) An appeals officer is not personally liable for anything done or omitted to be done by the officer in good faith under the authority or purported authority of this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>197.</B> Subsection 146(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appeal of direction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>146.</B> (1) An employer, employee or trade union that feels aggrieved by a direction issued by the Minister under this Part may appeal the direction in writing to an appeals officer within 30 days after the date of the direction being issued or confirmed in writing.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 26 (4th Supp.), s. 5(4); 1993, c. 42, s. 11(3)(F)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>198.</B> Subsection 157(6) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Compliance with standards<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) Regulations made under this section that prescribe or incorporate a standard but that require the standard to be complied with only to the extent that compliance is practicable or reasonably practicable in circumstances governed by the standard may require the employer to report to the Minister the reason that full compliance is not practicable or reasonably practicable in particular circumstances.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provisions--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Pending proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>199.</B> (1) The <I>Canada Labour Code</I>, as it read immediately before the coming into force of this section, applies to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) any proceedings — commenced before that coming into force — with respect to which a health and safety officer or a regional health and safety officer may exercise powers or perform duties or functions under Part II of that Act, as it read immediately before that coming into force; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) any procedure — commenced before that coming into force — relating to a refusal to work commenced under sections 128 to 129 of that Act, as it read immediately before that coming into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appeal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) With respect to directions issued by a health and safety officer under Part II of the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>, an employer, employee or trade union that feels aggrieved by a direction may appeal the direction in writing to an appeals officer within 30 days after the date of the direction being issued or confirmed in writing. The appeal is deemed to have been brought under subsection 146(1) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Health and safety officers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) For the purposes of subsection (1), health and safety officers or regional health and safety officers designated under subsection 140(1) of the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>, as it read immediately before the coming into force of this section, continue to act, respectively, as health and safety officers or regional health and safety officers.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Consequential Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Consequential Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:National Energy Board Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. N-7<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">National Energy Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 27<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>200.</B> Subsection 9(4) of the <I>National Energy Board Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Hazardous Materials Information Review Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 24 (3rd Supp.), <keep>Part III</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Hazardous Materials Information Review Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 26; 2005, c. 34, par. 79(<I>d</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>201.</B> Paragraph 46(2)(<I>c</I>) of the <I>Hazardous Materials Information Review Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) any official of the Department of Employment and Social Development, any appeals officer within the meaning of subsection 122(1) of the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>, or any person to whom powers, duties or functions have been delegated by the Minister of Labour under subsection 140(1) of that Act, or under an agreement entered into under subsection 140(2), of that Act, for the purposes of the administration or enforcement of Part II of that Act;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Non-smokers’ Health Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 15 (4th Supp.)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Non-smokers’ Health Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2000, c. 20, s. 28<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>202.</B> The definition “inspector” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Non-smokers’ Health Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“inspector”<br />« <I>inspecteur</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“inspector” means a person who is designated as an inspector under section 9;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Order in council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>203.</B> The provisions of this Division come into force on a day or days to be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 6</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Changes to the Canadian Ministry--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Changes to the Canadian Ministry</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act--><MarginalNote>2005, c. 34<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>204.</B> The long title of the <I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="10" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-4" Hyphenate="OFF">An Act respecting the Department of Employment and Social Development and to amend and repeal certain related Acts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>205.</B> Section 1 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Short title<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>1.</B> This Act may be cited as the <I>Department of Employment and Social Development Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>206.</B> The definition “Minister” in section 2 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“Minister”<br />« <I>ministre</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Minister” means the Minister of Employment and Social Development.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>207.</B> The headings before section 3 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:DEPARTMENT OF EMPLOYMENT AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT--><Para TopMargin="5" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">DEPARTMENT OF EMPLOYMENT AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:Continuation--><Para TopMargin="5" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Continuation</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>208.</B> Subsections 3(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Department continued<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>3.</B> (1) The Department of Human Resources and Skills Development is continued under the name of the Department of Employment and Social Development over which the Minister of Employment and Social Development, appointed by commission under the Great Seal, shall preside.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employment and Social Development Canada<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The expressions “Employment and Social Development Canada” and “Emploi et Développement social Canada” in any document issued or executed in relation to the powers, duties and functions conferred on the Minister by this or any other Act are deem-<keep>ed to be</keep> references to the “Department of <keep>Employment</keep> and Social Development” and the “ministère de l’Emploi et du Développement social”, respectively.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>209.</B> Section 4 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deputy Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>4.</B> (1) The Governor in Council may appoint an officer called the Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development to hold office during pleasure and to be the deputy head of the Department.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Associate Deputy Ministers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Governor in Council may appoint one or more Associate Deputy Ministers of Employment and Social Development to hold office during pleasure and each shall have the rank and status of a deputy head of a department and exercise, under the Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development, the powers and perform the duties and functions as deputies of the Minister and otherwise that the Minister may specify.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deputy Minister of Labour<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Governor in Council may designate the Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development or one of the Associate Deputy Ministers to be Deputy Minister of Labour.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2010, c. 12, s. 1723<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>210.</B> Paragraphs 20(2)(<I>a</I>) and (<I>b</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development, who shall be the Chairperson of the Commission;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) an Associate Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development, who shall be the Vice-Chairperson of the Commission;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>211.</B> The Act is amended by adding the following before section 71:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>70.1</B> This Part applies to the following Acts, programs and activities:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the <I>Old Age Security Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the <I>Canada Student Financial Assistance Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) the <I>Canada Student Loans Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) any programs that are supported by grants or contributions under section 7; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) any activities in respect of which the administration or enforcement is the responsibility of the Minister under the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Regulations</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>212.</B> The portion of subsection 71(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>71.</B> (1) Subject to the regulations, the Minister may administer or enforce electronically the Acts, programs and activities referred to in paragraphs 70.1(<I>a</I>) to (<I>e</I>), (<I>g</I>) and (<I>h</I>), the Minister of Labour may administer or enforce electronically the <I>Canada Labour Code</I> and the Commission may administer or enforce elec- tronically the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I>, including for the purposes of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>213.</B> (1) Subsections 72(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Electronic manner of filing documents<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>72.</B> (1) Unless another manner of filing a document or information is expressly required by a provision of an Act referred to in section 70.1 or any of its regulations, by a term or condition of a program referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>g</I>) or by a provision of a regulation referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>h</I>), the filing of an electronic version of the document or information is to be considered as the filing of a document or information in accordance with the provision or the term or condition.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Power to prescribe form or manner of filing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A provision of an Act referred to in section 70.1 or any of its regulations, or a term or condition of a program referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>g</I>) or a provision of a regulation referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>h</I>), that provides for a power to issue, prescribe or in any other manner establish a form or to establish the manner of filing a document or information includes the power to do so with respect to an electronic document or information.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The portion of subsection 72(3) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Written documents or information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) A requirement under a provision of an Act referred to in section 70.1 or any of its regulations, or a term or condition of a program referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>g</I>) or a provision of a regulation referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>h</I>), that a document be in writing or information be provided in writing is satisfied by an electronic document or information if the electronic document or information</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The portion of subsection 72(4) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Signatures<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A requirement under a provision of an Act referred to in section 70.1 or any of its regulations, or a term or condition of a program referred to in  paragraph 70.1(<I>g</I>) or a provision of a regulation referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>h</I>), for a signature is satisfied by an electronic signature if the electronic signature</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>214.</B> (1) Subparagraph 73(1)(<I>c</I>)(ii) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the date and hour when an electronic document or electronic information is deemed to be sent or received and the place where it is deemed to be sent or received,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 73(1)(<I>g</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) respecting the establishment and operation of electronic systems or any other technology to be used in the administration or enforcement of an Act referred to in section 70.1, of a program referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>g</I>) or of a provision of a regulation referred to in paragraph 70.1(<I>h</I>), and respecting the manner in which and the extent to which any provision of that Act or its regulations, any term or condition of that program or any provision of that regulation applies to the electronic systems; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, s. 224<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 73(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Accessibility<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Minister, the Minister of Labour or the Commission, as the case may be, shall ensure that any document that is incorporated by reference in a regulation in respect of which the administration or the enforcement is their responsibility is accessible.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Salaries Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. S-3<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Salaries Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 16, s. 21(1)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>215.</B> Paragraph 4.1(3)(<I>z.2</I>) of the <I>Salaries Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>z.2</I>) the Minister of Employment and Social Development;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>z.21</I>) the Minister of Infrastructure, Communities and Intergovernmental Affairs; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 16, par. 21(3)(<I>b</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>216.</B> Section 4.2 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Index<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>4.2</B> The index referred to in subsections 4.1(2), (4) and (6) for a calendar year is the index of the average percentage increase in base-rate wages for the calendar year, resulting from major settlements negotiated with bargaining units of 500 or more employees in the private sector in Canada, as published by the Department of Employment and Social Development within three months after the end of that calendar year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provisions--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deputy Minister and Associate Deputy Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>217.</B> (1) Any person who holds the office of Deputy Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development or of Associate Deputy Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development immediately before the day on which this section comes into force is deemed to hold the office of Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development or of Associate Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development, respectively, as of that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Deputy Minister of Labour<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Any person who holds the office of Deputy Minister of Labour immediately before the day on which this section comes into force is deemed to have been designated Deputy Minister of Labour under subsection 4(3) of the <I>Department of Employment and Social Development Act</I>, as enacted by section 209 of this Act, as of that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Positions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>218.</B> Nothing in this Act is to be construed as affecting the status of an employee who, immediately before the coming into force of this section, occupied a position in the Department of Human Resources and Skills Development except that the employee, on the coming into force of this section, occupies their position in the Department of Employment and Social Development under the authority of the Minister of Employment and Social Development.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Transfer of appropriations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>219.</B> Any amount appropriated by an Act of Parliament for the fiscal year in which this section comes into force to defray the charges and expenses of the Department of Human Resources and Skills Development that is unexpended is deemed to have been appropriated to defray the charges and expenses of the Department of Employment and Social Development.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Transfer of powers, duties and functions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>220.</B> If, under any Act of Parliament, any instrument made under an Act of Parliament or any order, contract, lease, licence or other document, any power, duty or function is vested in or may be exercised or performed by the Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development, that power, duty or function is vested in or may be exercised or performed by the Minister of Employment and Social Development, the Deputy Minister of Employment and Social Development or the appropriate officer of the Department of Employment and Social Development, as the case may be.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Consequential Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Consequential Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Access to Information Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. A-1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Access to Information Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 34, s. 59<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>221.</B> Schedule I to the <I>Access to Information Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “DEPARTMENTS AND MINISTRIES OF STATE”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Human Resources and Skills Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère des Ressources humaines et du Développement des compétences </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>222.</B> Schedule I to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order under the heading “DEPARTMENTS AND MINISTRIES OF STATE”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Employment and Social Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère de l’Emploi et du Développement social</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Administration Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. F-11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Administration Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 34, s. 66<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>223.</B> Schedule I to the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Human Resources and Skills Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère des Ressources humaines et du Développement des compétences </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>224.</B> Schedule I to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Employment and Social Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère de l’Emploi et du Développement social</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 9, s. 270<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>225.</B> Part I of Schedule VI to the Act is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Human Resources and Skills Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère des Ressources humaines et du Développement des compétences </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>226.</B> Part I of Schedule VI to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Employment and Social Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère de l’Emploi et du Développement social</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Privacy Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. P-21<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Privacy Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 34, s. 73<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>227.</B> The schedule to the <I>Privacy Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “DEPARTMENTS AND MINISTRIES OF STATE”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Human Resources and Skills Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère des Ressources humaines et du Développement des compétences </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>228.</B> The schedule to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order under the heading “DEPARTMENTS AND MINISTRIES OF STATE”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Employment and Social Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère de l’Emploi et du Développement social</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Family Orders and Agreements Enforcement Assistance Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 4 (2nd Supp.)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Family Orders and Agreements Enforcement Assistance Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2012, c. 19, subpar. 694(<I>c</I>)(i) and s. 695(2)(E)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>229.</B> Paragraph (<I>a</I>) of the definition “information bank director” in section 2 of the <I>Family Orders and Agreements Enforcement Assistance Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) with respect to any of the information banks controlled by the Department of Employment and Social Development that may be searched under this Part, the Minister of Employment and Social Development,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 35, s. 53; 2012, c. 19, subpar. 694(<I>c</I>)(ii) and 695(<I>d</I>)(i)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>230.</B> Section 6 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Agreements regarding comprehensive pension plans<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>6.</B> With the approval of the Governor in Council, the Minister of Employment and Social Development may, on behalf of the Government of Canada, enter into an agreement with each province providing a comprehensive pension plan, as defined under the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I>, for the purpose of obtaining the approval of that province for</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the creation, for the purposes of this Act, of an information bank to be controlled by the Department of Employment and Social Development in respect of contributors to and beneficiaries under that comprehensive pension plan; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the release of information under this Part from the information bank referred to in paragraph (<I>a</I>) and from any other information bank controlled by the Department of Employment and Social Development that contains information in respect of contributors to and beneficiaries under that comprehensive pension plan.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Income Tax Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 1 (5th Supp.)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Income Tax Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>231.</B> Subparagraph 241(4)(<I>d</I>)(x.1) of the <I>Income Tax Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(x.1) to an official of the Department of Employment and Social Development solely for the purpose of the administration or enforcement of a program established under the authority of the <I>Department of Employment and Social Development Act</I> in respect of children who are deceased or missing as a result of an offence, or a probable offence, under the <I>Criminal Code</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Sector Compensation Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 30<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Sector Compensation Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 34, s. 76<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>232.</B> Schedule I to the <I>Public Sector Compensation Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “DEPARTMENTS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Human Resources and Skills Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère des Ressources humaines et du Développement des compétences </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>233.</B> Schedule I to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order under the heading “DEPARTMENTS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Department of Employment and Social Development</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Ministère de l’Emploi et du Développement social</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Student Financial Assistance Act--><MarginalNote>1994, c. 28<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Student Financial Assistance Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2008, c. 28, s. 108(4)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>234.</B> Subsection 15(2) of the <I>Canada Student Financial Assistance Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Immigration and Refugee Protection Act--><MarginalNote>2001, c. 27<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2013, c. 33, s. 161<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>235.</B> The portion of subsection 30(1.43) of the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</I> before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Revocation or suspension of opinion<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.43) If, in the view of the Department of Employment and Social Development, public policy considerations that are specified in instructions given by the Minister of Employment and Social Development justify it, that Department may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Terminology--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Terminology</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement of “<I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I>”<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>236.</B> (1) Every reference to the “<I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I>” is replaced by a reference to the “<I>Department of Employment and Social Development Act</I>” in the following provisions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) subsection 144(5.1) of the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) in the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) subsections 38(1) and (3) and paragraph 38(4)(<I>b</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) section 82,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) the portion of section 83 before paragraph (<I>a</I>), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iv) paragraph 108(3)(<I>e</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) in the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) section 65.21,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) paragraphs 77(1)(<I>d.1</I>) and (<I>g</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) section 113, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iv) subsection 114(1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>d</I>) paragraph 28(1)(<I>g</I>) of the <I>Federal Courts Act</I> as enacted by subsection 272(2) of the <I>Jobs, Growth and Long-term Prosperity Act</I>, chapter 19 of the Statutes of Canada, 2012;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>e</I>) in the <I>Income Tax Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) paragraph 56(1)(<I>a.3</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) subparagraph 110(1)(<I>g</I>)(i), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) the definition “qualifying educational program” in subsection 118.6(1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>f</I>) in the <I>Labour Adjustment Benefits Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) the definition “Social Security Tribunal” in subsection 2(1), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) subsection 13(7); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>g</I>) in the <I>Old Age Security Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) paragraph 5(3)(<I>b</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) subparagraph 19(6)(<I>f</I>)(ii),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) subparagraph 21(9)(<I>d</I>)(ii), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iv) subsection 28(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Other references to <I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Unless the context requires otherwise, every reference to the <I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I> in any provision of an Act of Parliament other than a provision referred to in subsection (1) is, with any grammatical adaptations, to be read as a reference to the <I>Department of Employment and Social Development Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement in regulations, etc.<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Unless the context requires otherwise, “<I>Department of Human Resources and Skills Development Act</I>” is replaced by “<I>Department of Employment and Social Development Act</I>” in</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) any regulation, as defined in section 2 of the <I>Statutory Instruments Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) any other instrument made</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) in the execution of a power conferred by or under an Act of Parliament, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) by or under the authority of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement of “Department of Human Resources and Skills Development”<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>237.</B> (1) Every reference to the “Department of Human Resources and Skills Development” is replaced by a reference to the “Department of Employment and Social Development” in the following provisions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) in the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) subsection 70.1(1), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) the definition “regional director” in section 166;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) in the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) paragraph 66(3)(<I>d</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) subsection 103(3), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) subsection 104.1(1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) paragraph 81(<I>d</I>) of the <I>Canadian Forces Members and Veterans Re-establishment and Compensation Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>d</I>) subsection 28(1) of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>e</I>) paragraph 107(5)(<I>i</I>) of the <I>Customs Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>f</I>) paragraph 6.7(<I>d</I>) of the <I>Department of Veterans Affairs Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>g</I>) section 15 of the <I>Family Orders and Agreements Enforcement Assistance Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>h</I>) paragraph 46(2)(<I>c</I>) of the <I>Hazardous Materials Information Review Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>i</I>) subsection 89(1.1) of the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>j</I>) paragraph 56(1)(<I>n.1</I>) of the <I>Income Tax Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>k</I>) subsections 28(2) and (5) of the <I>Labour Adjustment Benefits Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>l</I>) section 33.1 of the <I>Old Age Security Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>m</I>) section 67.1 of the <I>Parliament of Canada Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>n</I>) paragraph 109.2(<I>d</I>) of the <I>Pension Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>o</I>) paragraph 30(2)(<I>c</I>) of the <I>War Veterans Allowance Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Other references to Department of Human Resources and Skills Development<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Unless the context requires otherwise, every reference to the Department of Human Resources and Skills Development in any provision of an Act of Parliament other than a provision referred to in subsection (1) is, with any grammatical adaptations, to be read as a reference to the Department of Employment and Social Development.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement in regulations, etc.<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Unless the context requires otherwise, “Department of Human Resources and Skills Development” is replaced by “Department of Employment and Social Development” in</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) any regulation, as defined in section 2 of the <I>Statutory Instruments Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) any other instrument made</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) in the execution of a power conferred by or under an Act of Parliament, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) by or under the authority of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement of “Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development”<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>238.</B> (1) Every reference to the “Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development” is replaced by a reference to the “Minister of Employment and Social Development” in the following provisions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) subsection 212(2) of the <I>Canada Labour Code</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) in the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) section 3,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) subsection 4(3),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) subsections 26.1(1) and (2),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iv) section 27,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(v) paragraph 27.2(1)(<I>a</I>),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(vi) the definition “Minister” in subsection 42(1),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(vii) the definition “Minister” in section 91, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(viii) the portion of subsection 117(1) before paragraph (<I>a</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) the definition “Minister” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Canada Student Loans Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>d</I>) the definition “Minister” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Employment Insurance Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>e</I>) section 3 of the <I>Energy Costs Assistance Measures Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>f</I>) in the <I>Federal-Provincial Fiscal Arrangements Act</I>, chapter F-8 of the Revised Statutes of Canada, 1985,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) subsection 24.3(2),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) the definition “Minister” in section 24.9,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) section 25.8, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iv) paragraph 40(<I>f</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>g</I>) section 3 of the <I>Government Annuities Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>h</I>) in the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) subsection 4(2.1),</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) subsection 92(1.1), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(iii) section 93;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>i</I>) in the <I>Income Tax Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) subparagraph 118.5(1)(<I>a</I>)(ii), and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) the definition “designated educational institution” in subsection 118.6(1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>j</I>) the definition “Minister” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Labour Adjustment Benefits Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>k</I>) in the <I>Old Age Security Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) the definition “Minister” in section 2, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) section 46;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>l</I>) in the <I>Unemployment Assistance Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) the definition “Minister” in section 2, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) section 6; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>m</I>) the definition “Minister” in section 2 of the <I>Universal Child Care Benefit Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Other references to Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Unless the context requires otherwise, every reference to the Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development in any provision of an Act of Parliament other than a provision referred to in subsection (1) is, with any grammatical adaptations, to be read as a reference to the Minister of Employment and Social Development.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement in regulations, etc.<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Unless the context requires otherwise, “Minister of Human Resources and Skills Development” is replaced by “Minister of Employment and Social Development” in</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) any regulation, as defined in section 2 of the <I>Statutory Instruments Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) any other instrument made</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(i) in the execution of a power conferred by or under an Act of Parliament, or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(ii) by or under the authority of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 7</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Dominion Coal Blocks--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Dominion Coal Blocks</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>239.</B> The following definitions apply in this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Crow’s Nest Pass Act”<br />« <I>Loi du Nid-de-Corbeau</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“Crow’s Nest Pass Act” means <I>An Act to authorize a Subsidy for a Railway through the Crow’s Nest Pass</I>, chapter 5 of the Statutes of Canada 1897.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Dominion Coal Blocks”<br />« <I>Réserve fédérale de charbon</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“Dominion Coal Blocks” means the selected land referred to in paragraph 1(<I>i.</I>) of the Crow’s Nest Pass Act, being</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) Parcel Identifier 014-832-020, Parcel 73, shown on Plan DD 729 (F25(2)), District Lot 4589, Kootenay District, British Columbia; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) Parcel Identifier 014-832-038, Parcel 82, shown on Plan DD 729 (F25(1)), District Lot 4589, Kootenay District, British Columbia, except Part included in Plan 6844.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Minister”<br />« <I>ministre</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“Minister” means the Minister designated under section 240, or, if none is designated, the Minister of Natural Resources.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Designation of Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>240.</B> The Governor in Council may, by order, designate any federal minister to be the Minister referred to in this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dominion Coal Blocks<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>241.</B> Nothing in the Crow’s Nest Pass Act, in the agreement mentioned in that Act or in any covenant in the instrument conveying the Dominion Coal Blocks to His Majesty in right of Canada operates so as to limit the power of Her Majesty in right of Canada to hold, dispose of or otherwise deal with the Dominion Coal Blocks, or any part of the Dominion Coal Blocks or any interest in them, in any manner and on any conditions that Her Majesty in right of Canada considers appropriate.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>242.</B> (1) With the approval of the Governor in Council, and subject to any terms that the Governor in Council considers appropriate, the Minister may dispose of the Dominion Coal Blocks, or any part of the Dominion Coal Blocks or any interest in them, in any manner and on any conditions established under section 241.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception —<keep>easements</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Despite subsection (1), the Minister may grant an easement over any part of the Dominion Coal Blocks without the approval of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) The Minister may do anything that he or she considers necessary to prepare the Dominion Coal Blocks, or any part of the Dominion Coal Blocks or any interest in them, for disposition.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Administration<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The Minister has the administration of the Dominion Coal Blocks.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of provincial law<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>243.</B> A disposition under section 241 or subsection 242(1) or (2) may be effected by any instrument by which an interest in real property may be disposed of by a private person under the laws in force in British Columbia.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Her Majesty’s obligations are terminated<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>244.</B> All obligations and liabilities of Her Majesty in right of Canada arising out of any of the matters referred to in paragraph 1(<I>i.</I>) of the Crow’s Nest Pass Act, and all rights acquired by any other party under any covenant in the instrument conveying the Dominion Coal Blocks to His Majesty in right of Canada relating to those matters, are extinguished.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No liability<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>245.</B> No action or other proceeding, including any action or proceeding in restitution, or for damages of any kind, that is based on or is in relation to any agreement in respect of the Dominion Coal Blocks that existed on or before the coming into force of this section lies or may be instituted by anyone against Her Majesty in right of Canada or any minister or any employee or agent of Her Majesty in right of Canada, or any person engaged to provide advice or services to Her Majesty in right of Canada in relation to such an agreement, for anything done or omitted to be done or for anything purported to have been done or omitted to be done, in the exercise or performance of their powers, duties and functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No compensation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>246.</B> No one is entitled to any compensation from Her Majesty in right of Canada in connection with the coming into force of section 244.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of money from disposition<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>247.</B> The money from a sale or other disposition made under section 241 or subsection 242(1) or (2) minus an amount equal to the amount paid or payable by Her Majesty in right of Canada, or any agent of Her Majesty in right of Canada, under an agreement relating to the disposition, including the management of that disposition, is public money for the purposes of the <I>Financial Administration Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Federal Real Property and Federal Immovables Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>248.</B> The <I>Federal Real Property and Federal Immovables Act</I> does not apply to any disposition of the Dominion Coal Blocks.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 8</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Reorganization of Certain Crown Corporations (Bridges)--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Reorganization of Certain Crown Corporations (Bridges)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Interpretation--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Interpretation</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definition of “amalgamated corporation”<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>249.</B> In this Division, “amalgamated corporation” means the corporation resulting from the amalgamation after which each of the corporations referred to in paragraphs 252(1)(<I>a</I>) to (<I>d</I>) has been amalgamated with at least one other corporation referred to in subsection 252(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amalgamation--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amalgamation</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuance under <I>Canada Business Corporations Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>250.</B> Despite section 103 of the <I>Financial Administration Act</I>, the directors of the Blue Water Bridge Authority may, under subsection 268(4) of the <I>Canada Business Corporations Act</I>, apply for a certificate <keep>of con-</keep>tinuance.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Articles<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>251.</B> For the purposes of paragraph 90(1)(<I>c</I>) of the <I>Financial Administration Act</I>, The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited may, before any amalgamation referred to in subsection 252(1), amend its articles to make a material change in the objects or purposes for which it was incorporated, or the restrictions on the businesses or activities that it may carry on, as set out in its articles.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Amalgamation authorized<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>252.</B> (1) For the purposes of paragraph 90(1)(<I>e</I>) of the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> and despite section 14 of <I>An Act to incorporate St. Mary’s River Bridge Company</I>, the amalgamation of the following corporations with each other is authorized, the amalgamation of any of the following corporations with the corporation that results from the amal- gamation of two or three of the other corporations is authorized and the amalgamation of any of the following corporations with any corporation that results from the amalgamation of two of the other corporations with the third corporation is authorized:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) St. Mary’s River Bridge Company;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) The Seaway International Bridge Corporation, Ltd.; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>d</I>) Blue Water Bridge Authority.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Transitional<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The chief executive officer and the members of the board of directors of The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited continue as the chief executive officer and members of the board of directors, respectively, of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) the corporation that results from the amalgamation of The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited with either or both of the corporations referred to in paragraphs (1)(<I>b</I>) and (<I>c</I>); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the corporation that results from the amalgamation of either of the corporations referred to in paragraphs (1)(<I>b</I>) and (<I>c</I>) with the corporation that results from the amalgamation of The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited with the other of the corporations referred to in those paragraphs, if The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited amalgamated with only one of them.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Amalgamated corporation an agent<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>253.</B> The amalgamated corporation is an agent of Her Majesty in right of Canada.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Contracts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>254.</B> The amalgamated corporation may enter into contracts with Her Majesty as though it were not an agent of Her Majesty.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Borrowing authorized<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>255.</B> The amalgamated corporation may borrow money otherwise than from the Crown, including by means of the issuance, sale and pledge of bonds, debentures, notes or other evidence of indebtedness, as long as the total principal amount of those borrowings that is outstanding does not exceed $130,000,000 at any time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Charges<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>256.</B> (1) The amalgamated corporation may fix and charge tolls, fees or other charges for the use of a bridge or tunnel that it owns or operates.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Authorization by amalgamated corporation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The amalgamated corporation may authorize another person to fix or charge tolls, fees or other charges for the use of such a bridge or tunnel.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Auditor<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>257.</B> The Auditor General of Canada is the auditor of the amalgamated corporation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No compensation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>258.</B> Despite the provisions of any contract, agreement or order, no person who is appointed to hold office as a part-time member of the board of directors of The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited, of a corporation that results from an amalgamation referred to in subsection 252(2) or of Blue Water Bridge Authority has any right to claim or receive any compensation, damages, indemnity or other form of relief from Her Majesty in right of Canada or from any employee or agent of Her Majesty for ceasing to hold that office or for the abolition of that office following any amalgamation referred to in subsection 252(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Financial Administration Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>259.</B> For the purposes of Part I of Sched- ule III to the <I>Financial Administration Act</I>, the reference in that Part to The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited is deemed to be a reference to the name of any corporation that results from an amalgamation referred to in subsection 252(1), if that name is “The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Payments in Lieu of Taxes Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>260.</B> For the purposes of Schedule III to the <I>Payments in Lieu of Taxes Act</I>, the reference in that Schedule to The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited is deemed to be a reference to the name of any corporation that results from an amalgamation referred to in subsection 252(1), if that name is “The Federal Bridge Corporation Limited”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Consequential Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Consequential Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Administration Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. F-11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Administration Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>SOR/2002-173, s. 1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>261.</B> Part I of Schedule III to the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Blue Water Bridge Authority</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Administration du pont Blue Water</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Marine Act--><MarginalNote>1998, c. 10<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Marine Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>262.</B> Section 142 of the <I>Canada Marine Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:International Bridges and Tunnels Act--><MarginalNote>2007, c. 1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">International Bridges and Tunnels Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>263.</B> Items 26, 39, 42, 45 and 50 of the schedule to the <I>International Bridges and Tunnels Act</I> are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Repeals--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Repeals</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1901, c. 112<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>264.</B> <I>An Act to incorporate the St. Mary River Bridge Company</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1928, c. 64<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>265.</B> <I>An Act to incorporate the St. Clair Transit Company</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1934, c. 66<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>266.</B> <I>An Act to incorporate Thousand Islands Bridge Company</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1955, c. 64<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>267.</B> <I>An Act to incorporate St. Mary’s River Bridge Company</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1964-65, c. 6<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>268.</B> The <I>Blue Water Bridge Authority Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Order in council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>269.</B> Sections 253 to 263 and 266 to 268 come into force on a day or days to be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 9</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Administration Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. F-11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Administration Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>270.</B> Section 100 of the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Security interests<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>100.</B> (1) Subject to subsection (2), no agent corporation, for the purposes of securing payment of a debt or performance of an obligation, shall charge, mortgage, hypothecate, cede and transfer, pledge or otherwise create an interest in or charge on any property held by the corporation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subject to any terms and conditions set out in the designation, an agent corporation designated by the Minister may pledge any securities or cash that it holds, or give deposits, as security for the payment or performance of any obligation of the corporation arising out of any derivative that it enters into or guarantees for the management of financial risks.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 10</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:National Research Council Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. N-15<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">National Research Council Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>271.</B> Section 2 of the <I>National Research Council Act</I> is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“Chairperson”<br />« <I>premier conseiller</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Chairperson” means the Chairperson of the Council appointed under subsection 3(1);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2010, c. 12, s. 1757<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>272.</B> Subsection 3(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Council established<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>3.</B> (1) There is established a Council, to be called the National Research Council of Canada, consisting of a President, a Chairperson and not more than 10 other members, to be appointed by the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>273.</B> Section 9 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Acting President<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>9.</B> (1) If the President is absent or unable to act or if the office of President is vacant, the Minister may appoint another person to act as President, but that person may act as President for a period of more than 90 days only with the approval of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Acting Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the Chairperson is absent or unable to act or if the office of Chairperson is vacant, the Minister may appoint another person to act as Chairperson, but that person may act as Chairperson for a period of more than 90 days only with the approval of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>274.</B> Subsection 11(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>275.</B> Section 13 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Meetings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Council shall meet at least three times a year at the times and places in Canada that the Chairperson may determine. The Chairperson presides at those meetings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 11</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Veterans Review and Appeal Board Act--><MarginalNote>1995, c. 18<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Veterans Review and Appeal Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>276.</B> Section 4 of the <I>Veterans Review and Appeal Board Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Establishment of Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>4.</B> There is established an independent board, to be known as the Veterans Review and Appeal Board, consisting of not more than 25 permanent members to be appointed by the Governor in Council and any number of temporary members that are appointed under section 6.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 12</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Pension Plan Investment Board Act--><MarginalNote>1997, c. 40<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Pension Plan Investment Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>277.</B> (1) Subsection 10(4) of the <I>Canada Pension Plan Investment Board Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointment factors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Before making a recommendation to the Governor in Council with respect to the appointment of directors and before making an appointment under subsection (8), the Minister shall</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) have regard to the desirability of having on the board of directors</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) directors who are representative of the various regions of Canada, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) a sufficient number of directors with proven financial ability or relevant work experience to enable the Board to effectively achieve its objects; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) endeavour to ensure that no more than three of the 12 directors reside outside Canada.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 10(9) of the Act is amended by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>f</I>), by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>g</I>) and by repealing paragraph (<I>h</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Order in council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>278.</B> Section 277 comes into force, in accordance with subsection 114(4) of the <I>Canada Pension Plan</I>, on a day to be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 13</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act--><MarginalNote>2000, c. 17; 2001, c. 41, s. 48<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>279.</B> Section 11 of the <I>Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Solicitor-client privilege<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>11.</B> Nothing in this Act requires a legal counsel to disclose any communication that is subject to solicitor-client privilege.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2004, c. 15, s. 101<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>280.</B> Subsection 65(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Any information disclosed by the Centre under subsection (1) may be used by an agency referred to in that subsection only as evidence of a contravention of Part 1, and any information disclosed by the Centre under subsection (2) may be used by an agency or body referred to in subsection (2) only for purposes relating to compliance with Part 1.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coordinating Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coordinating Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2010, c. 12<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>281.</B> (1) In this section, “other Act” means the <I>Jobs and Economic Growth Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) On the first day on which both section 1868 of the other Act and section 279 of this Act are in force, section 11 of the English version of the <I>Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Solicitor-client privilege or professional secrecy<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>11.</B> Nothing in this Act requires a legal counsel to disclose any communication that is subject to solicitor-client privilege or, in Quebec, the professional secrecy of legal counsel.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) On the first day on which both paragraph 1882(<I>d</I>) of the other Act and section 280 of this Act are in force, subsection 65(3) of the <I>Proceeds of Crime (Money Laundering) and Terrorist Financing Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Any information disclosed by the Centre under subsection (1) may be used by an agency referred to in that subsection only as evidence of a contravention of Part 1 or 1.1, and any information disclosed by the Centre under subsection (2) may be used by an agency or body referred to in subsection (2) only for purposes relating to compliance with Part 1 or 1.1.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 14</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Enactment of Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Enactment of Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Enactment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>282.</B> The <I>Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act</I>, whose text is as follows and whose schedule is set out in the schedule to this Act, is enacted:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="10" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-4" Hyphenate="OFF">An Act to establish the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:SHORT TITLE--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SHORT TITLE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Short title<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>1.</B> This Act may be cited as the <I>Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:INTERPRETATION--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">INTERPRETATION</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>2.</B> The following definitions apply in this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Mackenzie gas project”<br />« <I>projet gazier Mackenzie</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Mackenzie gas project” means the project proposed by a consortium led by Imperial Oil Resources Ventures Limited that includes the development of the natural gas fields of Niglintgak, Taglu and Parsons Lake, and the construction and operation of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a gathering system related to those fields;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a natural gas liquids pipeline;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the natural gas pipeline that is the subject of the application GH-12004 made to the National Energy Board on October 7, 2004; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) facilities related to the fields, the gathering system or the pipelines.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“regional organization”<br />« <I>organisation régionale</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“regional organization” means an organization referred to in the schedule.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:DESIGNATION OF MINISTER--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">DESIGNATION OF MINISTER</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Power of Governor in Council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>3.</B> The Governor in Council may designate a member of the Queen’s Privy Council for Canada to be the Minister for the purpose of this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PURPOSE OF ACT--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PURPOSE OF ACT</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Purpose<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>4.</B> The purpose of this Act is to establish the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund in order to provide for contributions to regional organizations with respect to projects described in section 8.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:MACKENZIE GAS PROJECT IMPACTS FUND--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">MACKENZIE GAS PROJECT IMPACTS FUND</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Account established<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>5.</B> There is established in the accounts of Canada an account to be known as the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Charges<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>6.</B> On the requisition of the Minister, there is to be paid out of the Consolidated Revenue Fund and charged to the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund all contributions that are to be paid under section 8.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Interest to be credited to Fund<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>7.</B> The Minister of Finance must, from the Consolidated Revenue Fund, credit to the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund interest — calculated in the manner and at the rate determined by the Governor in Council — on the balance from time to time of that Fund.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Eligible project<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>8.</B> The Minister may provide contributions to regional organizations with respect to a project if the project</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) mitigates the existing or anticipated socio-economic impacts on communities in the Northwest Territories arising from the Mackenzie gas project; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) meets the criteria established and made publicly available by the Minister.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Agreement with regional organizations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>9.</B> The Minister must, before providing a contribution to a regional organization, enter into an agreement with the organization respecting, among other things,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the manner in which advances will be made in respect of contributions and when those advances will be made;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the terms or conditions on which the contributions will be provided; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the evaluation of the regional organization’s performance in achieving the objectives associated with the provision of contributions for eligible projects and the evaluation of the results of the projects that are funded.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:AMENDMENT OF SCHEDULE--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">AMENDMENT OF SCHEDULE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Order in council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.</B> The Governor in Council may, by order made on the recommendation of the Minister, add or delete the name of any organization to or from the schedule.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PAYMENT OUT OF THE CONSOLIDATED REVENUE FUND--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PAYMENT OUT OF THE CONSOLIDATED REVENUE FUND</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Payment of $500,000,000<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>11.</B> (1) From the Consolidated Revenue Fund, there may, on the requisition of the Minister of Finance made on the recommendation of the Minister, be credited to the Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Fund payments not greater than, in the aggregate, $500,000,000.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Condition for recommendation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Minister may only make the recommendation if the Mackenzie gas project has not been terminated and the Minister is of the opinion that progress is being made on the project.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Consequential Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Consequential Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Access to Information Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. A-1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Access to Information Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 4, s. 210<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>283.</B> Schedule I to the <I>Access to Information Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “OTHER GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Corporation for the Mitigation of Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Société d’atténuation des répercussions du projet gazier Mackenzie </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Administration Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. F-11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Administration Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 4, s. 211<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>284.</B> Part I of Schedule III to the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Corporation for the Mitigation of Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Société d’atténuation des répercussions du projet gazier Mackenzie </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Privacy Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. P-21<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Privacy Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 4, s. 212<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>285.</B> The schedule to the <I>Privacy Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “OTHER GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Corporation for the Mitigation of Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Société d’atténuation des répercussions du projet gazier Mackenzie </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Budget Implementation Act, 2006--><MarginalNote>2006, c. 4<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Budget Implementation Act, 2006</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>286.</B> Section 209 of the <I>Budget Implementation Act, 2006</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Repeal--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Repeal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 4, s. 208<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>287.</B> The <I>Mackenzie Gas Project Impacts Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 15</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Conflict of Interest Act--><MarginalNote>2006, c. 9, s. 2<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Conflict of Interest Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>288.</B> (1) Paragraph (<I>e</I>) of the definition “public office holder” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Conflict of Interest Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) a person or a member of a class of persons if the person or class of persons is designated under subsection 62.1(1) or 62.2(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph (<I>f</I>) of the definition “reporting public office holder” in subsection 2(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) a person or a member of a class of persons if the person or class of persons is designated under subsection 62.1(2) or 62.2(2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>289.</B> The Act is amended by adding the following before section 63:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Minister designating public office holder<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>62.1</B> (1) The appropriate minister of the Crown may designate a full-time ministerial appointee as a public office holder for the purpose of paragraph (<I>e</I>) of the definition “public office holder” in subsection 2(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Minister designating reporting public office holder<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The appropriate minister of the Crown may designate a full-time ministerial appointee who is a public office holder as a reporting public office holder for the purpose of paragraph (<I>f</I>) of the definition “reporting public office holder” in subsection 2(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Governor in Council designating public office holder<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>62.2</B> (1) The Governor in Council may, by order, designate any person or class of persons as public office holders for the purpose of paragraph (<I>e</I>) of the definition “public office holder” in subsection 2(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Governor in Council designating reporting public office holder<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Governor in Council may, by order, designate any person who is a public office holder or any class of persons who are public office holders as reporting public office holders for the purpose of paragraph (<I>f</I>) of the definition “reporting public office holder” in subsection 2(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 16</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Immigration and Refugee Protection Act--><MarginalNote>2001, c. 27<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>290.</B> Part 1 of the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</I> is amended by adding the following after the heading “IMMIGRATION TO CANADA”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Division 0.1--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 0.1</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Invitation to Make an Application--><Para TopMargin="5" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Invitation to Make an Application</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application for permanent residence — <keep>invitation</keep> <keep>to apply</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.1</B> (1) A foreign national who seeks to enter or remain in Canada as a member of a class that is referred to in an instruction given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>a</I>) may make an application for permanent residence only if the Minister has issued them an invitation to do so, the invitation has not been cancelled under subsection 10.2(5) and the applicable period specified in an instruction given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>k</I>) has not expired.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) An instruction may be given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>a</I>) only in respect of a class that is part of the economic class referred to in subsection 12(2).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Expression of interest<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) A foreign national who wishes to be invited to make an application must submit an expression of interest to the Minister by means of an electronic system in accordance with instructions given under section 10.3 unless the instructions provide that they may do so by other means.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Inadmissible foreign national<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A foreign national may not submit an expression of interest if they have been determined to be — and continue to be — inadmissible for misrepresentation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>New expression of interest<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) A foreign national who has submitted an expression of interest may not submit another one before the expiry of the period referred to in an instruction given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>f</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Change in circumstances<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) A foreign national who is invited to make an application must, before making the application, advise the Minister of any change in their circumstances that relates to any of the criteria on the basis of which they were invited.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Expression of interest — <keep>processing</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.2</B> (1) In processing an expression of interest, the Minister</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) is to determine whether the foreign national is eligible to be invited to make an application by applying the criteria set out in instructions given under paragraph 10.3(1)<I>(<I>e</I>)</I> and is to advise the foreign national of the determination in accordance with instructions given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>l</I>); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) subject to subsection (2), is to determine whether, in accordance with instructions given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>i</I>), the foreign national occupies the rank required to be invited to make an application and, if so, <keep>is to issue</keep> the invitation in accordance <keep>with instructions</keep> given under paragraph <keep>10.3(1)(<I>l</I>).</keep></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A determination under paragraph (1)(<I>b</I>) may be made only if the number of invitations that have been issued is less than the number provided for in an instruction given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>j</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Electronic system<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Minister is to use an electronic system to carry out any applicable instruction given under subsection 10.3(1) and to make a determination under paragraph (1)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Compliance with instructions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) An expression of interest must be processed in compliance with any applicable instruction.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Cancellation of invitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) The Minister may cancel an invitation to make an application if</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the invitation was issued in error; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) a change in the foreign national’s circumstances results in their no longer meeting the criteria on the basis of which they were invited.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Instructions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.3</B> (1) The Minister may give instructions governing any matter relating to invitations to make an application referred to in subsection 10.1(1), including instructions respecting</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the classes in respect of which subsection 10.1(1) applies;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the electronic system referred to in subsections 10.1(3) and 10.2(3);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the submission and processing of an expression of interest by means of the electronic system;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the circumstances in which an expression of interest may be submitted by means other than the electronic system and respecting those other means;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) the criteria that a foreign national must meet to be eligible to be invited to make an application;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the period during which a foreign national remains eligible to be invited to make an application;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) the personal information that the Minister may disclose under section 10.4 and the entities to which that information may be disclosed;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) the basis on which an eligible foreign national may be ranked relative to other eligible foreign nationals;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>i</I>) the rank an eligible foreign national must occupy to be invited to make an application;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j</I>) the number of invitations that may be issued within a specified period, including in respect of a class referred to in an instruction given under paragraph (<I>a</I>);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>k</I>) the period within which an application must be made once an invitation has been issued; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>l</I>) the means by which a foreign national is to be advised of any matter relating to their expression of interest, including an invitation to make an application.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Clarification<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) For greater certainty, an instruction given under paragraph (1)(<I>j</I>) may provide that the number of invitations that may be issued in any specified period in respect of a class be zero.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of instructions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) An instruction given under any of paragraphs (1)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>) and (<I>f</I>) to (<I>l</I>) applies in respect of an expression of interest that is submitted before the day on which the instruction takes effect, unless the instruction provides otherwise.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Publication<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Instructions given under subsection (1) must be published on the Department of Citizenship and Immigration’s Internet site. Instructions given under any of paragraphs <keep>(1)(<I>a</I>),</keep> (<I>d</I>) to (<I>g</I>), (<I>k</I>) and (<I>l</I>) must also be published in the <I>Canada Gazette</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Criteria provided for under other Divisions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) For greater certainty, an instruction given under subsection (1) may provide for criteria that are more stringent than the criteria or requirements provided for in or under any other Division of this Act regarding applications for permanent residence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Disclosure of information<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.4</B> For the purpose of facilitating the selection of a foreign national as a member of the economic class or as a temporary resident, the Minister may disclose personal information provided to him or her by the foreign national under section 10.1 and referred to in an instruction given under paragraph 10.3(1)(<I>g</I>) to an entity that is referred to in an instruction given under that paragraph.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>291.</B> Subsection 25(1.2) of the Act is amended by adding the following after paragraph (<I>a</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a.1</I>) the request is for an exemption from any of the criteria or obligations of Division 0.1;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2011, c. 8, s. 1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>292.</B> (1) Subsection 91(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Representation or advice for consideration<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>91.</B> (1) Subject to this section, no person shall knowingly, directly or indirectly, represent or advise a person for consideration — or offer to do so — in connection with the submission of an expression of interest under subsection 10.1(3) or a proceeding or application under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2011, c. 8, s. 1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsections 91(3) to (5) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Students-at-law<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) A student-at-law does not contravene subsection (1) by offering or providing representation or advice to a person if the student-at-law is acting under the supervision of a person mentioned in paragraph (2)(<I>a</I>) who is representing or advising the person — or offering to do so — in connection with the submission of an expression of interest under subsection 10.1(3) or a proceeding or application under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Agreement or arrangement with Her Majesty<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) An entity, including a person acting on its behalf, that offers or provides services to assist persons in connection with the submission of an expression of interest under subsection 10.1(3) or an application under this Act, including for a permanent or temporary resident visa, travel documents or a work or study permit, does not contravene subsection (1) if it is acting in accordance with an agreement or arrangement between that entity and Her Majesty in right of Canada that authorizes it to provide those services.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Designation by Minister<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) The Minister may, by regulation, designate a body whose members in good standing may represent or advise a person for consideration — or offer to do so — in connection with the submission of an expression of interest under subsection 10.1(3) or a proceeding or application under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2011, c. 8, s. 1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 91(7)(<I>b</I>) of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) providing that members or classes of members of a body that has ceased to be a designated body under that subsection continue for a specified period to be authorized to represent or advise a person for <keep>consideration</keep>— or offer to do so — in connection with the submission of an expression of interest under subsection 10.1(3) or a proceeding or application under this Act without contravening subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Order in council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>293.</B> The provisions of this Division come into force on a day or days to be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 17</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations Act--><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 2<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>294.</B> (1) The definition “essential services agreement” in subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) The definition “essential service” in subsection 4(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“essential service”<br />« <I>services essentiels</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“essential service” means a service, facility or activity of the Government of Canada that has been determined under subsection 119(1) to be essential.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 4(2) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>295.</B> Section 13 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mandate<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board’s mandate is to provide adjudication services and mediation services in accordance with this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>296.</B> Section 16 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>297.</B> (1) Paragraph 39(<I>h</I>) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 39(<I>j</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j</I>) the specification of the times within which notices, other than those referred to in subsections 124(1) and (2), and other documents are to be sent or given under this Part, the persons to whom they are to be sent or given and when they are deemed to have been sent, given or received;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>298.</B> Section 53 of the Act and the heading before it are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>299.</B> Section 67 of the Act is amended by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>c</I>), by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>d</I>) and by repealing paragraph (<I>e</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>300.</B> Subsections 79(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mergers, amalgamations and transfers of jurisdiction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>79.</B> (1) If, by reason of a merger or an amalgamation of employee organizations or a transfer of jurisdiction among employee organ- izations, other than as a result of a revocation of certification, an employee organization succeeds another one that, at the time of the merger, amalgamation or transfer of jurisdiction, is a bargaining agent, the successor is deemed to have acquired the rights, privileges and duties of its predecessor, whether under a collective agreement, an arbitral award or otherwise.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Board to determine questions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If any question arises in respect of the merger, amalgamation or transfer of jurisdiction concerning the rights, privileges and duties of an employee organization under this Part or under a collective agreement or an arbitral award in respect of a bargaining unit or an employee in a bargaining unit, the Board, on application by the employer or any person or employee organization concerned, must determine what rights, privileges and duties have been acquired or are retained.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>301.</B> Subsection 101(1) of the Act is amended by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>a</I>), by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>b</I>) and by repealing paragraph (<I>c</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>302.</B> The heading “<SC SC_PerCent="85">Choice of Process for Dispute Resolution</SC>” before section 103 and sections 103 and 104 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Process for Dispute Resolution--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Process for Dispute Resolution</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Conciliation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>103.</B> Subject to section 104, the process for the resolution of disputes between an employer and the bargaining agent for a bargaining unit is conciliation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Arbitration —<keep>agreement</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>104.</B> (1) The employer and the bargaining agent for a bargaining unit may, by agreement in writing, choose arbitration as the process for the resolution of disputes. If the employer is a separate agency, it may enter into such an agreement only with the approval of the President of the Treasury Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Arbitration — <keep>essential</keep> services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If, on the day on which notice to bargain collectively may be given, 80% or more of the positions in the bargaining unit have been designated under section 120, the process for the resolution of disputes between the employer and the bargaining agent is arbitration.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>303.</B> Subsections 105(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notice to bargain collectively<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>105.</B> (1) After the Board has certified an employee organization as the bargaining agent for a bargaining unit, the bargaining agent or the employer may, by notice in writing, require the other to commence bargaining collectively with a view to entering into, renewing or revising a collective agreement.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>When notice may be given<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subject to subsection (2.1), the notice to bargain collectively may be given</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) at any time, if no collective agreement or arbitral award is in force and no request for arbitration has been made by either of the parties in accordance with this Part; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if a collective agreement or arbitral award is in force, within the 12 months before it ceases to be in force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.1) In the case of the bargaining agent for a bargaining unit that has never been bound by a collective agreement or arbitral award to which the employer is a party, the notice to bargain collectively may not be given until the expiry of 60 days after the day on which the employer gives to the bargaining agent the notice required by section 121.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>304.</B> (1) The portion of section 107 of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Duty to observe terms and conditions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>107.</B> Unless the parties otherwise agree, and subject to subsection 125(1), after the notice to bargain collectively is given, each term and condition of employment applicable to the employees in the bargaining unit to which the notice relates that may be included in a collective agreement, and that is in force on the day on which the notice is given, is continued in force and must be observed by the employer, the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit and the employees in the bargaining unit until a collective agreement is entered into in respect of that term or condition or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 107(<I>a</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>a</I>) dans le cas où le mode de règlement des différends est l’arbitrage, jusqu’à ce que la décision arbitrale soit rendue;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>305.</B> Sections 119 to 134 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employer’s right to determine essential service<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>119.</B> (1) The employer has the exclusive right to determine whether any service, facility or activity of the Government of Canada is essential because it is or will be necessary for the safety or security of the public or a segment of the public.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employer’s right<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Nothing in this Act is to be construed as limiting the employer’s right under subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employer’s right to designate positions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>120.</B> (1) The employer has the exclusive right to designate the positions in a bargaining unit that include duties that, in whole or in part, are or will be necessary for the employer to provide essential services, and the employer may exercise that right at any time.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employer’s right<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Nothing in this Act is to be construed as limiting the employer’s right under subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notice to bargaining agent<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>121.</B> (1) The employer must notify in writing a bargaining agent that represents a bargaining unit that the employer either has, or has not, under section 120 designated positions in the bargaining unit.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Identification of designated positions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the notice is to the effect that the employer has designated positions, the notice must identify the designated positions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>When notice must be given<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The notice must be given not later than three months before the first day on which a notice to bargain collectively may be given. However, in the case of an employee organization that is certified as the bargaining agent for a bargaining unit after the day on which this section comes into force, the notice must be given within 60 days after the certification.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notice to Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) The employer must notify the Board of the date the notice was given under subsection (1) to the bargaining agent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Consultations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>122.</B> (1) If the notice under subsection 121(1) is to the effect that the employer has designated positions, the employer must, after giving the notice, without delay, begin consultations with the bargaining agent about the designated positions that are identified in the notice. Those consultations must end 60 days after the day on which the notice is given.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Employer’s determination<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Within the 30 days that follow the end of the 60 days, the employer must notify the bargaining agent of the positions in the bargaining unit that the employer has or will designate under section 120.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Replacement positions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>123.</B> If a position that is designated by the employer under section 120 becomes vacant, the employer may identify a position of the same type as a replacement position. If the employer does so, the employer must provide the bargaining agent with a notice of replacement.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notification of employees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>124.</B> (1) As soon as feasible after designating a position under section 120, the employer must provide the employee who occupies the position with a notice informing the employee that they occupy such a position.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notification of change<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A notice given under this section remains valid as long as the employee continues to occupy the position unless the employer notifies the employee that the position occupied by them is no longer necessary for the employer to provide essential services.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Duty to observe terms and conditions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>125.</B> (1) Unless the parties otherwise agree, every term and condition of employment applicable to employees in a bargaining unit in respect of which a notice to bargain collectively is given that may be included in a collective agreement and that is in force on the day on which the notice is given remains in force in respect of any employee who occupies a position that is designated under section 120 and must be observed by the employer, the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit and the employee until a collective agreement is entered into.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Saving<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Nothing in this Act is to be construed as limiting the employer’s right to require that an employee who occupies a position that is designated under section 120 perform all of the duties assigned to that position and be available during his or her off-duty hours to report to work without delay to perform those duties if required to do so by the employer.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>306.</B> Paragraph 135(<I>a</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>a</I>) d’une part, le mode de règlement des différends applicable à l’unité de négociation est l’arbitrage;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>307.</B> (1) Section 148 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Making of Arbitral Award--><Para TopMargin="10" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Making of Arbitral Award</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Preponderant factors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>148.</B> (1) In determining whether compensation levels and other terms and conditions represent a prudent use of public funds and are sufficient to allow the employer to meet its operational needs, the arbitration board is to be guided by and to give preponderance to the following factors in the conduct of its proceedings and in making an arbitral award:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the necessity of attracting competent persons to, and retaining them in, the public service in order to meet the needs of Canadians; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) Canada’s fiscal circumstances relative to its stated budgetary policies.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Other factors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If relevant to the making of a determination under subsection (1), the arbitration board may take any of the following factors into account:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) relationships with compensation and other terms and conditions of employment as between different classification levels within an occupation and as between occupations in the public service;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the compensation and other terms and conditions of employment relative to employees in similar occupations in the private and public sectors, including any geographical, industrial or other variations that the arbitration board considers relevant;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) compensation and other terms and conditions of employment that are reasonable in relation to the qualifications required, the work performed, the responsibility assumed and the nature of the services rendered; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the state of the Canadian economy.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Section 148 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (2):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Nothing in subsections (1) and (2) precludes the operation of sections 17 to 19 of the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>308.</B> The heading before section 149 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>309.</B> Subsection 149(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Making of arbitral award<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>149.</B> (1) The arbitration board must make an arbitral award as soon as feasible in respect of all the matters in dispute that are referred to it and set out in the award the reasons for its decision in respect of each of those matters.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Terms of employment to be considered<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) The arbitration board must not make an arbitral award without having taken into account all terms and conditions of employment of, <keep>and benefits</keep> provided to, the employees in <keep>the bargaining</keep> unit to which the award re-<keep>lates, including</keep> salaries, bonuses, allowances, <keep>vacation pay,</keep> employer contributions to pension funds or plans and all forms of health plans and dental insurance plans.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>310.</B> The Act is amended by adding the following after section 158:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Review--><Para TopMargin="10" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Review</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Review<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>158.1</B> (1) Within seven days after the day on which an arbitral award is made, the Chairperson may direct the arbitration board to review the arbitral award, or any part of it, if in the Chairperson’s opinion, the arbitral award, or any part of it, does not represent a reasonable application of the factors referred to in section 148 based on a full consideration of the written submissions provided to the arbitration board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Review — <keep>application</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) On application by either party to an arbitral award, made within seven days after the day on which the arbitral award is made, the Chairperson may, within seven days after the day on which the application is made, direct the arbitration board to review the arbitral award, or any part of it, if in the Chairperson’s opinion, the arbitral award, or any part of it, does not represent a reasonable application of the factors referred to in section 148 based on a full consideration of the written submissions provided to the arbitration board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Duty to confirm or amend<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Within 30 days after the day on which the Chairperson directs it to review the arbitral award, or any part of it, the arbitration board must either confirm the award or amend it and provide the Chairperson with reasons in writing for doing so. If the arbitral award is amended, the arbitration board must also provide the Chairperson with a copy of the amended arbitral award.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notice<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) The Chairperson must, without delay, inform the parties of the arbitration board’s decision and provide them with a copy of that board’s reasons in writing. If the arbitral award is amended, the Chairperson must also provide the parties with a copy of the amended arbitral award.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Restriction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) For greater certainty, the arbitration board’s power to amend the arbitral award is restricted to amending it only in relation to the matters in dispute that were originally referred to it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>311.</B> Paragraph 160(<I>a</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>a</I>) d’une part, le mode de règlement des différends applicable à l’unité de négociation est la conciliation;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>312.</B> Subsection 164(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Constitution<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>164.</B> (1) The public interest commission consists of either a single member appointed in accordance with section 165 or, subject to subsection (2), three members, appointed in accordance with section 167.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>313.</B> Sections 165 and 166 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Commission with single member<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>165.</B> (1) If the public interest commission is to consist of a single member, the Chairperson must submit to the Minister the name of a person jointly recommended by the bargaining agent and the employer. If no person is so recommended, the Chairperson may, at his or her discretion, recommend the appointment of a particular person.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) After receiving the recommendation, the Minister must, without delay, appoint the person recommended.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>314.</B> Subsections 167(3) to (5) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointment of chairperson nominated by parties<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Within five days after the day on which the second member is appointed, the two members must nominate a person to be the chairperson and third member of the public interest commission, and the Chairperson must recommend to the Minister the appointment of that person. The Minister must appoint the person, without delay, as chairperson and third member of the commission.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Failure to nominate<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If the two members fail to make a nomination under subsection (3), the Chairperson must, without delay, recommend to the Minister the appointment of a particular person as the chairperson and third member of the public interest commission.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) After receiving the recommendation, the Minister must, without delay, appoint the person recommended as the chairperson and third member of the public interest commission.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>315.</B> Subsection 170(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Death, incapacity or resignation of single member<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>170.</B> (1) In the event of the death, incapacity or resignation of the member of a public interest commission that consists of a single member before the commission makes a report to the Chairperson, the Chairperson must recommend to the Minister the appointment of another person under section 165 and the Minister must, without delay, appoint that person. That person must recommence the conciliation proceedings from the beginning.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>316.</B> (1) Section 175 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Preponderant factors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>175.</B> (1) In determining whether compensation levels and other terms and conditions represent a prudent use of public funds and are sufficient to allow the employer to meet its operational needs, the public interest commission is to be guided by and to give preponderance to the following factors in the conduct of its proceedings and in making a report to the Chairperson:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the necessity of attracting competent persons to, and retaining them in, the public service in order to meet the needs of Canadians; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) Canada’s fiscal circumstances relative to its stated budgetary policies.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Other factors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If relevant to the making of a determination under subsection (1), the public interest commission may take any of the following factors into account:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) relationships with compensation and other terms and conditions of employment as between different classification levels within an occupation and as between occupations in the public service;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the compensation and other terms and conditions of employment relative to employees in similar occupations in the private and public sectors, including any geographical, industrial or other variations that the public interest commission considers relevant;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) compensation and other terms and conditions of employment that are reasonable in relation to the qualifications required, the work performed, the responsibility assumed and the nature of the services rendered; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the state of the Canadian economy.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Section 175 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (2):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Nothing in subsections (1) and (2) precludes the operation of sections 20 and 21 of the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>317.</B> Section 176 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (1):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Reasons<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) The public interest commission must set out in the report the reasons for each of its recommendations.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Terms of employment to be considered<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.2) The public interest commission must not submit its report without having taken into account all terms and conditions of employment of, and benefits provided to, the employees in the bargaining unit to which the report relates, including salaries, bonuses, allowances, vacation pay, employer contributions to pension funds or plans and all forms of health plans and dental insurance plans.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>318.</B> Section 179 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Reconsideration of matters contained in report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>179.</B> The Chairperson may direct the public interest commission to reconsider and clarify or amplify its report or any part of it if in his or her opinion section 175 has not been properly applied.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>319.</B> (1) Subsection 182(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Alternate dispute resolution process<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>182.</B> (1) Despite any other provision of this Part, the employer and the bargaining agent for a bargaining unit may, at any time in the negotiation of a collective agreement, agree to refer any term or condition of employment of employees in the bargaining unit that may be included in a collective agreement to any eligible person for final and binding determination by whatever process the employer and the bargaining agent agree to. If the employer is a separate agency, it may enter into such an agreement to refer a term or condition for final and binding determination only with the approval of the President of the Treasury Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 182(2) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Maintien du mode normal de règlement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">(2) Le mode de règlement des différends applicable à toute condition d’emploi non renvoyée à la personne en question pour décision définitive et sans appel demeure la conciliation.</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>320.</B> Paragraph 190(1)(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the employer, a bargaining agent or an employee has failed to comply with subsection 125(1) (duty to observe terms and conditions); or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>321.</B> Paragraph 192(1)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if the employer has failed to comply with section 107 or subsection 125(1), an order requiring the employer to pay to any employee compensation that is not more than the amount that, in the Board’s opinion, is equivalent to the remuneration that would, but for that failure, have been paid by the employer to the employee;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>322.</B> (1) Paragraph 194(1)(<I>e</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>e</I>) si le mode de règlement des différends applicable à l’égard de l’unité de négociation est l’arbitrage;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraphs 194(1)(<I>f</I>) to (<I>j</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the process for resolution of a dispute applicable to the bargaining unit is conciliation and a notice has been given under section 121 to the effect that the employer has, under section 120, designated positions in the bargaining unit and the employer has not notified the bargaining agent under subsection 122(2);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 194(1)(<I>k</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>k</I>) si le mode de règlement des différends applicable à l’égard de l’unité de négociation est la conciliation et qu’aucune commission de l’intérêt public n’a été établie pour aider l’employeur et l’organisation syndicale, à titre d’agent négociateur de l’unité de négociation, à conclure ou à réviser la convention collective, sauf si l’organisation syndicale a été avisée conformément au paragraphe 162(3) qu’une telle commission ne serait pas établie;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) Subsection 194(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Essential services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) No employee organization shall declare or authorize a strike the effect of which is or would be to involve the participation of any employee who occupies a position that is designated under section 120, and no officer or representative of an employee organization shall counsel or procure the declaration or authorization of a strike in respect of a bargaining unit or the participation of those employees in a strike.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>323.</B> (1) Paragraph 196(<I>e</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>e</I>) s’il appartient à une unité de négociation pour laquelle le mode de règlement des différends est l’arbitrage;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraphs 196(<I>f</I>) to (<I>k</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) is included in a bargaining unit for which the process for resolution of a dispute is conciliation and in respect of which a notice has been given under section 121 to the effect that the employer has, under section 120, designated positions in the bargaining unit and the employer has not notified the bargaining agent under subsection 122(2);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) occupies a position that has been designated under section 120;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Paragraph 196(<I>l</I>) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"><I>l</I>) s’il appartient à une unité de négociation pour laquelle le mode de règlement des différends est la conciliation et à l’égard de laquelle aucune commission de l’intérêt public n’a été établie pour aider l’employeur et l’agent négociateur de l’unité de négociation à conclure ou à réviser la convention collective, sauf si l’agent négociateur a été avisé conformément au paragraphe 162(3) qu’aucune commission ne serait établie;</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>324.</B> Section 199 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Obstruction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>199.</B> No person shall impede or prevent or attempt to impede or prevent an employee from entering or leaving the employee’s place of work if the employee occupies a position that is designated under section 120.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>325.</B> (1) Subsection 208(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) An employee may not present an individ- ual grievance in respect of which an administrative procedure for redress is provided under any Act of Parliament.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 208(4) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Agreement required<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Unless the grievance is in respect of a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, an employee who is included in a bargaining unit may present an individual grievance only if the employee has the approval of and is represented by the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Section 208 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (7):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Discriminatory practices<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) An individual grievance in respect of a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> must be presented at the first level in the grievance process within one year after the last of the acts or omissions that gave rise to the grievance, or any longer period that the Board considers appropriate in the circumstances.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(9) An individual grievance may be dismissed at any level of the grievance process if the grievance is considered to be trivial, frivolous, vexatious or made in bad faith. If it is dismissed, the employee must be informed in writing of the dismissal and the reasons for it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>326.</B> (1) Subsection 209(1) of the Act is amended by striking out “or” at the end of paragraph (<I>c</I>) and by adding the following after that paragraph:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c.1</I>) a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 209(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Agreement required<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Unless the grievance is in respect of a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, an employee who is included in a bargaining unit may refer an individual grievance to adjudication only if the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit has agreed to represent the employee in the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>327.</B> Section 210 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>328.</B> Section 211 of the Act is renumbered as subsection 211(1) and is amended by adding the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Discriminatory practice<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of the referral to adjudication of an individual grievance in respect of a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>329.</B> Subsection 215(4) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A bargaining agent may not present a group grievance in respect of which an administrative procedure for redress is provided under any Act of Parliament.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>330.</B> Section 217 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>331.</B> Subsections 220(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Right of employer and bargaining agent<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>220.</B> (1) If the employer and a bargaining agent are bound by an arbitral award or have entered into a collective agreement and the employer or the bargaining agent seeks to enforce an obligation that is alleged to arise out of the award or agreement, other than an obligation the enforcement of which may be the subject of a grievance of an employee in the bargaining unit to which the agreement or award applies, either of them may present a policy grievance to the other.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Neither the employer nor a bargaining agent may present a policy grievance in respect of which an administrative procedure for redress is provided under any other Act of Parliament.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>332.</B> Section 222 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>333.</B> (1) Paragraph 226(1)(<I>h</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) give relief in accordance with any of paragraphs 53(2)(<I>b</I>) to (<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 226(1)(<I>j</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>j</I>) summarily dismiss grievances that in the adjudicator’s opinion are trivial, frivolous, vexatious or made in bad faith.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>334.</B> Section 232 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision in respect of policy grievances<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>232.</B> An adjudicator’s decision in respect of a policy grievance is limited to one or more of the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) declaring the correct interpretation of a collective agreement or an arbitral award;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) declaring that the collective agreement or arbitral award has been contravened; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) requiring the employer or bargaining agent, as the case may be, to interpret the collective agreement or arbitral award in a specified manner, without giving it retroactive effect.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>335.</B> Section 235 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Individual grievance — <keep>paragraph</keep> 209(1)(<I>a</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>235.</B> (1) Subject to subsection (3), if an individual grievance that is related to matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>a</I>) is referred to adjudication by an aggrieved employee, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne in equal parts by the employer and the bargaining agent that represents the aggrieved employee in the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Paragraph 209(1)(<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If an individual grievance that is related to matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>) is referred to adjudication by an aggrieved employee who is included in a bargaining unit, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne in equal parts by the bargaining agent and the deputy head responsible for the portion of the public service that employs the aggrieved employee in the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Paragraph 209(1)(<I>a</I>) and paragraph 209(1)(<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If an individual grievance that is related to matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>a</I>) and matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>) or to matters in both of those paragraphs is referred to adjudication by an aggrieved employee, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne in equal parts by the bargaining agent and the deputy head responsible for the portion of the public service that employs the aggrieved employee in the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Paragraph 209(1)(<I>c.1</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) If an individual grievance that is related to matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>c.1</I>) is referred to adjudication by an aggrieved employee who is included in a bargaining unit, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne by the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Paragraph 209(1)(<I>d</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If an individual grievance that is related to matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>d</I>) is referred to adjudication by an aggrieved employee who is included in a bargaining unit, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne in equal parts by the employer and the bargaining agent that represents the aggrieved employee in the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Paragraph 209(1)(<I>b</I>), (<I>c</I>), (<I>c.1</I>) or (<I>d</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(6) If an individual grievance that is related to matters referred to in paragraph 209(1)(<I>b</I>), (<I>c</I>), (<I>c.1</I>) or (<I>d</I>) is referred to adjudication by an aggrieved employee who is not included in a bargaining unit, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne by the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Recovery<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(7) Any amount that by this section is payable by a bargaining agent may be recovered as a debt due to Her Majesty in right of Canada. The bargaining agent is deemed to be a person for the purposes of this subsection.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Determination by Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(8) For the purpose of this section, the expenses of the adjudication are determined by the Chairperson.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Group grievance<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>235.1</B> (1) If a group grievance is referred to adjudication, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne in equal parts by the employer and the bargaining agent that represents the aggrieved employees in the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Recovery<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Any amount that by subsection (1) is payable by a bargaining agent may be recovered as a debt due to Her Majesty in right of Canada. The bargaining agent is deemed to be a person for the purposes of this subsection.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Determination by Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) For the purpose of this section, the expenses of the adjudication are determined by the Chairperson.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Policy grievance<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>235.2</B> (1) If a policy grievance is referred to adjudication, the expenses of the adjudication are to be borne in equal parts by the employer and the bargaining agent to the adjudication proceedings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Recovery<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Any amount that by subsection (1) is payable by a bargaining agent may be recovered as a debt due to Her Majesty in right of Canada. The bargaining agent is deemed to be a person for the purposes of this subsection.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Determination by Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) For the purpose of this section, the expenses of the adjudication are determined by the Chairperson.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>336.</B> (1) Subsection 237(1) of the Act is amended by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>g</I>), by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>h</I>) and by repealing paragraph (<I>i</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Section 237 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (1):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Extensions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) Regulations made under paragraph <keep>(1)(<I>d</I>),</keep> (<I>f</I>) or (<I>h</I>) may provide for extensions of time only in circumstances that the Board considers to be exceptional.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>337.</B> Subsection 247(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Remuneration and expenses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>247.</B> (1) Members of arbitration boards, mediators, adjudicators and persons seized of referrals under subsection 182(1) are entitled to be paid the remuneration and expenses that may be fixed by the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provisions--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>338.</B> (1) The following definitions apply in this section.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“commencement day”<br />« <I>date de référence</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“commencement day” means the day on which this Act receives royal assent.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“the Act”<br />« <I>Loi</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“the Act” means the <I><I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I></I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Words and expressions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Unless the context otherwise requires, words and expressions used in this section have the same meaning as in the Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of provisions enacted by this Act<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subject to subsections (4) to (7), the provisions of the Act, as enacted by sections 294 to 306, subsection 307(1), sections 308 to 314, subsection 316(1) and sections 317 to 324 also apply in respect of the following bargaining units:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) a bargaining unit in respect of which a notice to commence bargaining collectively with a view to entering into, renewing or revising a collective agreement has been given before the commencement day;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) a bargaining unit that is bound by a collective agreement or arbitral award that is in force on the commencement day and that expires on that day or at any time after that day, and in respect of which no notice to bargain collectively has been given before the commencement day; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) a bargaining unit in respect of which no notice to bargain collectively for the purpose of entering into a first collective agreement has been given before the commencement day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Arbitration board established<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The provisions of the Act, as they read immediately before the commencement day, continue to apply in respect of a bargaining unit that is referred to in paragraph (3)(<I>a</I>) until an arbitral award is made in respect of the bargaining unit if, before the commencement day,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) a request for arbitration was made by the employer or the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the Chairperson had notified the parties of the establishment of an arbitration board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Public interest commission established<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) The provisions of the Act, as they read immediately before the commencement day, continue to apply in respect of a bargaining unit that is referred to in paragraph (3)(<I>a</I>) until a collective agreement is entered into by parties if, before the commencement day,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) a request for conciliation was made by the employer or the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) the Chairperson had notified the parties of the establishment of a public interest commission.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No essential services agreement entered<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) If, before the commencement day, arbitration or conciliation has been chosen by the bargaining agent representing a bargaining unit that is referred to in paragraph (3)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) as the process for the resolution of disputes to which it may be a party and if, before that day, no essential services agreement has been entered into by the employer and the bargaining agent in relation to that bargaining unit, then,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) the process for the resolution of disputes is conciliation; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) despite subsection 121(3) of the Act, as enacted by section 305, the notice that is referred to in subsection 121(1) of the Act, as enacted by section 305, must be given not later than 12 months after the commencement day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Essential services agreement entered into<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) If, before the commencement day, arbitration or conciliation has been chosen by the bargaining agent representing a bargaining unit that is referred to in paragraph (3)(<I>a</I>) or (<I>b</I>) as the process for the resolution of disputes to which it may be a party and if, before that day, an essential services agreement has been entered into by the employer and the bargaining agent in relation to that bargaining unit, then, the process for the resolution of disputes is</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) arbitration, if 80% or more of the positions in the bargaining unit were, immediately before the commencement day, necessary for the employer to provide an essential service; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) conciliation, if less than 80% of the positions in the bargaining unit were, immediately before the commencement day, necessary for the employer to provide an essential service.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of subsection 105(2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) Subsection 105(2) of the Act, as that subsection read immediately before the commencement day, continues to apply in respect of a bargaining unit referred to in paragraph (3)(<I>b</I>) until an arbitral award is made or a collective agreement is entered into in respect of a bargaining unit.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Positions — <keep>essential</keep> services agreement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) If a bargaining unit is bound by an essential service agreement immediately before the commencement day, every position that is identified in the agreement as being necessary for the employer to provide essential services is deemed to be a position designated by the employer under section 120 of the Act, as enacted by section 305. However, subsection 124(1) of the Act, as enacted by section 305, does not apply in respect of any of those positions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Grievance<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>339.</B> The provisions of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, as it read immediately before the day on which sections 325 to 336 come into force, continue to apply in respect of every grievance presented under Part 2 of that Act before that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canadian Human Rights Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. H-6<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canadian Human Rights Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>340.</B> Section 40.1 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> is amended by adding the following after subsection (2):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) A complaint must not be dealt with by the Commission under section 40 if the complaint is made by an employee, as defined in subsection 206(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, against their employer, as defined in subsection 2(1) of that Act and it alleges that the employer has engaged in a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote><I>Public Service Employment Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A complaint must not be dealt with by the Commission under section 40 if the complaint is made by a person against the Public Service Commission or a deputy head as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> and it alleges that a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 has been engaged in in relation to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an appointment or proposed appointment in an internal appointment process under that Act;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the revocation of an appointment under that Act; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the laying off of employees under that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provision--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Complaints<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>341.</B> The provisions of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which section 340 comes into force, continue to apply in respect of every complaint filed with or initiated by the Canadian Human Rights Commission before that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Employment Act--><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, ss. 12 and 13<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Employment Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>342.</B> (1) Paragraph 35(1)(<I>b</I>) of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) has the right to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 35(2)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) has the right to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2005, c. 21, s. 115<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>343.</B> Paragraph 35.1(1)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) has the right to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 9, s. 101<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>344.</B> Paragraph 35.2(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) has the right to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 9, s. 101<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>345.</B> Paragraph 35.3(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) has the right to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>346.</B> Subsection 58(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Extension by deputy head<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A deputy head may extend the specified term, and the extension does not constitute an appointment or deployment or entitle any person to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>347.</B> Subsection 59(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Not an appointment or deployment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A conversion under subsection (1) does not constitute an appointment or deployment or entitle any person to make a complaint under section 77 or 78.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>348.</B> Subsections 64(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Laying off of employees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>64.</B> (1) If an employee’s services are no longer required by reason of lack of work, the discontinuance of a function or the transfer of work or a function outside those portions of the federal public administration named in Schedule I, IV or V to the <I>Financial Administration Act</I>, the deputy head may lay off the employee, in which case the deputy head shall so advise the employee.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Selection of employees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the deputy head determines under subsection (1) that some but not all of the employees in any part of the deputy head’s organization who occupy positions at the same group and level and perform similar duties are to be laid off, the employees to be laid off shall be selected in accordance with the Commission’s regulations.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>349.</B> (1) Subsection 65(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Complaint to Tribunal re <keep>lay-off</keep><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>65.</B> (1) If some but not all of the employees in a part of an organization who occupy positions at the same group and level and perform similar duties are informed by the deputy head that they will be laid off, any employee selected for lay-off may make a complaint to the Tribunal, in the manner and within the time fixed by the Tribunal’s regulations, that his or her selection constituted an abuse of authority.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsections 65(5) and (6) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Discriminatory practice<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If the Tribunal determines that the Commission or the deputy head has engaged in a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, it may order that the Commission or deputy head, as the case may be, cease the discriminatory practice and take measures to redress the practice or to prevent the same or a similar practice from occurring in the future or it may make any order that may be made under any of paragraphs 53(2)(<I>b</I>) to (<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 65(8) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>350.</B> The Act is amended by adding the following after section 76:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Discriminatory practice<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>76.1</B> (1) If the Tribunal finds a complaint under section 74 to be substantiated and it determines that the Commission or the deputy head has engaged in a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, it may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) order that the Commission or deputy head, as the case may be, cease the discriminatory practice and take measures to redress the practice or to prevent the same or a similar practice from occurring in the future; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) make any order that may be made under any of paragraphs 53(2)(<I>b</I>) to (<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) In considering whether a complaint is substantiated, the Tribunal may interpret and apply the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, other than its provisions relating to the right to equal pay for work of equal value.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>351.</B> Sections 77 to 79 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Grounds of complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>77.</B> (1) When the Commission has made or proposed an appointment in an internal appointment process, a person referred to in subsection (2) may, in the manner and within the period provided by the Tribunal’s regulations, make a complaint to the Tribunal that he or she was not appointed or proposed for appointment by reason of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) an abuse of authority by the Commission in the exercise of its authority under subsection 30(2);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) an abuse of authority by the Commission in choosing between an advertised and a non-advertised internal appointment process; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the failure of the Commission to assess the complainant in the official language of his or her choice as required by subsection 37(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Persons entitled to make complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The following persons may make a complaint under subsection (1):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) in the case of an advertised internal appointment process, a person who is an unsuccessful candidate in the area of selection determined under section 34 and who has been determined by the Commission to meet the essential qualifications for the work to be performed as established by the deputy head under paragraph 30(2)(<I>a</I>); and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) in the case of a non-advertised internal appointment process, a person who is in the area of selection determined under section 34.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Excluded grounds<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Tribunal may not consider an allegation that fraud occurred in an appointment process or that an appointment or proposed appointment was not free from political influence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>When no right to complain<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) No complaint may be made under subsection (1) in respect of an appointment under subsection 15(6) (reappointment on revocation by deputy head), section 40 (prior- ities — surplus employees), subsection 41(1) or (4) (other priorities), section 73 (reappointment on revocation by Commission) or section 86 (reappointment following Tribunal order), or under any regulations made under paragraph 22(2)(<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Corrective action when complaint upheld<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(5) If the Tribunal finds the complaint to be substantiated, it may order the Commission to revoke the appointment or not to make the appointment, as the case may be, and to take any corrective action that the Tribunal considers appropriate.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Grounds of complaint — <keep>person</keep> not meeting qualifications<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>78.</B> (1) When, in the case of an advertised internal appointment process, the Commission has made or proposed an appointment, a person who is an unsuccessful candidate in the area of selection determined under section 34 and who has been determined by the Commission not to meet the essential qualifications for the work to be performed as established by the deputy head under paragraph 30(2)(<I>a</I>) or the qualifications considered by the deputy head under subparagraph 30(2)(<I>b</I>)(i) to be an asset for that work may, in the manner and within the period provided by the regulations, make a complaint to the Tribunal that the Commission</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) has abused its authority under subsection 30(2) in making that determination in relation to those qualifications; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) has failed to assess the complainant in the official language of the complainant’s choice as required by subsection 37(1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>When no right to complain<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) No complaint may be made under subsection (1) in respect of an appointment under subsection 15(6) (reappointment on revocation by deputy head), section 40 (priorities — surplus employees), subsection 41(1) or (4) (other priorities), section 73 (reappointment on revocation by Commission) or section 86 (reappointment following Tribunal order), or under any regulations made under paragraph 22(2)(<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Corrective action when complaint upheld<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If the Tribunal finds the complaint to be substantiated, it may order the Commission to revoke the appointment or not to make the appointment, as the case may be, and to take any corrective action that the Tribunal considers appropriate.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Right to be heard<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>79.</B> A person making a complaint under section 77 or 78, the person appointed or proposed for appointment, the deputy head and the Commission — or their <keep>representatives</keep>— are entitled to be heard by the Tribunal.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>352.</B> Section 80 of the English version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>80.</B> In considering whether a complaint under section 77 or 78 is substantiated, the Tribunal may interpret and apply the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>, other than its provisions relating to the right to equal pay for work of equal value.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>353.</B> Sections 81 and 82 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Corrective action when complaint upheld<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>81.</B> (1) If the Tribunal finds a complaint under section 77 or 78 to be substantiated, the Tribunal may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) order the Commission or the deputy head to revoke the appointment or not to make the appointment, as the case may be, and to take any corrective action that the Tribunal considers appropriate; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if it has determined that the Commission or the deputy head has engaged in a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) order that the Commission or deputy head, as the case may be, cease the discriminatory practice and take measures to redress the practice or to prevent the same or a similar practice from occurring in the future; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) make any order that may be made under any of paragraphs 53(2)(<I>b</I>) to (<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Restriction<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Tribunal may not order the Commission or the deputy head to make an appointment or to conduct a new appointment process if the Commission or the deputy head, as the case may be, has not been determined to have engaged in a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>354.</B> Paragraph 83(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the person who made the complaint under section 77 or 78,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>355.</B> Section 84 of the Act is amended by striking out “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>a</I>), by adding “or” at the end of paragraph (<I>b</I>) and by adding the following after paragraph (<I>b</I>):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) if the complaint involved a discriminatory practice set out in section 7, 8, 10 or 14 of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act,</I> make any order against the deputy head or the Commission that the Tribunal considers appropriate in the circumstances.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>356.</B> Subsection 88(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mandate<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Tribunal’s mandate is to consider and dispose of complaints made under subsection 65(1) and sections 74, 77, 78 and 83.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>357.</B> Section 99 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (2):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissing complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.1) The Tribunal may summarily dismiss a complaint if the complainant fails to comply with any procedures set out in this Act, or the Tribunal’s regulations, in relation to a complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissing complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.2) The Tribunal may summarily dismiss a complaint if the deputy head has taken the corrective action that the Tribunal considers appropriate in relation to the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>358.</B> Section 101 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Copy of decision provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>101.</B> The Tribunal shall render a decision on a complaint made under subsection 65(1) or section 74, 77, 78 or 83 and provide a copy of it — including any written reasons — and any accompanying order to the Commission and to each person who exercised the right to be heard on the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>359.</B> (1) Paragraph 109(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the manner in which and the time within which a complaint may be made under subsection 65(1) or section 74, 77, 78 or 83;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Section 109 of the Act is amended by adding “and” at the end of paragraph (<I>c</I>) and by repealing paragraph (<I>d</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provision--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Complaints<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>360.</B> The provisions of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I>, as it Act read immediately before the day on which sections 348 to 357 come into force, continue to apply in respect of every complaint made under that Act before that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act--><MarginalNote>2009, c. 2. s. 394<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>361.</B> Section 17 of the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Arbitration<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>17.</B> If arbitration has been chosen under subsection 104(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> as, or is, by reason of subsection 104(2) of that Act, the process for the resolution of disputes, questions concerning the provision of equitable compensation to employees may be the subject of a request for arbitration under subsection 136(1) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>362.</B> Section 20 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Conciliation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>20.</B> If conciliation is the process for the resolution of disputes by reason of section 103 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, questions concerning the provision of equitable compensation to employees may be the subject of a request for conciliation under subsection 161(1) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coordinating Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coordinating Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2009, c. 2<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>363.</B> (1) In this section, “other Act” means the <I>Budget Implementation Act, 2009</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) If section 400 of the other Act comes into force before section 295 of this Act, then section 13 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mandate<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board’s mandate is to provide adjudication services and mediation services in accordance with this Act and the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If section 295 of this Act comes into force before section 400 of the other Act, then that section 400 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>400.</B> Section 13 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mandate<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board’s mandate is to provide adjudication services and mediation services in accordance with this Act and the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) If section 295 of this Act comes into force on the same day as section 400 of the other Act, then that section 400 is deemed to have come into force before that section 295 and subsection (2) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Subsections 307(2) and 316(2)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>364.</B> (1) Subsections 307(2) and 316(2) come into force on the day on which section 17 of the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Sections 325 to 336, 340 and 342 to 359<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Sections 325 to 336, 340 and 342 to 359 come into force on a day to be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 18</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Reorganization of Federal Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Boards--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Reorganization of Federal Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Boards</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Enactment of Act<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>365.</B> The <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> is enacted as follows:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="10" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-4" Hyphenate="OFF">An Act to establish the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:SHORT TITLE--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SHORT TITLE</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Short title<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>1.</B> This Act may be cited as the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:INTERPRETATION--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">INTERPRETATION</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>2.</B> The following definitions apply in this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“bargaining agent”<br />« <I>agent négociateur</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“bargaining agent” has the same meaning as in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“employer”<br />« <I>employeur</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“employer” has the same meaning as in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Minister”<br />« <I>ministre</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Minister” means the Minister who is designated under section 3.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:DESIGNATION OF MINISTER--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">DESIGNATION OF MINISTER</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Power of Governor in Council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>3.</B> The Governor in Council may, by order, designate any federal minister, other than a member of the Treasury Board, to be the Minister referred to in this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Establishment and Composition--><Para TopMargin="5" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Establishment and Composition</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Establishment of Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>4.</B> (1) A board is established, to be known as the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Board’s composition<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Board is composed of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a Chairperson, who is to hold office on a full-time basis;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) not more than two Vice-chairpersons, who are to hold office on a full-time basis;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) not more than 10 other members who are to hold office on a full-time basis; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) any part-time members that the Governor in Council considers necessary to carry out the Board’s powers, duties and functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Appointment of Members--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Appointment of Members</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Qualifications<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>5.</B> (1) To be eligible to hold office as a member, a person must</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) be a Canadian citizen within the meaning of the <I>Citizenship Act</I> or a permanent resident as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) not hold any other office or employment under the employer;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) not be a member of or hold an office or employment under an employee organization, as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, that is certified as a bargaining agent; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) not accept any office or employment, or carry on any activity, that is inconsistent with the person’s duties or functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Despite paragraph (1)(<I>b</I>), a person is not ineligible to hold office as a member by reason only of holding office as a member of any board that may be constituted by the Commissioner in Council of the Northwest Territories or the Legislature of Yukon or the Legislature for Nunavut with powers, duties and functions similar to those of the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointments of other members from list<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>6.</B> (1) Every member, other than the Chairperson or a Vice-chairperson, must be appointed from among eligible persons whose names are on a list prepared by the Chairperson after consultation with the employer and the bargaining agents.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Contents<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Chairperson must set out on the list</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the names of all eligible persons who are recommended by the employer;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the names of all eligible persons who are recommended by the bargaining agents; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the names of any other eligible persons whom the Chairperson considers suitable for appointment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Equal numbers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The appointment of members, other than the Chairperson and the Vice-chairpersons, is to be made so as to ensure that, to the extent possible, an equal number are appointed from among persons recommended by the employer and from among persons recommended by the bargaining agents.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-representative Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) Despite being recommended by the employer or the bargaining agents, a member does not represent either the employer or the employees and must act impartially in the exercise of their powers and the performance of their duties and functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Residence of full-time members<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>7.</B> A full-time member must reside in the National Capital Region as it is described in the schedule to the <I>National Capital Act</I> or within any distance of it that the Governor in Council may determine.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointment of members<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>8.</B> (1) Each member is to be appointed by the Governor in Council, on the Minister’s recommendation, to hold office during good behaviour and may be removed by the Governor in Council for cause.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Term of office<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A full-time member may be appointed for a term of office that is not more than five years and a part-time member may be appointed for a term of office that is not more than three years.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Reappointment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) A member is eligible for reappointment on the expiry of any term of office.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Completion of duties and functions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(4) A person who ceases to be a member for any reason other than removal may, at the request of the Chairperson, within eight weeks after ceasing to be a member, carry out and complete any duties or functions that they would otherwise have had in connection with any matter that came before the Board while they were still a member and in respect of which there was any proceeding in which they participated as a member. For that purpose, the person is deemed to be a part-time member.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Oath or solemn affirmation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>9.</B> Before beginning their duties or functions, a person who is appointed as a member of the Board must take an oath or make a solemn affirmation in the following form before a commissioner of oaths or other person having authority to administer oaths or solemn affirmations:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" Size="8" Leading="9" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">I, ...................., do swear (<I>or</I> solemnly affirm) that I will faithfully, truly and impartially, to the best of my judgment, skill and ability, execute and perform the office of member (<I>or</I> Chairperson <I>or</I> Vice-chairperson) of the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Remuneration--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Remuneration</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Remuneration<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.</B> Every member and former member referred to in subsection 8(4)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) is to be paid the remuneration that may be determined by the Governor in Council; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) is entitled to be paid reasonable travel and other expenses incurred by them in the course of their duties while absent from, in the case of full-time members, their ordinary place of work and, in the case of part-time members, their ordinary place of residence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Application of Other Acts--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Application of Other Acts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of <I>Public Service Superannuation Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>11.</B> A full-time member is deemed to be employed in the public service for the purposes of the <I>Public Service Superannuation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application of certain Acts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>12.</B> A member is deemed to be an employee for the purposes of the <I>Government Employees Compensation Act</I> and to be employed in the federal public administration for the purposes of regulations made under section 9 of the <I>Aeronautics Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Head Office and Meetings--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Head Office and Meetings</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Head office<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board’s head office is to be in the National Capital Region as it is described in the schedule to the <I>National Capital Act</I> but the Board may, with the approval of the Governor in Council, establish any regional offices that the Chairperson considers necessary for the exercise of the Board’s powers and the perform- ance of its duties and functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Services and facilities<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>14.</B> In exercising its powers and performing its duties and functions, the Board may use any services and facilities of departments, boards and agencies of the Government of Canada that are appropriate for the Board’s operation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Meetings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>15.</B> (1) Meetings of the Board are to be held at any date, time and place that the Chairperson considers appropriate for the conduct of the Board’s business.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Off-site participation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A meeting of the Board may be held <keep>by any means</keep> of telecommunication that per-<keep>mits all</keep> persons who are participating to <keep>communicate</keep> adequately with each other. A person who is participating by such means is deemed to be present at the meeting.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Quorum<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>16.</B> The Chairperson, one Vice-chairperson and a majority of the other full-time members constitute a quorum at a meeting of the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Attendance of part-time members at meetings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>17.</B> A part-time member is not entitled to attend a meeting of the Board, but may attend at the Chairperson’s invitation.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision of majority<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>18.</B> A decision of a majority of the Board’s members who are present at a meeting of the Board is a decision of the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Board’s Powers, Duties and Functions--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Board’s Powers, Duties and Functions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers, duties and functions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>19.</B> The Board is to exercise the powers and perform the duties and functions that are conferred or imposed on it by this Act or any other Act of Parliament.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>20.</B> The Board has, in relation to any matter before it, the power to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) summon and enforce the attendance of witnesses and compel them to give oral or written evidence on oath in the same manner as a superior court of record;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) order pre-hearing procedures, including pre-hearing conferences that are held in private, and determine the date, time and place of the hearings for those procedures;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) order that a pre-hearing conference or a hearing be conducted using any means of telecommunication that permits all persons who are participating to communicate adequately with each other;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) administer oaths and solemn affirmations;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) accept any evidence, whether admissible in a court of law or not; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) compel, at any stage of a proceeding, any person to produce the documents and things that may be relevant.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Frivolous matters<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>21.</B> The Board may dismiss summarily any matter that in its opinion is trivial, frivolous, vexatious or was made in bad faith.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Determination without oral hearing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>22.</B> The Board may decide any matter before it without holding an oral hearing.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>General power to assist parties<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>23.</B> The Board, or any of its members or employees that it designates, may, if the parties agree, assist the parties in resolving any issues in dispute at any stage of a proceeding and by any means that the Board considers appropriate, without prejudice to the Board’s power to determine issues that have not been settled.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Delegation by Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>24.</B> The Board may</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) authorize the Chairperson to exercise any of its powers or perform any of its duties or functions, other than the power to make regulations; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) authorize any person to exercise any of its powers under paragraphs 20(<I>d</I>) to (<I>f</I>) and require the person to report to it on what the person has done.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Chairperson--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Chairperson</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Chief executive officer<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>25.</B> The Chairperson is the chief executive officer of the Board and has supervision over and direction of the Board’s work, including</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the assignment and reassignment of matters that the Board is seized of to panels;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the composition of panels; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the determination of the date, time and place of hearings.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Delegation by Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>26.</B> The Chairperson may authorize a Vice-chairperson to exercise any of the Chairperson’s powers or perform any of the Chairperson’s duties or functions, including powers, duties or functions delegated to the Chairperson by the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Acting Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>27.</B> (1) If the Chairperson is absent or unable to act or the office of Chairperson is vacant, a Vice-chairperson designated by the Minister is to act as Chairperson.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Absence of Chairperson and Vice-chairpersons<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the Chairperson and the Vice-chairpersons are absent or unable to act, or all of those offices are vacant, the Minister may designate a member to act as Chairperson but no member so designated has authority to act as Chairperson for more than 90 days without the Governor in Council’s approval.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Human Resources--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Human Resources</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Responsibility for human resources management<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>28.</B> The Chairperson is authorized, in respect of persons who are employed by the Board, to exercise the powers and perform the duties and functions of the Treasury Board under the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> that relate to human resources management within the meaning of paragraph 7(1)(<I>e</I>) and section 11.1 of that Act, and those of deputy heads under subsection 12(2) of that Act, including the determination of terms and conditions of employment of persons who are employed by the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Human resources<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>29.</B> (1) The Chairperson may employ persons for the conduct of the Board’s work, fix their period of employment, establish their probationary periods, reject them on probation and lay them off.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Political activities<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Part 7 of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> applies to persons who are employed by the Board as if they were employees as defined in subsection 2(1) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Experts and advisors<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>30.</B> (1) The Chairperson may engage on a temporary basis the services of mediators and other experts to assist the Board in an advisory capacity and, subject to the Governor in Council’s approval, fix their remuneration.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application of <I>Public Service Superannuation Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A person who is engaged under subsection (1) is not to be considered as being employed in the public service for the purposes of the <I>Public Service Superannuation Act</I> by reason only of being so engaged.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Protection--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Protection</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Evidence respecting information obtained<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>31.</B> A member of the Board, any person who is employed by the Board or any person who is engaged under subsection 30(1) is not competent or compellable to appear as a witness in any civil action, suit or other proceeding respecting information obtained in the exercise of their powers or the performance of their duties and functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No disclosure of notes and drafts<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>32.</B> Notes or draft orders or decisions of the Board or of any of its members are not to be disclosed without the consent of the person who made them.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Immunity from proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>33.</B> No criminal or civil proceedings lie against a member of the Board, any person who is employed by the Board, any person who is engaged under subsection 30(1) or any person who is acting on the Board’s behalf for anything done — or omitted to be done — or reported or said by that member or that person in good faith in the course of the exercise or performance or purported exercise or performance of their powers, duties or functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Review and Enforcement of Orders and Decisions--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Review and Enforcement of Orders and Decisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No review by court<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>34.</B> (1) Every order or decision of the Board is final and is not to be questioned or reviewed in any court, except in accordance with the <I>Federal Courts Act</I> on the grounds referred to in paragraph 18.1(4)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>) or (<I>e</I>) of that Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Standing of Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Board has standing to appear in proceedings under subsection (1) for the purpose of making submissions regarding the standard of review to be used with respect to its orders or decisions and its jurisdiction, policies and procedures.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No review by <I>certiorari</I>, etc.<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) Except as permitted by subsection (1), no order, decision or proceeding of the Board made or carried on under or purporting to be made or carried on under any Act of Parliament may, on any ground, including the ground that the order, decision or proceeding is beyond the Board’s jurisdiction to make or carry on or that, in the course of any proceeding, the Board for any reason exceeded or lost its jurisdiction,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) be questioned, reviewed, prohibited or restrained; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) be made the subject of any proceedings in or any process of any court, whether by way of injunction, <I>certiorari</I>, prohibition, <I>quo warranto</I> or otherwise.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Filing of Board’s orders in Federal Court<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>35.</B> (1) The Board must, on the written request of any person or organization affected by any order of the Board, file a certified copy of the order, exclusive of the reasons for it, in the Federal Court, unless, in the Board’s opinion,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) there is no indication, or likelihood, of failure to comply with the order; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) there is another good reason why the filing of the order in the Federal Court would serve no useful purpose.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Effect of filing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) An order of the Board becomes an order of the Federal Court when a certified copy of it is filed in that court, and it may subsequently be enforced as such.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Regulations--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Regulations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Regulations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>36.</B> The Board may make regulations respecting</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the practice and procedure for hearings and pre-hearing proceedings of the Board;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) the use of any means of telecommunication in the conduct of its activities;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the hearing or determination of any application, complaint, question or dispute that may be made to, referred to or otherwise come before the Board;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) the establishment of an expeditious procedure and matters that may be determined under that procedure;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) the forms to be used in respect of any proceeding that may come before the Board;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the manner in which and the period during which evidence and information may be presented to the Board in connection with any proceeding that may come before it;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>g</I>) the time within which and the persons to whom notices, other than those referred to in subsections 130(1) and (2) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, and other documents must be sent or given, and when the notices are deemed to have been sent, given or received; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) any other matters or things that are incidental or conducive to the exercise of the Board’s powers and the performance of its duties and functions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Panels--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Panels</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Panels<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>37.</B> (1) Subject to subsection (2), matters of which the Board is seized are to be heard by a panel consisting of one member.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Three-member panels<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the Chairperson considers that the complexity of a matter requires it, he or she may assign the matter to a panel consisting of three members.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Chairperson of three-member panel<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) If the Chairperson is a member of a three-person panel, he or she is to be its chairperson; otherwise, he or she must designate a member of it to be its chairperson.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Member’s death or incapacity<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>38.</B> (1) In the event of the death or incapac- ity of a member of a three-member panel, other than the death or incapacity of the chairperson of the panel, the chairperson of the panel may determine any matter that was before the panel and his or her decision is deemed to be the panel’s decision.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Chairperson’s death or incapacity<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) In the event of the death or incapacity of the chairperson of a panel, or of the member when the panel consists of one member, the Chairperson must establish a new panel to hear and determine the matter on any terms and conditions that the Chairperson may specify for the protection and preservation of the rights and interests of the parties.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers, rights and privileges<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>39.</B> A panel has all of the Board’s powers, rights and privileges with respect to any matter assigned to the panel.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Panel’s decision<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>40.</B> (1) A decision made by a majority of the members of a panel is the decision of the panel or, if no decision is supported by the majority, the decision of the chairperson of the panel is the decision of the panel.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Board’s decision<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) A decision of a panel is a decision of the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Witness Fees--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Witness Fees</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Payment of witness fees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>41.</B> A person who is summoned by the Board to attend as a witness at any of its proceedings is entitled to receive fees and allowances for so attending that are equal to those to which the person would be entitled if they were summoned to attend before the Federal Court.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Annual Report--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Annual Report</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Obligation to prepare report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>42.</B> (1) As soon as feasible after the end of each fiscal year, the Board must prepare and submit to the Minister a report on its activities during the immediately preceding fiscal year, other than its activities under the <I>Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Tabling in Parliament<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Minister must cause the report to be tabled in each House of Parliament within the first 15 days on which that House is sitting after the Minister receives it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations Act--><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 2<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>366.</B> (1) The definitions “adjudicator” and “Board” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“adjudicator”<br />« <I>arbitre de grief</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“adjudicator” means a person or board of adjudication to whom a grievance is referred under paragraph 223(2)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Board”<br />« <I>Commission</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 2(3)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) the person is engaged under subsection 30(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 273<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>367.</B> The headings before section 12 and sections 12 to 38 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 4</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board--><Para TopMargin="5" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Administration of Act<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>12.</B> The Board administers this Act and it may exercise the powers and perform the duties and functions that are conferred or imposed on it by this Act, or as are incidental to the attainment of the objects of this Act, including the making of orders requiring compliance with this Act, with regulations made under it or with decisions made in respect of a matter coming before the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Adjudication services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board is to provide adjudication services that consist of the hearing of applications and complaints made under this Part, the referral of grievances to adjudication in accord- ance with Part 2 and the hearing of matters brought before the Board under Part 3.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mediation services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>14.</B> The Board is to provide mediation services that consist of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) assisting parties in the negotiation of collective agreements and their renewal;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) assisting parties in the management of the relations resulting from the implementation of collective agreements;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) mediating in relation to grievances; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) assisting the Chairperson in discharging his or her responsibilities under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>National Joint Council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>15.</B> The Board is to provide facilities and administrative support to the National Joint Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>16.</B> The Board has, in relation to any matter before it, the power to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) examine any evidence that is submitted to it respecting membership of employees in an employee organization seeking certification and, in the case of a council of employee organizations seeking certification, in any employee organization forming part of the council;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) examine documents forming or relat-<keep>ing to the</keep> constitution or articles of associa-<keep>tion of any</keep> employee organization seeking <keep>certification</keep> and, in the case of a council of employee organizations seeking certification, those of any employee organization forming part of the council;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) require the employer to post and keep posted in appropriate places any notice that the Board considers necessary to bring matters or proceedings before the Board to the attention of employees;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) subject to any limitations that the Governor in Council may establish in the interests of defence or security, enter any premises of the employer where work is being or has been done by employees, inspect and view any work, material, machinery, appliance or article in the premises and require any person in the premises to answer all questions relating to the matter before it;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>e</I>) subject to any limitations that the Governor in Council may establish in the interests of defence or security, enter any premises of the employer for the purpose of conducting representation votes during working hours; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) authorize any person to do anything that the Board may do under paragraphs (<I>a</I>) to (<I>e</I>) and require the person to report to it on what the person has done.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>368.</B> Paragraphs 39(<I>i</I>) to (<I>m</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>l</I>) the circumstances in which the following evidence may be received by it as evidence that any employees wish or do not wish to have a particular employee organization represent them as their bargaining agent, and the circumstances in which it must not make public any evidence so received:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(i) evidence as to membership of employees in an employee organization,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) evidence of objection by employees to certification of an employee organization, and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(iii) evidence of signification by employees that they no longer wish to be represented by an employee organization; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>m</I>) any other matter that is incidental or conducive to the attainment of the objects of this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>369.</B> Sections 40 and 41 of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 274<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>370.</B> The heading before section 44 and sections 44 to 53 of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>371.</B> Section 147 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>147.</B> (1) The arbitration board has all the powers of the Board set out in paragraphs 16(<I>c</I>) and (<I>d</I>) of this Act and paragraphs 20(<I>a</I>) and (<I>d</I>) to (<I>f</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Delegation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The arbitration board may authorize any person to exercise any of its powers set out in paragraphs 16(<I>c</I>) and (<I>d</I>) of this Act and paragraphs 20(<I>d</I>) and (<I>e</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>, and require that person to report to it on the exercise of those powers.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>372.</B> Section 174 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>174.</B> (1) The public interest commission has all the powers of the Board set out in paragraphs 16(<I>c</I>) and (<I>d</I>) of this Act and paragraphs 20(<I>a</I>) and (<I>d</I>) to (<I>f</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Delegation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The public interest commission may authorize any person to exercise any of its powers set out in paragraphs 16(<I>c</I>) and (<I>d</I>) of this Act and paragraphs 20(<I>d</I>) and (<I>e</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>, and require that person to report to it on the exercise of those powers.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>373.</B> The headings before section 223 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Adjudication--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Adjudication</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:Notice to Board--><Para TopMargin="5" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Notice to Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>374.</B> Subsections 223(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notice<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>223.</B> (1) A party who refers a grievance to adjudication must, in accordance with the regulations, give notice of the reference to the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Action to be taken by Chairperson<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If the party specifies in the notice that an adjudicator is named in an applicable collective agreement, that an adjudicator has otherwise been selected by the parties or, if no adjudicator is so named or has been selected, that the party requests the establishment of a board of adjudication, then the Chairperson must, on receipt of the notice by the Board,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) if the grievance is one arising out of a collective agreement and an adjudicator is named in the agreement, refer the matter to the adjudicator;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) if the parties have selected an adjudicator, refer the matter to the adjudicator; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) if a board of adjudication has been requested and the other party has not objected in the time provided for in the regulations, establish the board and refer the matter to it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Board seized of grievance<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2.1) If the notice does not specify any of the things described in subsection (2), or if a board of adjudication has been requested and the other party has objected in the time provided for in the regulations, the Board is seized of the grievance.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>375.</B> Section 225 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Compliance with procedures<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>225.</B> No grievance may be referred to adjudication until the grievance has been presented at all required levels in accordance with the applicable grievance process.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>376.</B> Sections 226 and 227 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of adjudicator<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>226.</B> (1) An adjudicator may, in relation to any matter referred to adjudication, exercise any of the powers set out in paragraph 16(<I>d</I>) of this Act and sections 20 to 23 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of adjudicator and Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) An adjudicator or the Board may, in relation to any matter referred to adjudication,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) interpret and apply the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> and any other Act of Parliament relating to employment matters, other than the provisions of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> that are related to the right to equal pay for work of equal value, whether or not there is a conflict between the Act being interpreted and applied and the collective agreement, if any;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) give relief in accordance with paragraph 53(2)(<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) award interest in the case of grievances involving termination, demotion, suspension or financial penalty at a rate and for a period that the adjudicator or the Board, as the case may be, considers appropriate.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>377.</B> The heading before section 228 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:Decision--><Para TopMargin="10" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Decision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>378.</B> Subsections 228(1) and (2) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Hearing of grievance<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>228.</B> (1) If a grievance is referred to adjudication, the adjudicator or the Board, as the case may be, must give both parties to the grievance an opportunity to be heard.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision on grievance<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) After considering the grievance, the adjudicator or the Board, as the case may be, must render a decision, make the order that the adjudicator or the Board consider appropriate in the circumstances, and then send a copy of the order — and, if there are written reasons for the decision, a copy of the reasons — to each party, to the representative of each party and to the bargaining agent, if any, for the bargaining unit to which the employee whose grievance it is belongs. The adjudicator must also deposit a copy of the order and, if there are written reasons for the decision, a copy of the reasons, with the Chairperson.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>379.</B> Sections 229 and 230 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision requiring amendment<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>229.</B> An adjudicator’s or the Board’s decision may not have the effect of requiring the amendment of a collective agreement or an arbitral award.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Determination of reasonableness of opinion<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>230.</B> In the case of an employee in the core public administration or an employee of a separate agency designated under subsection 209(3), in making a decision in respect of an employee’s individual grievance relating to a termination of employment or demotion for unsatisfactory performance, an adjudicator or the Board, as the case may be, must determine the termination or demotion to have been for cause if the opinion of the deputy head that the employee’s performance was unsatisfactory is determined by the adjudicator or the Board to have been reasonable.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>380.</B> The portion of section 231 of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Determination of consent requirement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>231.</B> An adjudicator or the Board, when seized of a grievance referred to in subparagraph 209(1)(<I>c</I>)(ii), may determine any question relating to whether</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>381.</B> The portion of section 232 of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision in respect of certain policy grievances<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>232.</B> If a policy grievance relates to a matter that was or could have been the subject of an individual grievance or a group grievance, an adjudicator’s or the Board’s decision in respect of the policy grievance is limited to one or more of the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>382.</B> Sections 233 and 234 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No review by court<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>233.</B> Subsections 34(1) and (3) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> apply, with any necessary modifications, to an adjudicator’s orders and decisions.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Filing of order in Federal Court<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>234.</B> (1) The Board must, on the request in writing of any person who was a party to the proceedings that resulted in an order of an adjudicator or the Board, as the case may be, file a certified copy of the order, exclusive of the reasons for it, in the Federal Court, unless, in the opinion of the Board,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) there is no indication, or likelihood, of failure to comply with the order; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) there is another good reason why the filing of the order in the Federal Court would serve no useful purpose.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Section 35 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> does not apply to an order of the Board referred to in subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Effect of filing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) An order of an adjudicator or the Board becomes an order of the Federal Court when a certified copy of it is filed in that court, and it may subsequently be enforced as such.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>383.</B> Subsection 235(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Aggrieved employee represented by agent<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If an aggrieved employee is represented in the adjudication by a bargaining agent, the bargaining agent is liable to pay and must remit to the Board any part of the costs of the adjudication that may be determined by the Chairperson with the Board’s approval.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>384.</B> (1) Subparagraph 240(<I>a</I>)(ii) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="0">(ii) the “Board” is to be read as a reference to the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraphs 240(<I>b</I>) and (<I>c</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) section 156 of that Act does not apply in respect of the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) the provisions of this Act apply, with any necessary modifications, in respect of matters brought before the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>385.</B> Section 243 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Evidence respecting information obtained<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>243.</B> Members of arbitration boards, members of public interest commissions, mediators, adjudicators and persons seized of referrals under subsection 182(1) are not competent or compellable to appear as witnesses in any civil action, suit or other proceeding respecting information obtained in the discharge of their functions under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>386.</B> Paragraph 244(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) notes or draft orders or decisions of an adjudicator;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>387.</B> Section 245 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Criminal or civil proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>245.</B> No criminal or civil proceedings lie against a member of an arbitration board, a member of a public interest commission, a mediator, an adjudicator or a person seized of a referral under subsection 182(1) for anything done — or omitted to be done — or reported or said in good faith in the course of the exercise or performance or purported exercise or perform- ance of any power, duty or function under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>388.</B> Subsection 247(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Remuneration and expenses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>247.</B> (1) Members of arbitration boards, mediators, adjudicators and persons seized of referrals under subsection 182(1) are entitled to be paid the remuneration and expenses that may be fixed by the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>389.</B> Section 248 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Payment of witness fees<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>248.</B> A person who is summoned by an arbitration board, a public interest commission or an adjudicator to attend as a witness at any proceeding under this Act is entitled to receive fees and allowances for so attending that are equal to those to which the person would be entitled if summoned to attend before the Federal Court.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>390.</B> Section 251 of the Act and the heading before it are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provisions--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>391.</B> The following definitions apply in sections 392 to 402.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“former Board”<br />« <I>ancienne Commission</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“former Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations Board that is established by section 12 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“new Board”<br />« <I>nouvelle Commission</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“new Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointments terminated<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>392.</B> (1) Members of the former Board cease to hold office on the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No compensation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Despite the provisions of any contract, agreement or order, no person who was appointed to hold office as a part-time member of the former Board has any right to claim or receive any compensation, dam- ages, indemnity or other form of relief from Her Majesty in right of Canada or from any employee or agent of Her Majesty for ceasing to hold that office or for the abolition of that office by the operation of this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>393.</B> Subject to section 394, every proceeding commenced under the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force is to be taken up and continued under and in conformity with that Act, as it is amended by this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Persons employed by Public Service Staffing Tribunal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>394.</B> Every proceeding commenced under Part 1 or 2 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force that relates to a person who is employed by the Public Service Staffing Tribunal — continued by subsection 88(1) of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force — and that was not finally disposed of by the former Board before that day is deemed to have been discontinued immediately before that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation — members of former Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>395.</B> (1) A member of the former Board — other than an adjudicator referred to in paragraph 223(2)(<I>d</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force — may, at the request of the Chairperson of the new Board, continue to hear and decide any matter that was before the member before that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), a member of the former Board exercises the same powers, and performs the same duties and functions, as a panel of the new Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Refusal to complete duties<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If a member of the former Board refuses to continue to hear or decide any matter referred to in subsection (1), the Chairperson of the new Board may assign it to a panel of the new Board in accordance with section 37 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> on any terms and conditions that the Chairperson may specify for the protection and preservation of the rights and interests of the parties.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Supervision by Chairperson of new Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The Chairperson of the new Board has supervision over and direction of the work of any member of the former Board who continues to hear and decide a matter referred to in subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Remuneration and expenses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) A member of the former Board who continues to hear and decide a matter referred to in subsection (1)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) is to be paid the remuneration for their services that may be fixed by the Governor in Council; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) is entitled to be paid reasonable travel and living expenses incurred in the course of providing services during any period of absence from their ordinary place of residence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The Chairperson of the new Board may withdraw from a member of the former Board a matter referred to in subsection (1) that is not disposed of within one year after the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force and assign it to a panel of the new Board in accordance with section 37 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> on any terms and conditions that the Chairperson of the new Board may specify for the protection and preservation of the rights and interests of the parties.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation — former Board member adjudicators<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>396.</B> (1) An adjudicator referred to in paragraph 223(2)(<I>d</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force, may, at the request of the Chairperson of the new Board, continue to hear and decide any grievance that was before the adjudicator before that day.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), the adjudicator exercises the same powers as an adjudicator under the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Refusal to complete duties<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If an adjudicator refuses to continue to hear or decide a grievance referred to in subsection (1), the new Board is seized of the grievance.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Supervision by Chairperson of new Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The Chairperson of the new Board has supervision over and direction of the work of any adjudicator who continues to hear and decide a grievance referred to in subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Remuneration and expenses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) An adjudicator who continues to hear and decide a grievance referred to in subsection (1)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) is to be paid the remuneration for their services that may be fixed by the Governor in Council; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) is entitled to be paid reasonable travel and living expenses incurred in the course of providing services during any period of absence from their ordinary place of residence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The Chairperson of the new Board may withdraw from an adjudicator a griev- ance referred to in subsection (1) that is not disposed of within one year after the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force. If the Chairperson of the new Board withdraws the grievance, the new Board becomes seized of it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Persons employed by former Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>397.</B> Nothing in this Division affects the status of any person who was employed by the former Board immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force, except that, as of that day, the person is employed by the new Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Rights and obligations transferred<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>398.</B> All rights and property held by or in the name of or in trust for the former Board and all obligations and liabilities of the former Board are deemed to be rights, property, obligations and liabilities of the new Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>References<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>399.</B> Every reference to the former Board in a deed, contract or other document executed or, in Quebec, signed by the former Board in its own name is to be read as a reference to the new Board, unless the context requires otherwise.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of legal proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>400.</B> Any action, suit or other proceeding to which the former Board is a party that is pending in any court on the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force may be continued by or against the new Board in the same manner and to the same extent as it could have been continued by or against the former Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Commencement of legal proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>401.</B> Any action, suit or other legal proceeding in respect of an obligation or liability incurred by the former Board may be brought against the new Board in any court that would have had jurisdiction if the action, suit or other legal proceeding had been brought against the former Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Orders and decisions continued<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>402.</B> Every order or decision made by the former Board is deemed to have been made by the new Board and may be enforced as such.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Employment Act--><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, ss. 12 and 13<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Employment Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>403.</B> (1) The definition “Tribunal” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Subsection 2(1) of the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“Board”<br />« <I>Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>404.</B> (1) The portion of subsection 35(1) of the Act before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mobility — <keep>separate</keep> agencies<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>35.</B> (1) Unless otherwise provided in this or any other Act, a person employed in a separate agency to which the Commission does not have the exclusive authority to make appointments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Section 35 of the Act is amended by adding the following after subsection (1):</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Exception<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(1.1) Paragraph (1)(<I>b</I>) does not apply to persons employed by the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) Subsection 35(3) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>405.</B> The headings before section 88 and sections 88 to 96 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PART 6</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD--><Para TopMargin="5" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Powers, Duties and Functions--><Para TopMargin="5" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Powers, Duties and Functions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Complaints<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>88.</B> The Board is to consider and dispose of complaints made under subsection 65(1) and sections 74, 77 and 83.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>89.</B> Subject to any limitations that the Governor in Council may establish in the interests of defence or security, the Board has, in relation to a complaint, the power to enter any premises of an employer where work is being or has been done by employees, inspect and view any work, material, machinery, appliances or articles in the premises and require any person in the premises to answer all questions relating to the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>406.</B> The heading before section 97 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:Mediation Services--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Mediation Services</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>407.</B> Sections 98 to 104 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Complaint Procedure--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Complaint Procedure</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Filing of order in Federal Court<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>103.</B> (1) The Board must, on the request in writing of the Commission or any person to whom an order of the Board applies, file a certified copy of the order in the Federal Court unless, in the Board’s opinion</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) there is no indication, or likelihood, of failure to comply with the order; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) there is another good reason why the filing of the order in the Federal Court would serve no useful purpose.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Non-application<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) Section 35 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> does not apply to an order of the Board referred to in subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Effect of filing<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) An order of the Board becomes an order of the Federal Court when a certified copy of it is filed in that court, and it may subsequently be enforced as such.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Copy of decision provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>103.1</B> The Board shall render a decision on a complaint made under subsection 65(1) or section 74, 77 or 83 and provide a copy of it — including any written reasons — and any accompanying order to the Commission and to each person who exercised the right to be heard on the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:General--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">General</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Certain persons not compellable as witnesses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>104.</B> Persons providing mediation services under this Part are not competent or compellable to appear as witnesses in any civil action, suit or other proceeding respecting information obtained in the discharge of their functions under this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>408.</B> Paragraph 105(<I>a</I>) of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>409.</B> Sections 106 to 108 of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>410.</B> The heading before section 109 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:Regulations--><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Regulations</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>411.</B> Paragraphs 109(<I>b</I>) and (<I>c</I>) of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>412.</B> Section 110 of the Act is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>413.</B> Subsection 111(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Meaning of “deputy head”<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) For the purposes of this Part, “deputy head” includes a Commissioner who is appointed under subsection 4(5) and the Chairperson of the Board who is appointed under subsection 8(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Terminology<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>414.</B> The Act is amended by replacing “Tribunal” with “Board” in the following provisions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) section 38;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) section 65;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) the heading before section 74 and sections 74 to 76;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>d</I>) the heading before section 77 and sections 77 to 85;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>e</I>) section 87;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>f</I>) section 97; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>g</I>) the portion of section 109 before paragraph (<I>a</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provisions--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Definitions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>415.</B> The following definitions apply in sections 416 to 424.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Board”<br />« <I>Commission</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><MarginalNote>“Tribunal”<br />« <I>Tribunal</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" Bold="Yes">“Tribunal” means the Public Service Staffing Tribunal that is continued by subsection 88(1) of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I>, as that Act read immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Appointments terminated<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>416.</B> (1) Members of the Tribunal cease to hold office on the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No compensation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Despite the provisions of any contract, agreement or order, no person who was appointed to hold office as a part-time member of the Tribunal has any right to claim or receive any compensation, damages, indemnity or other form of relief from Her Majesty in right of Canada or from any employee or agent of Her Majesty for ceasing to hold that office or for the abolition of that office by the operation of this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>417.</B> Subject to subsection 418(1), every proceeding commenced with respect to a complaint made under subsection 65(1) or sections 74, 77 or 83 of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force is to be taken up and continued under and in conformity with that Act, as it is amended by this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation — member of Tribunal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>418.</B> (1) A member of the Tribunal may, at the request of the Chairperson of the Board, continue to consider and dispose of any complaint that was before the member before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), a member of the Tribunal exercises the same powers, and performs the same duties and functions, as a panel of the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Refusal to complete duties<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If a member of the Tribunal refuses to continue to consider or dispose of a complaint referred to in subsection (1), the Chairperson of the Board may assign it to a panel of the Board in accordance with section 37 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>, on any terms and conditions that the Chairperson of the Board may specify for the protection and preservation of the rights and interests of the parties.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Supervision by Chairperson of Board<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) The Chairperson of the Board has supervision over and direction of the work of any member of the Tribunal who continues to consider and dispose of a complaint referred to in subsection (1).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Remuneration and expenses<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) A member of the Tribunal who continues to consider and dispose of a complaint referred to in subsection (1)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) is to be paid the remuneration for their services that may be fixed by the Governor in Council; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) is entitled to be paid reasonable travel and living expenses incurred in the course of providing services during any period of absence from their ordinary place of residence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Limitation<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) The Chairperson of the Board may withdraw from a member of the Tribunal a complaint referred to in subsection (1) that is not disposed of within one year after the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force and assign it to a panel of the Board in accordance with section 37 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>, on any terms and conditions that the Chairperson of the Board may specify for the protection and preservation of the rights and interests of the parties.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Persons employed by Tribunal<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>419.</B> Nothing in this Division affects the status of any person who, immediately before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force, is employed by the Tribunal, except that, as of that day, the person is employed by the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Rights and obligations transferred<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>420.</B> All rights and property held by or in the name of or in trust for the Tribunal and all obligations and liabilities of the Tribunal are deemed to be rights, property, obligations and liabilities of the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>References<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>421.</B> Every reference to the Tribunal in a deed, contract or other document executed or, in Quebec, signed by the Tribunal in its own name is to be read as a reference to the Board, unless the context requires otherwise.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of legal proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>422.</B> Any action, suit or other proceeding to which the Tribunal is a party that is pending in any court on the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force may be continued by or against the Board in the same manner and to the same extent as it could have been continued by or against the Tribunal.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Commencement of legal proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>423.</B> Any action, suit or other legal proceeding in respect of an obligation or liability incurred by the Tribunal may be brought against the Board in any court that would have had jurisdiction if the action, suit or other legal proceeding had been brought against the Tribunal.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Orders and decisions continued<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>424.</B> Every order or decision made by the Tribunal is deemed to have been made by the Board and may be enforced as such.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. 33 (2nd Supp.)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendments to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendments to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 182(3)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>425.</B> The definition “Board” in section 3 of the <I>Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“Board”<br />« <I>Commission</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, ss. 183(E), 184 and 185<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>426.</B> The headings before section 9 and sections 9 to 11 of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division I</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board--><Para TopMargin="5" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Application of Certain Acts--><Para TopMargin="5" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Application of Certain Acts</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Application<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>9.</B> Unless otherwise provided in this Part, the provisions of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I> and the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> respecting the Board apply also in respect of this Part except that, for the purpose of that application,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) a reference to either of those Acts in any of those provisions shall be read as a reference to this Part; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) words and expressions used in those provisions that are defined by this Part shall have the meaning given to them by this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Powers, Duties and Functions--><Para TopMargin="10" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Powers, Duties and Functions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers, duties and functions<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>10.</B> The Board shall administer this Part and shall exercise the powers and perform the duties and functions that are conferred or imposed on it by, or are incidental to the attainment of the objects of, this Part including the making of orders requiring compliance with this Part, with any regulation made under this Part or with any decision made in respect of a matter coming before the Board under this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>427.</B> (1) Paragraphs 12(1)(<I>f</I>) to (<I>i</I>) of the Act are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) the establishment of rules of procedure for the hearings of an adjudicator;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>h</I>) the circumstances in which evidence as to membership of employees in an employee organization may be received by the Board as evidence that any employees wish or do not wish to have that employee organization represent them as their bargaining agent;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 12(1)(<I>k</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>k</I>) any other matter that is incidental or conducive to the attainment of the objects of this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>428.</B> (1) Paragraphs 15(<I>a</I>) to (<I>c</I>) of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) Paragraph 15(<I>f</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>f</I>) to authorize any person to do anything that the Board may do under paragraphs (<I>d</I>) and (<I>e</I>) and to require the person to report to the Board on it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>429.</B> Subsection 49(3) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of arbitrator<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) An arbitrator appointed under this section has all the powers of the Board set out in paragraph 15(<I>d</I>) of this Act and paragraphs <keep>20(<I>d</I>) and</keep> (<I>e</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>430.</B> Subsection 50(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Request for arbitration<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>50.</B> (1) If the parties to collective bargaining have bargained collectively in good faith with a view to concluding a collective agreement but have been unable to reach agreement on any term or condition of employment of employees in the relevant bargaining unit that may be embodied in an arbitral award, either party may, by notice in writing to the Board given in accordance with subsection (2), request arbitration in respect of that term or condition of employment.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>431.</B> Subsection 51(1) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Request for arbitration by other party<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>51.</B> (1) If notice under section 50 is received by the Board from any party requesting arbitration, the Chairperson shall as soon as feasible send a copy of the notice to the other party, who shall within seven days after receipt of it advise the Chairperson, by notice in writing, of any matter, additional to the matters specified in the notice under section 50, that was a subject of negotiation between the parties during the period before the arbitration was requested but on which the parties were unable to reach agreement and in respect of which, being a matter that may be embodied in an arbitral award, that other party requests arbitration.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>432.</B> Paragraph 66(4)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) shall not be a member of the Board but has, for the purposes of the adjudication, all the powers, rights and privileges of the Board other than the power to make regulations under section 12 of this Act or section 36 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1992, c. 1, s. 111<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>433.</B> Section 66.1 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers of adjudicator<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>66.1</B> An adjudicator has, for the purposes of the adjudication of a grievance respecting a matter referred to in paragraph 63(1)(<I>a</I>), (<I>b</I>) or (<I>c</I>) that is referred to adjudication, the powers that the Board has under paragraph 15(<I>d</I>) of this Act and paragraphs 20(<I>a</I>) and (<I>d</I>) to (<I>f</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>, in relation to the hearing or determination of a proceeding before it.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>434.</B> Paragraph 68(2)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) deposit a copy of the decision with the Board.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>435.</B> Subsection 69(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>If no adjudicator named in agreement<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) If a grievance is referred to adjudication but is not referred to an adjudicator named in a collective agreement, and the employee, whose grievance it is, is represented in the adjudication proceedings by the bargaining agent for the bargaining unit to which the employee belongs, the bargaining agent, subject to subsection (3), is liable to pay and shall remit to the Board any part of the costs of the adjudication that may be determined by the Chairperson with the Board’s approval.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>436.</B> Section 72 of the Act and the heading “<I>Review of Orders</I>” before it are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Review of Decisions--><Para TopMargin="10" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Review of Decisions</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No review by court<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>72.</B> (1) Except as provided in this Part, every award or decision of an arbitrator appointed under section 49 or an adjudicator is final and shall not be questioned or reviewed in any court.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>No review by injunction, etc.<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) No order shall be made or process entered, or proceedings taken in any court, whether by way of injunction, <I>certiorari</I>, prohibition, <I>quo warranto</I> or otherwise, to question, review, prohibit or restrain an arbitrator appointed under section 49 or an adjudicator in any of the proceedings of the arbitrator or adjudicator.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>437.</B> Section 78 of the Act and the heading before it are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Protection--><Para TopMargin="10" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Protection</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Evidence respecting information obtained<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>78.</B> No adjudicator, conciliator or person appointed by the Board and no arbitrator appointed under section 49 shall be required to give evidence in any civil action, suit or other proceeding respecting information obtained in the discharge of his or her duties under this Part.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provision--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>438.</B> Every proceeding commenced under the <I>Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act</I> before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force is to be taken up and continued under and in conformity with that Act, as it is amended by this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Federal Courts Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. F-7; 2002, c. 8, s. 14<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Federal Courts Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendment to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendment to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1990, c. 8, s. 8; 2003, c. 22, s. 262(E)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>439.</B> Paragraph 28(1)(<I>i</I>) of the <I>Federal Courts Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>i</I>) the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>i</I><I>.1</I>) adjudicators as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provision--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Applications for judicial review<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>440.</B> A decision of an adjudicator, as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, in respect of which an application for judicial review has been made before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force is to be dealt with as if that subsection had not come into force.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act--><MarginalNote>2009, c. 2, s. 394<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Amendment to the Act--><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Amendment to the Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>441.</B> The definition “Board” in subsection 2(1) of the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>“Board”<br />« <I>Commission</I> »<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0">“Board” means the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>442.</B> The heading “PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS BOARD” before section 25 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes"><!--Heading:PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD--><Para TopMargin="10" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">PUBLIC SERVICE LABOUR RELATIONS AND EMPLOYMENT BOARD</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>443.</B> Subsection 25(2) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Regulations<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Board may make regulations concerning the procedure in respect of the making of complaints under this Act and any other matter that is incidental or conducive to the exercise of its powers and the performance of its duties and functions under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>444.</B> Subsection 28 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Notice to employee<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>28.</B> If the Board decides not to deal with a complaint filed with it under this Act, it shall send a written notice of its decision and the reasons for it to the employee who filed the complaint and to the employer or bargaining agent, as the case may be — or, in the case of a complaint filed under section 24, to the employer and the bargaining agent — to whom the complaint relates.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Transitional Provision--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Transitional Provision</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Continuation of proceedings<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>445.</B> Every proceeding commenced under the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> before the day on which subsection 366(1) of this Act comes into force is to be taken up and continued under and in conformity with that Act, as it is amended by this Division.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Consequential Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Consequential Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Access to Information Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. A-1<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Access to Information Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, ss. 88 and 246<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>446.</B> Schedule I to the <I>Access to Information Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “OTHER GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations Board </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail dans la fonction publique </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staffing Tribunal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Tribunal de la dotation de la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>447.</B> Schedule I to the Act is amended by adding the following, in alphabetical order, under the heading “OTHER GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canada Evidence Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. C-5<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canada Evidence Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 105<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>448.</B> Item 11 of the schedule to the <I>Canada Evidence Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="ON" TextAlign="Justify">11. The Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>, for the purposes of a grievance process under the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> with respect to an employee of the Canadian Security Intelligence Service, with the exception of any information provided to the Board by the employee</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Canadian Security Intelligence Service Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. C-23<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Canadian Security Intelligence Service Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 143(3)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>449.</B> Subsection 8(3) of the <I>Canadian Security Intelligence Service Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Adjudication of employee grievances<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) When a grievance is referred to adjudication, the adjudication shall not be heard or determined by any person, other than a full-time member of the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board that is established by subsection 4(1) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Financial Administration Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. F-11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Financial Administration Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>1992, c. 1, s. 72; 2003, c. 22, s. 168; SOR/2003-443<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>450.</B> Schedule I.1 to the <I>Financial Administration Act</I> is amended by striking out, in column I, the reference to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations Board </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail dans la fonction publique </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">and the corresponding reference in column II to “Minister of Canadian Heritage”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 247; SOR/2003-444<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>451.</B> Schedule I.1 to the Act is amended by striking out, in column I, the reference to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staffing Tribunal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Tribunal de la dotation de la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">and the corresponding reference in column II to “Minister of Canadian Heritage”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>452.</B> Schedule I.1 to the Act is amended by amended by adding, in alphabetical order in column I, a reference to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">and a corresponding reference in column II to “Minister of Canadian Heritage”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>453.</B> Schedule IV to the Act is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staffing Tribunal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Tribunal de la dotation de la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 11<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>454.</B> Schedule V to the Act is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations Board </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail dans la fonction publique </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>455.</B> Schedule V to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 9, s. 270<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>456.</B> Part III of Schedule VI to the Act is amended by striking out, in column I, the reference to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations Board </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail dans la fonction publique </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">and the corresponding reference in column II to “Chairperson”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2006, c. 9, s. 270<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>457.</B> Part III of Schedule VI to the Act is amended by striking out, in column I, the reference to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staffing Tribunal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Tribunal de la dotation de la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">and the corresponding reference in column II to “Chairperson”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>458.</B> Part III of Schedule VI to the Act is amended by adding, in alphabetical order in column I, a reference to</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">and a corresponding reference in column II to “Chairperson”.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Privacy Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. P-21<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Privacy Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, ss. 189 and 248<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>459.</B> The schedule to the <I>Privacy Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “OTHER GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations Board </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staffing Tribunal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Tribunal de la dotation de la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>460.</B> The schedule to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order under the heading “OTHER GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Service Superannuation Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. P-36<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Service Superannuation Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 250<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>461.</B> Part I of Schedule I to the <I>Public Service Superannuation Act</I> is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staffing Tribunal</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"> Tribunal de la dotation de la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 213<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>462.</B> Part II of Schedule I to the Act is amended by striking out the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr"> Commission des relations de travail dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>463.</B> Part II of Schedule I to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Public Sector Compensation Act--><MarginalNote>1991, c. 30<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Public Sector Compensation Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>464.</B> Schedule I to the <I>Public Sector Compensation Act</I> is amended by striking out the following under the heading “OTHER PORTIONS OF THE PUBLIC SERVICE”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Staff Relations Board </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail dans la Fonction publique </AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>465.</B> Schedule I to the Act is amended by adding the following in alphabetical order under the heading “OTHER PORTIONS OF THE PUBLIC SERVICE”:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes" /><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="2" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="-2">Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="0" LeftMargin="4" FirstLineIndent="-2" Italic="Yes"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">Commission des relations de travail et de l’emploi dans la fonction publique</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Status of the Artist Act--><MarginalNote>1992, c. 33<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Status of the Artist Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 220(E)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>466.</B> Paragraph 9(3)(<I>a</I>) of the <I>Status of the Artist Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) employees, within the meaning of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I>, including those determined to be employees by the Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board, and members of a bargaining unit that is certified by that Board; or</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coordinating Amendments--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coordinating Amendments</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>This Act<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>467.</B> (1) On the day on which section 298 comes into force, section 370 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2003, c. 22, s. 274<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>370.</B> The heading before section 44 and sections 44 to 52 of the Act are repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) If section 333 of this Act comes into force before section 376 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 376 comes into force, paragraph 226(2)(<I>b</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) give relief in accordance with any of paragraphs 53(2)(<I>b</I>) to (<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If section 376 comes into force before section 333, then that section 333 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>333.</B> Paragraph 226(2)(<I>b</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) give relief in accordance with any of paragraphs 53(2)(<I>b</I>) to (<I>e</I>) or subsection 53(3) of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I>; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) If section 333 comes into force on the same day as section 376, then that section 333 is deemed to have come into force before that section 376 and subsection (2) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) On the first day on which both sections 334 and 381 of this Act are in force, the portion of section 232 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> before paragraph (<I>a</I>) is replaced by the following</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Decision in respect of policy grievances<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>232.</B> An adjudicator’s or the Board’s decision in respect of a policy grievance is limited to one or more of the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) If section 335 comes into force before section 383, then that section 383 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>383.</B> Subsection 235(6) of the French version of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Alinéas <keep>209(1)<I>b</I>),</keep> <I>c</I>), <keep><I>c.1</I>) ou</keep> <I>d</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">(6) Dans le cas du renvoi à l’arbitrage d’un grief individuel d’un type visé aux alinéas 209(1)<I>b</I>), <I>c</I>), <I>c.1</I>) ou <I>d</I>) par un fonctionnaire s’estimant lésé qui ne fait pas partie d’une unité de négociation, les frais d’arbitrage sont à la charge de la Commission.</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) If section 383 of this Act comes into force before section 335 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 335 comes into force, subsection 235(6) of the French version of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Alinéas <keep>209(1)<I>b</I>),</keep> <I>c</I>), <keep><I>c.1</I>) ou</keep> <I>d</I>)<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><AltLang xml:lang="fr">(6) Dans le cas du renvoi à l’arbitrage d’un grief individuel d’un type visé aux alinéas 209(1)<I>b</I>), <I>c</I>), <I>c.1</I>) ou <I>d</I>) par un fonctionnaire s’estimant lésé qui ne fait pas partie d’une unité de négociation, les frais d’arbitrage sont à la charge de la Commission.</AltLang></Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) If section 335 comes into force on the same day as section 383, then that section 383 is deemed to have come into force before that section 335 and subsection (7) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) On the day on which section 337 comes into force, section 388 is repealed.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) If section 356 of this Act comes into force before section 405 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 405 comes into force, section 88 of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Complaints<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>88.</B> The Board is to consider and dispose of complaints made under subsection 65(1) and sections 74, 77, 78 and 83.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(11) If section 405 comes into force before section 356, then that section 356 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>356.</B> Section 88 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Complaints<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>88.</B> The Board is to consider and dispose of complaints made under subsection 65(1) and sections 74, 77, 78 and 83.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(12) If section 356 comes into force on the same day as section 405, then that section 356 is deemed to have come into force before that section 405 and subsection (10) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(13) If section 357 of this Act comes into force before section 407 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 407 comes into force, section 89 of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>89.</B> (1) Subject to any limitations that the Governor in Council may establish in the interests of defence or security, the Board has, in relation to a complaint, the power to enter any premises of an employer where work is being or has been done by employees, inspect and view any work, material, machinery, appliances or articles in the premises and require any person in the premises to answer all questions relating to the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissing complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Board may summarily dismiss a complaint if the complainant fails to comply with any procedures set out in this Act, or the Board’s regulations, in relation to a complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissing complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Board may summarily dismiss a complaint if the deputy head has taken the corrective action that the Board considers appropriate in relation to the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(14) If section 407 comes into force before section 357, then that section 357 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>357.</B> Section 89 of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Powers<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>89.</B> (1) Subject to any limitations that the Governor in Council may establish in the interests of defence or security, the Board has, in relation to a complaint, the power to enter any premises of an employer where work is being or has been done by employees, inspect and view any work, material, machinery, appliances or articles in the premises and require any person in the premises to answer all questions relating to the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissing complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(2) The Board may summarily dismiss a complaint if the complainant fails to comply with any procedures set out in this Act, or the Board’s regulations, in relation to a complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Dismissing complaint<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2">(3) The Board may summarily dismiss a complaint if the deputy head has taken the corrective action that the Board considers appropriate in relation to the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(15) If section 357 comes into force on the same day as section 407, then that section 357 is deemed to have come into force before that section 407 and subsection (13) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(16) On the first day on which both sections 358 and 407 of this Act are in force, section 103.1 of the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Copy of decision provided<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>103.1</B> The Board shall render a decision on a complaint made under subsection 65(1) or section 74, 77, 78 or 83 and provide a copy of it — including any written reasons — and any accompanying order to the Commission and to each person who exercised the right to be heard on the complaint.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Terminology — <I>Public Service Employment Act</I><br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>468.</B> (1) In this section, “the Act” means the <I>Public Service Employment Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) If section 414 of this Act comes into force before section 349 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 349 comes into force, the Act is amended by replacing “Tribunal” with “Board” in the following provisions:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) subsections 65(1) and (5);</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) sections 77 to 79;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>c</I>) section 81; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>d</I>) paragraph 84(<I>c</I>).</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If section 414 comes into force on the same day as sections 349, 351, 353 and 355, then those sections 349, 351, 353 and 355 are deemed to have come into force before that section 414.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) On the first day on which both sections 414 and 350 of this Act are in force, the Act is amended by replacing “Tribunal” with “Board” in section 76.1.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) If section 414 of this Act comes into force before section 352 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 352 comes into force, the English version of the Act is amended by replacing “Tribunal” with “Board” in section 80.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) If section 414 comes into force on the same day as section 352, then that section 352 is deemed to have come into force before that section 414.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>2009, c. 2<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>469.</B> (1) In this section, “other Act” means the <I>Budget Implementation Act, 2009</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(2) If section 367 of this Act comes into force before section 400 of the other Act, then</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) that section 400 is repealed; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) on the day on which the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> comes into force, sections 13 and 14 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Adjudication services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board is to provide adjudication services that consist of the hearing of applications and complaints made under this Part, the referral of grievances to adjudication in accord­ance with Part 2 and the hearing of matters brought before the Board under Part 3. The Board is also to provide adjudication services in accordance with the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mediation services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>14.</B> The Board is to provide mediation services that consist of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) assisting parties in the negotiation of collective agreements and their renewal;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) assisting parties in the management of the relations resulting from the implementation of collective agreements;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) mediating in relation to grievances; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) assisting the Chairperson in discharging his or her responsibilities under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">The Board is also to provide mediation services in accordance with the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(3) If section 400 of the other Act comes into force before section 367 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 367 comes into force, sections 13 and 14 of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> are replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Adjudication services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>13.</B> The Board is to provide adjudication services that consist of the hearing of applications and complaints made under this Part, the referral of grievances to adjudication in accord- ance with Part 2 and the hearing of matters brought before the Board under Part 3. The Board is also to provide adjudication services in accordance with the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Mediation services<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>14.</B> The Board is to provide mediation services that consist of</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) assisting parties in the negotiation of collective agreements and their renewal;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>b</I>) assisting parties in the management of the relations resulting from the implementation of collective agreements;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>c</I>) mediating in relation to grievances; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>d</I>) assisting the Chairperson in discharging his or her responsibilities under this Act.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0">The Board is also to provide mediation services in accordance with the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(4) If section 400 of the other Act comes into force on the same day as section 367 of this Act, then that section 400 is deemed to have come into force before that section 367 and subsection (3) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(5) If section 404 of the other Act comes into force before section 376 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 376 comes into force, paragraph 226(2)(<I>a</I>) of the <I>Public Service Labour Relations Act</I> is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) interpret and apply the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> and any other Act of Parliament relating to employment matters, other than the provisions of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> that are related to the right to equal pay for work of equal value and the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>, whether or not there is a conflict between the Act being interpreted and applied and the collective agreement, if any;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(6) If section 376 of this Act comes into force before section 422 of the other Act, then that section 422 is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>422.</B> Paragraph 226(2)(<I>a</I>) of the Act is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0">(<I>a</I>) interpret and apply the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> and any other Act of Parliament relating to employment matters, other than the provisions of the <I>Canadian Human Rights Act</I> that are related to the right to equal pay for work of equal value and the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I>, whether or not there is a conflict between the Act being interpreted and applied and the collective agreement, if any;</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(7) If section 404 of the other Act comes into force on the same day as section 376 of this Act, then that section 404 is deemed to have come into force before that section 376 and subsection (5) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(8) If section 405 of the other Act comes into force before section 390 of this Act, then, on the day on which that section 390 comes into force, subsection 42(1) of the <I><I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I></I>, as enacted by section 365 of this Act, is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Obligation to prepare report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>42.</B> (1) As soon as feasible after the end of each fiscal year, the Board must prepare and submit to the Minister a report on its activities during the immediately preceding fiscal year, other than its activities under the <I>Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act</I>. The report must include a summary of the reports that the Board has received under the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> during that year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(9) If section 390 of this Act comes into force before section 405 of the other Act, then,</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>a</I>) that section 405 is repealed; and</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="No"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="2" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes">(<I>b</I>) on the day on which the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> comes into force, subsection 42(1) of the <I><I>Public Service Labour Relations and Employment Board Act</I></I>, as enacted by section 365 of this Act, is replaced by the following:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Obligation to prepare report<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>42.</B> (1) As soon as feasible after the end of each fiscal year, the Board must prepare and submit to the Minister a report on its activities during the immediately preceding fiscal year, other than its activities under the <I>Parliamentary Employment and Staff Relations Act</I>. The report must include a summary of the reports that the Board has received under the <I>Public Sector Equitable Compensation Act</I> during that year.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes">(10) If section 405 of the other Act comes into force on the same day as section 390 of this Act, then that section 405 is deemed to have come into force before that section 390 and subsection (8) applies as a consequence.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Coming into Force--><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Coming into Force</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>Order in council<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>470.</B> Sections 365 to 466, and the provisions of any Act as they are enacted by this Division, come into force on a day or days to be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Division 19</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:Supreme Court Act--><MarginalNote>R.S., c. S-26<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" Bold="Yes" SmallCaps="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">Supreme Court Act</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>471.</B> The <I>Supreme Court Act</I> is amended by adding the following after section 5:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>For greater certainty<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>5.1</B> For greater certainty, for the purpose of section 5, a person may be appointed a judge if, at any time, they were a barrister or advocate of at least 10 years standing at the bar of a province.</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2" Bold="Yes"><B>472.</B> The Act is amended by adding the following after section 6:</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="Y" Align="Yes"><MarginalNote>For greater certainty<br /></MarginalNote><Para TopMargin="5" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="2"><B>6.1</B> For greater certainty, for the purpose of section 6, a judge is from among the advocates of the Province of Quebec if, at any time, they were an advocate of at least 10 years standing at the bar of that Province.</Para></Block><Block Align="Yes" LineCnt="N"><Para NoLineBreak="Yes" NoHtml="Yes" Leading="0" Size="0" TopMargin="0" BottomMargin="0"></Para></Block></Bill_Part><Bill_Part Part_Type="Schedule" CountLines="No" RunningHead_E="Economic Action Plan 2013, No. 2. – Schedule"><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SCHEDULE </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Bold="Yes" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">(Section 282)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para TopMargin="10" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">SCHEDULE </Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><Para Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Italic="Yes" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">(Sections 2 and 10)</Para></Block><Block LineCnt="N" Align="Yes" KeepWith="Next"><!--Heading:REGIONAL ORGANIZATIONS--><Para TopMargin="5" Size="9" Leading="10" LeftMargin="0" FirstLineIndent="0" Hyphenate="OFF" TextAlign="Center">REGIONAL ORGANIZATIONS</Para></Block><Block Align="Yes"><Para Style="BPT_ImprintE"><br /><br />Published under authority of the Speaker of the House of Commons</Para></Block><Block Align="Yes" LineCnt="N"><Para NoLineBreak="Yes" NoHtml="Yes" Leading="0" Size="0" TopMargin="0" BottomMargin="0"></Para></Block></Bill_Part></Bill>